Quarterlytics / Financial Services / Banks - Regional / CresCom Bank

CresCom Bank

caro · NASDAQ Financial Services
Claim this profile
Ticker caro
Exchange NASDAQ
Sector Financial Services
Industry Banks - Regional
Employees 201-500
← All annual reports
FY2015 Annual Report · CresCom Bank
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
288 Meeting Street, Charleston, SC 29401
288 Meeting Street, Charleston, SC 29401
288 Meeting Street, Charleston, SC 29401

DOWNTOWN CHARLESTON
DOWNTOWN CHARLESTON
DOWNTOWN CHARLESTON
288 Meeting Street
288 Meeting Street
288 Meeting Street
Charleston, SC 29401-1570
Charleston, SC 29401-1570
Charleston, SC 29401-1570

GARDEN CITY
GARDEN CITY
GARDEN CITY
2636 S Hwy 17
2636 S Hwy 17
2636 S Hwy 17
Murrells Inlet, SC 29576-7617
Murrells Inlet, SC 29576-7617
Murrells Inlet, SC 29576-7617

WEST ASHLEY
WEST ASHLEY
WEST ASHLEY
884 Orleans Road
884 Orleans Road
884 Orleans Road
Charleston, SC 29407-4937
Charleston, SC 29407-4937
Charleston, SC 29407-4937

LITCHFIELD/PAWLEYS ISLAND
LITCHFIELD/PAWLEYS ISLAND
LITCHFIELD/PAWLEYS ISLAND
13021 Ocean Highway
13021 Ocean Highway
13021 Ocean Highway
Pawleys Island, SC 29585-7080
Pawleys Island, SC 29585-7080
Pawleys Island, SC 29585-7080

JAMES ISLAND
JAMES ISLAND
JAMES ISLAND
430 Folly Road
430 Folly Road
430 Folly Road
Charleston, SC 29412-2641
Charleston, SC 29412-2641
Charleston, SC 29412-2641

MOUNT PLEASANT
MOUNT PLEASANT
MOUNT PLEASANT
1492 Stuart Engals Blvd.
1492 Stuart Engals Blvd.
1492 Stuart Engals Blvd.
Mount Pleasant, SC 29464-3378
Mount Pleasant, SC 29464-3378
Mount Pleasant, SC 29464-3378

SUMMERVILLE
SUMMERVILLE
SUMMERVILLE
200 N Cedar Street
200 N Cedar Street
200 N Cedar Street
Summerville, SC 29483-6404
Summerville, SC 29483-6404
Summerville, SC 29483-6404

LITTLE RIVER
LITTLE RIVER
LITTLE RIVER
1180 Highway 17
1180 Highway 17
1180 Highway 17
Little River, SC 29566-9208
Little River, SC 29566-9208
Little River, SC 29566-9208

GREENVILLE
GREENVILLE
GREENVILLE
3695 E. North Street
3695 E. North Street
3695 E. North Street
Greenville, SC 29615
Greenville, SC 29615
Greenville, SC 29615

HEATH SPRINGS
HEATH SPRINGS
HEATH SPRINGS
202 N Main Street
202 N Main Street
202 N Main Street
Heath Springs, SC 29058
Heath Springs, SC 29058
Heath Springs, SC 29058

NORTH CHARLESTON
NORTH CHARLESTON
NORTH CHARLESTON
8485 Dorchester Road
8485 Dorchester Road
8485 Dorchester Road
North Charleston, SC 29420-7307
North Charleston, SC 29420-7307
North Charleston, SC 29420-7307

SUNSET BEACH
SUNSET BEACH
SUNSET BEACH
7290 Beach Drive SW
7290 Beach Drive SW
7290 Beach Drive SW
Ocean Isle Beach, NC 28469-5436
Ocean Isle Beach, NC 28469-5436
Ocean Isle Beach, NC 28469-5436

CANE BAY
CANE BAY
CANE BAY
1724 State Road
1724 State Road
1724 State Road
Summerville, SC 29483-2842
Summerville, SC 29483-2842
Summerville, SC 29483-2842

SAINT GEORGE
SAINT GEORGE
SAINT GEORGE
5561 Memorial Blvd.
5561 Memorial Blvd.
5561 Memorial Blvd.
Saint George, SC 29477-2475
Saint George, SC 29477-2475
Saint George, SC 29477-2475

MYRTLE BEACH
MYRTLE BEACH
MYRTLE BEACH
991 38th Avenue N
991 38th Avenue N
991 38th Avenue N
Myrtle Beach, SC 29577-2832
Myrtle Beach, SC 29577-2832
Myrtle Beach, SC 29577-2832

NORTH MYRTLE BEACH
NORTH MYRTLE BEACH
NORTH MYRTLE BEACH
700 Main Street
700 Main Street
700 Main Street
North Myrtle Beach, SC 29582-3030
North Myrtle Beach, SC 29582-3030
North Myrtle Beach, SC 29582-3030

SOCASTEE
SOCASTEE
SOCASTEE
4506 Highway 707
4506 Highway 707
4506 Highway 707
Myrtle Beach, SC 29588
Myrtle Beach, SC 29588
Myrtle Beach, SC 29588

CONWAY
CONWAY
CONWAY
2069 E Hwy 501
2069 E Hwy 501
2069 E Hwy 501
Conway, SC 29526-9504
Conway, SC 29526-9504
Conway, SC 29526-9504

CONWAY
CONWAY
CONWAY
1230 16th Avenue
1230 16th Avenue
1230 16th Avenue
Conway, SC 29526-3479
Conway, SC 29526-3479
Conway, SC 29526-3479

HOLDEN BEACH
HOLDEN BEACH
HOLDEN BEACH
3178 Holden Beach Road SW
3178 Holden Beach Road SW
3178 Holden Beach Road SW
Holden Beach, NC 28462
Holden Beach, NC 28462
Holden Beach, NC 28462

SHALLOTTE
SHALLOTTE
SHALLOTTE
200 Smith Avenue
200 Smith Avenue
200 Smith Avenue
Shallotte, NC 28470-4458
Shallotte, NC 28470-4458
Shallotte, NC 28470-4458

SOUTHPORT
SOUTHPORT
SOUTHPORT
4945 Southport Supply Road SE
4945 Southport Supply Road SE
4945 Southport Supply Road SE
Southport, NC 28461-8742
Southport, NC 28461-8742
Southport, NC 28461-8742

WHITEVILLE
WHITEVILLE
WHITEVILLE
110 N J K Powell Blvd.
110 N J K Powell Blvd.
110 N J K Powell Blvd.
Whiteville, NC 28472-3124
Whiteville, NC 28472-3124
Whiteville, NC 28472-3124

CHADBOURN
CHADBOURN
CHADBOURN
111 Strawberry Blvd.
111 Strawberry Blvd.
111 Strawberry Blvd.
Chadbourn, NC 28431-1415
Chadbourn, NC 28431-1415
Chadbourn, NC 28431-1415

ELIZABETHTOWN
ELIZABETHTOWN
ELIZABETHTOWN
306 S Poplar Street
306 S Poplar Street
306 S Poplar Street
Elizabethtown, NC 28337
Elizabethtown, NC 28337
Elizabethtown, NC 28337

TABOR CITY
TABOR CITY
TABOR CITY
105 Hickman Road
105 Hickman Road
105 Hickman Road
Tabor City, NC 28463-1927
Tabor City, NC 28463-1927
Tabor City, NC 28463-1927

ALL LOCATIONS
ALL LOCATIONS
ALL LOCATIONS
1 (855) 273-7266  •  www.haveanicebank.com
1 (855) 273-7266  •  www.haveanicebank.com
1 (855) 273-7266  •  www.haveanicebank.com

2
2
2
0
0
0
1
1
1
5
5
5
A
A
A
n
n
n
n
n
n
u
u
u
a
a
a
l
l
l

R
R
R
e
e
e
p
p
p
o
o
o
r
r
r
t
t
t

2
2
2
0
0
0
1
1
1
6
6
6
P
P
P
r
r
r
o
o
o
x
x
x
y
y
y
S
S
S
t
t
t
a
a
a
t
t
t
e
e
e
m
m
m
e
e
e
n
n
n
t
t
t

2015 Annual Report
2015 Annual Report
2015 Annual Report
2016 Proxy Statement
2016 Proxy Statement
2016 Proxy Statement

HOME OFFICE
HOME OFFICE
HOME OFFICE
6600 Peachtree Dunwoody Rd. NE/600 Embassy Row, Suite 650
6600 Peachtree Dunwoody Rd. NE/600 Embassy Row, Suite 650
6600 Peachtree Dunwoody Rd. NE/600 Embassy Row, Suite 650
Atlanta, GA 30328 • (800) 851- 0263 • www.crescentmortgage.com
Atlanta, GA 30328 • (800) 851- 0263 • www.crescentmortgage.com
Atlanta, GA 30328 • (800) 851- 0263 • www.crescentmortgage.com

DISCLAIMER – This annual report has not been reviewed or confirmed for accuracy or relevance by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.
DISCLAIMER – This annual report has not been reviewed or confirmed for accuracy or relevance by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.
DISCLAIMER – This annual report has not been reviewed or confirmed for accuracy or relevance by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.

CarolinaFC-AR-Wrap-2016-FINAL.indd   Custom H

3/24/16   9:47 AM

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CAROLINA FINANCIAL CORPORATION 
288 Meeting Street 
Charleston, SC 29401 
(843) 723-7700

April 1, 2016 

Dear Stockholder:

On  behalf  of  the  Board  of  Directors  and  management  of  Carolina  Financial  Corporation  (the 
“Company”), we cordially invite you to attend the Annual Meeting of Stockholders. The meeting will be 
held at 5:00 p.m. on May 3, 2016, at The Country Club of Charleston, 1 Country Club Drive, Charleston, 
South Carolina.

A
n
n
e
x
A

P
r
o
x
y

In addition to the annual stockholder vote on corporate business items, the meeting will include 

management’s report to you on the Company’s fiscal 2015 financial and operating performance.

An important aspect of the meeting process is the stockholder vote on corporate business items. 
We urge you to exercise your rights as a stockholder to vote and participate in this process. Stockholders 
are being asked to consider and vote upon the following proposals: (i) to elect four directors to serve for 
a term of three years and one director to serve for a term of one year, (ii) to approve an amendment to 
the Company’s Restated Certificate of Incorporation to increase the number of shares of Common Stock 
that the Company is authorized to issue from 15,000,000 shares to 25,000,000 shares, and (iii) to ratify the 
appointment of the Company’s independent registered public accounting firm for the fiscal year ended 
December 31, 2016. The Board of Directors has carefully considered these proposals and unanimously 
recommends that you vote for each of the nominees and in favor of each of the proposals calling for a 
“yes” or “no” vote.

We  encourage  you  to  attend  the  meeting  in  person.  Whether  or  not  you  attend  the  meeting, 
we hope that you will read the enclosed proxy statement and vote your shares in advance of the Annual 
Meeting either by Internet, telephone or by mail. Instructions regarding Internet and telephone voting are 
included on the proxy card. If you choose to submit a proxy by mail, please mark, sign and date the proxy 
card and return it in the enclosed postage-paid envelope. This will save the Company additional expense in 
soliciting proxies and will ensure that your shares are represented. Please note that you may vote in person 
at the meeting even if you have previously returned the proxy. If you need assistance in completing your 
proxy, please call the Assistant Secretary of the Company at (843) 534-5142.

Thank you for your attention to this important matter.

Sincerely, 

G. Manly Eubank 
Chairman of the Board

 
 
(This page intentionally left blank)

CAROLINA FINANCIAL CORPORATION
288 Meeting Street
Charleston, South Carolina 29401
(843) 723-7700

NOTICE OF ANNUAL MEETING OF STOCKHOLDERS 
TO BE HELD ON MAY 3, 2016

Notice  is  hereby  given  that  the  Annual  Meeting  of  Stockholders  (the  “Meeting”)  of  Carolina 
Financial Corporation (the “Company”) will be held at The Country Club of Charleston, 1 Country Club 
Drive, Charleston, South Carolina. at 5:00 p.m., local time, on May 3, 2016.

A proxy card and a proxy statement for the Meeting are enclosed.

The Meeting is for the purpose of considering and acting upon:

A
n
n
e
x
A

P
r
o
x
y

1.  The election of four directors to serve for a term of three years and one director to serve for 

a term of one year;

2.  The approval of an amendment to the Company’s Restated Certificate of Incorporation to 
increase the number of shares of Common Stock the Company is authorized to issue from 
15,000,000 shares to 25,000,000 shares;

3.  The ratification of the appointment of Elliott Davis Decosimo, LLC as the independent  registered 

public accounting firm of the Company for the fiscal year ending December 31, 2016; and

4.  Such other matters as may properly come before the Meeting, or any adjournments thereof.

The Board of Directors is not aware of any other business to come before the Meeting. Any action 
may be taken on the foregoing proposals at the Meeting on the date specified above or on any date or 
dates to which the Meeting may be adjourned. Stockholders of record at the close of business on March 
18, 2016 are the stockholders entitled to vote at the Meeting and any adjournments thereof. A complete 
list of these stockholders will be available at the Company’s offices prior to the Meeting.

You are requested to vote the enclosed form of proxy, which is solicited on behalf of the Board of 
Directors, either by Internet, telephone or by mail. Instructions regarding Internet and telephone voting 
are included on the proxy card. If you choose to submit a proxy by mail, please mark, sign and date the 
proxy card and return it in the enclosed postage-paid envelope. The proxy will not be used if you attend 
and vote at the Meeting in person. If your shares are held in “street name,” you will need to obtain a proxy 
form from the institution that holds your shares in order to vote at the Meeting.

BY ORDER OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS

Charleston, South Carolina
April 1, 2016

M. J. Huggins, III
Executive Vice President and Secretary

 
IMPORTANT: THE PROMPT RETURN OF PROXIES WILL SAVE THE COMPANY THE  
EXPENSE OF FURTHER REQUESTS FOR PROXIES TO ENSURE A QUORUM AT THE 
MEETING. A SELF-ADDRESSED ENVELOPE IS ENCLOSED FOR YOUR CONVENIENCE. 
NO POSTAGE IS REQUIRED IF MAILED WITHIN THE UNITED STATES.

iv

PROXY STATEMENT

CAROLINA FINANCIAL CORPORATION
288 Meeting Street
Charleston, South Carolina 29401
(843) 723-7700

ANNUAL MEETING OF STOCKHOLDERS
TO BE HELD MAY 3, 2016

This proxy statement is furnished in connection with the solicitation on behalf of the Board of 
Directors of Carolina Financial Corporation (the “Company”), the parent company of  CresCom  Bank 
(the “Bank”), Crescent Mortgage Company (“Crescent Mortgage”), and Carolina Services Corporation 
of Charleston (“Carolina Services Corporation”), which are direct subsidiaries of the Bank, to be used at 
the Annual Meeting of Stockholders of the Company (the “Meeting”) which will be held at The Country 
Club of Charleston, 1 Country Club Drive, Charleston, South Carolina on May 3, 2016, at 5:00 p.m., local 
time, and all adjournments of the Meeting. The accompanying Notice of Annual Meeting and this proxy 
statement are first being mailed to stockholders on or about April 1, 2016.

A
n
n
e
x
A

P
r
o
x
y

At the Meeting, stockholders of the Company are being asked to consider and vote upon the elec-
tion of four directors to serve for a term of three years and one director to serve for a term of one year, to 
approve an amendment to the Company’s Restated Certificate of Incorporation (the “Certificate of Incor-
poration”) to increase the number of shares of Common Stock the Company is authorized to issue from 
15,000,000 shares to 25,000,000 shares, and to ratify the appointment of Elliott Davis Decosimo, LLC as the 
independent registered public accounting firm for the Company for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2016.

Vote Required and Proxy Information

The  Board  of  Directors  set  March  18,  2016,  as  the  record  date  for  the  Meeting.  Stockholders 
 owning the Company’s Common Stock at the close of business on that date are entitled to vote and to 
attend the Meeting. As of the record date, there were 12,051,615 shares of Common Stock outstanding, 
which were held by 258 stockholders of record. Each share of the Company’s Common Stock is entitled to 
one vote on all matters voted on at the Meeting. If you are a registered stockholder who wishes to vote at 
the Meeting, you may do so by selecting one of the following options:

Voting by Proxy: You are requested to vote the enclosed form of proxy, which is solicited on behalf 
of the Board of Directors, either by Internet, telephone or by mail. Instructions regarding Internet and 
telephone voting are included on the proxy card. If you choose to submit a proxy by mail, please mark, 
sign and date the proxy card and return it in the enclosed postage-paid envelope. No postage is required if 
mailed within the United States. If you receive more than one proxy card, it means that you have multiple 
accounts at the transfer agent. Please vote all proxy cards to be certain that all your shares are voted.

Voting in Person: You may vote in person at the Meeting. We will distribute written ballots to any 

stockholder of record who wishes to vote at the Meeting.

Many  of  the  Company’s  stockholders  hold  their  shares  through  a  stockbroker,  bank,  or  other 
nominee rather than directly in their own name. If you hold the Company’s shares in a stock brokerage 

1

Annex AProxy 
account or by a bank or other nominee, you are considered the beneficial owner of shares held in street 
name, and these materials are being forwarded to you by your broker or nominee, which is considered the 
stockholder of record with respect to those shares. As the beneficial owner, you have the right to direct your 
broker or nominee how to vote and are also invited to attend the Meeting. However, since you are not the 
stockholder of record, you may not vote these shares in person at the Meeting unless you obtain a signed 
proxy from the stockholder of record giving you the right to vote the shares. Your broker or nominee has 
enclosed or provided a voting instruction card for you to use to direct your broker or nominee how to vote 
these shares.

If you hold your shares in street name, it is critical that you cast your vote if you want it to count 
in  the  election  of  the  Company’s  director  nominees  and  the  vote  on  the  amendment  to  the  Certificate 
of Incorporation. In the past, if you held your shares in street name and you did not indicate how you 
wanted your shares voted on certain matters, your bank or broker was allowed to vote those shares on 
your behalf as they felt appropriate. Your brokerage firm may now vote your shares only under certain 
circumstances. Brokerage firms have authority under stock exchange rules to vote their customers’ shares 
on certain  “routine” matters. We expect that brokers will be allowed to exercise discretionary authority for 
beneficial owners who have not provided voting instructions ONLY with respect to the ratification of the 
appointment of our independent registered public accounting firm, but not with respect to the election of 
directors or the proposal to amend the Certificate of Incorporation. If you hold your shares in street name, 
it is critical that you cast your vote so your shares may be voted on all proposals.

When a brokerage firm votes its customers’ unvoted shares on routine matters, these shares are 
counted for purposes of establishing a quorum to conduct business at the meeting. If a brokerage firm 
indicates on a proxy that it does not have discretionary authority to vote certain shares on a particular 
matter, then those shares will be treated as “broker non-votes.”

A majority or more of the outstanding shares of Common Stock entitled to vote at the Meeting 
will constitute a quorum. We will include abstentions and broker non-votes in determining whether a quo-
rum exists. If a share is represented for any purpose at the Meeting by the presence of the registered owner 
or a person holding a valid proxy for the registered owner, it is deemed to be present for the purposes of 
establishing a quorum. Therefore, valid proxies which are marked “Abstain” or “Withhold” or as to which 
no vote is marked, including broker non-votes, will be included in determining the number of votes present 
or represented at the Meeting.

Assuming in each case that a quorum is present:

•	

•	

 With  respect  to  Proposal  No.  1,  the  directors  will  be  elected  by  a  plurality  of  the  votes  of 
the shares of Common Stock present in person or represented by proxy at the Meeting and 
entitled to vote on the election of directors. This means that the individuals who receive the 
highest number of votes are selected as directors up to the maximum number of directors to 
be elected at the Meeting. Abstentions, broker non-votes, and the failure to return a signed 
proxy will have no effect on the outcome of the vote on this matter.

 With respect to Proposal No. 2, the amendment to the Company’s Certificate of Incorpora-
tion requires the approval of a majority of the outstanding shares of the Company’s Common 
Stock entitled to vote. Abstentions, broker non-votes, and the failure to return a signed proxy 
will have the effect of a “no” vote on Proposal No. 2.

2

•	

  With  respect  to  Proposal  No.  3,  the  proposal  will  be  approved  if  the  number  of  shares  of 
Common Stock voted in favor of the matter exceed the number of shares of Common Stock 
voted against the matter. Abstentions, broker non-votes, and the failure to return a signed 
proxy will have no effect on the outcome of the vote on this matter.

Any other matters that may be brought before the Meeting will be determined by a majority of 

the votes cast.

As of the record date, the Company’s directors and executive officers owned or were deemed to 
control approximately 15.50% of the Company’s Common Stock, and they have indicated that they intend 
to vote their shares for the election of the Company’s director nominees, for the amendment to the Com-
pany’s Certificate of Incorporation to increase the number of shares of Common Stock that the Company 
is authorized to issue from 15,000,000 shares to 25,000,000 shares, and for the ratification of Elliott Davis 
Decosimo, LLC as our independent registered public accounting firm for the fiscal year ended December 
31, 2016.

When  you  sign  the  proxy  card,  you  appoint  Robert  G.  Clawson  and  Robert  M.  Moïse  as  your 
representatives at the Meeting. Messrs. Clawson and Moïse will vote your proxy as you have instructed 
them on the proxy card. If you submit a proxy but do not specify how you would like it to be voted, Messrs. 
Clawson and Moïse will vote your proxy for the election to the Board of Directors of all the nominees list-
ed below under “Election of Directors,” for the amendment to the Company’s Certificate of Incorporation 
to increase the number of shares of Common Stock the Company is authorized to issue from 15,000,000 
shares to 25,000,000 shares, and for the ratification of the appointment of Elliott Davis Decosimo, LLC as 
the independent registered public accounting firm for the Company for the fiscal year ending December 
31, 2016. The Company is not aware of any other matters to be considered at the Meeting. However, if any 
other matters come before the Meeting, Messrs. Clawson and Moïse will vote your proxy on such matters 
in accordance with their judgment.

A proxy given pursuant to the solicitation may be revoked at any time before it is voted. Proxies 
may be revoked by (i) filing with the Secretary of the Company at or before the Meeting a written notice 
of revocation bearing a later date than the proxy, (ii) duly executing a subsequent proxy relating to the 
same shares and delivering it to the Secretary of the Company at or before the Meeting, or (iii) attending 
the Meeting and voting in person (although attendance at the Meeting will not in and of itself constitute 
revocation of a proxy). Any written notice revoking a proxy before the Meeting should be delivered to  
M.  J.  Huggins,  III,  Secretary,  Carolina  Financial  Corporation,  288  Meeting  Street,  Charleston,  South 
Carolina 29401.

The Company is paying for the costs of preparing and mailing the proxy materials and of reimburs-
ing brokers and others for their expenses of forwarding copies of the proxy materials to its stockholders. 
Our officers and employees may assist in soliciting proxies but will not receive additional compensation for 
doing so. The Company is distributing this proxy statement on or about April 1, 2016.

Important  Notice  of  Internet  Availability.  The  proxy  statement  and  the  Company’s  2015  Annual 
Report on Form 10-K are available to the public for viewing under the Investor Relations section under 
the Governance Documents tab of the Company’s website https://www.haveanicebank.com.

In addition, the above items and other filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the 
“SEC”) are also available to the public on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov. Upon written or oral request 

3

Annex AProxyby any stockholder, we will deliver a copy of the Company’s 2015 Annual Report on Form 10-K. Only one 
copy of the Company’s proxy materials is being delivered to two or more stockholders who share an ad-
dress. However, upon written or oral request, we will also promptly deliver a copy of this proxy statement 
to the Company’s stockholders at a shared address to which a single copy of the document was delivered. 
Stockholders should contact M. J. Huggins, III, Secretary, Carolina Financial Corporation, 288 Meeting 
Street Charleston, South Carolina 29401 or at (843) 723-7700 if they wish to receive an additional copy of 
the Company’s proxy materials. Alternatively, any stockholders sharing an address and currently receiving 
multiple copies of the proxy materials may request that a single copy of the proxy materials be provided 
their shared address.

4

PROPOSAL I - ELECTION OF DIRECTORS

General Information Regarding Election of Directors

The Company’s Board of Directors is proposed to be comprised of 11 members and divided into 
three classes. Directors of the Company are generally elected to serve for a three-year term. The terms are 
staggered in order to provide for the election of approximately one-third of the directors each year. The 
Company’s Bylaws provide for an age limitation in that no person who has reached the age of 75 years may 
be elected or appointed to a term of office as a director.

Class I

Class II

Class III

Robert M. Moïse, CPA

W. Scott Brandon

Robert G. Clawson, Jr

David L. Morrow

Jerold L. Rexroad

Claudius E. Watts IV

Jeffery L. Deal, M.D.

Michael P. Leddy

Thompson E. Penney

G. Manly Eubank

Daniel H. Isaac, Jr.

At the Meeting, stockholders will elect four nominees as Class II directors to serve a three-year 
term, expiring at the 2019 Annual Meeting of Stockholders of the Company, and one nominee as a Class 
III director to serve for a one-year term, expiring at the 2017 Annual Meeting of Stockholders of the Com-
pany. The directors will be elected by a plurality of the votes cast at the Meeting. This means that the five 
nominees receiving the highest number of votes will be elected. Abstentions and broker non-votes with 
respect to the nominees will not be considered to be either affirmative or negative votes. Stockholders do 
not have cumulative voting rights with respect to the election of directors.

The Board of Directors recommends that you elect Messrs. Brandon, Deal, Leddy, and Penney as 

Class II directors and Mr. Isaac as a Class III director.

Three of the Company’s current Class II directors – Howell V. Bellamy, Jr., Benedict P. Rosen, 
and Bonum S. Wilson, Jr. – will not stand for re-election. Each of their terms as a director will expire at 
the Meeting.

If you submit a proxy but do not specify how you would like it to be voted, Messrs. Clawson and 
Moïse will vote your proxy to elect Messrs. Brandon, Deal, Isaac, Leddy, and Penney. If any of these nom-
inees are unable or fails to accept nomination or election (which we do not anticipate), Messrs. Clawson 
and Moïse will vote instead for a replacement to be recommended by the Board of Directors, unless you 
specifically instruct otherwise in the proxy.

Information on Nominees 

Set forth below is certain information about the nominees, including their age, the period they 
have served as a director or executive officer, their business experience for at least the past five years, the 
names of other publicly-held companies where they currently serve as a director or served as a director 
during the past five years, and additional information about the specific experience, qualifications, attri-
butes, or skills that led to the Board of Directors’ conclusion that such person should serve as a director 
for the Company.

5

Annex AProxyW. Scott Brandon, 52, has served as a member of the Company’s Board of Directors since 2001. 
Mr. Brandon is owner and CEO of The Brandon Agency, South Carolina’s largest independently owned 
advertising agency. He is also owner of Intellistrand, an internet marketing company that buys, sells and 
monetizes intuitive domain names on the internet as well as Fuel Interactive, South Carolina’s first and 
largest  interactive-only  advertising  agency.  He  holds  a  Bachelor  of  Science  degree  in  Economics  from 
Davidson College and a Juris Doctor degree from the University of South Carolina School of Law. Mr. 
Brandon is a 2012 recipient of The American Advertising Federation’s Silver Medal Award for his out-
standing contributions to advertising and creative excellence. Mr. Brandon currently serves on the Board 
of  Directors  for  the  Myrtle  Beach  Area  Recovery  Council  and  the  Myrtle  Beach  Regional  Economic 
Development Corporation. He is a past member of the Horry-Georgetown Technical College Board of 
Visitors, past board member of The E. Craig Wall School of Business Administration Board of Visitors, 
past  board  member  of  the  American  Heart  Association  (Coastal  Chapter),  past  board  member  of  the 
Better Business Bureau, past board member of the Salvation Army Horry County as well as the Myrtle 
Beach Haven. He is a current member of Young Presidents Organization and Chief Executives Organi-
zation. Mr. Brandon has substantial leadership and financial experience as founder of several successful 
businesses and is extensively involved in the local community, both of which enhance his ability to serve on 
the Company’s Board of Directors.

Jeffery L. Deal, M.D. 61, has served as a member of the Company’s Board of Directors since 1996. 
Dr. Deal is an anthropologist and physician and served as Director of Health Studies for Water Missions 
International, a non-profit non-governmental organization that provides water and sanitation for devel-
oping areas. Dr. Deal is a founding partner of Charleston ENT, and previously served as President of the 
Medical Staff of Bon Secours-St. Francis Hospital, Medical Director of a startup medical facility in South 
Sudan, and several other related positions. Dr. Deal is a Fellow in the American College of Surgeons, a 
Fellow in the American Academy of Otolaryngology - Head and Neck Surgery, and a Fellow in the Royal 
Society of Tropical Medicine. Dr. Deal is a graduate of the Medical University of South Carolina and com-
pleted his residency at the National Naval Medical Center in Bethesda, Maryland. He brings to the Board 
of Directors insights relative to the challenges and opportunities facing small businesses and healthcare 
professionals within the Company’s market areas.

Daniel  H.  Isaac,  Jr.,  64,  has  served  as  a  member  of  the  Board  of  Directors  of  the  Company’s 
wholly-owned subsidiary, CresCom Bank, since 2001. Mr. Isaac is founder and co-owner of A&I Fire and 
Water Restoration. He holds a Bachelor of Science degree from The Citadel in Charleston, South Caroli-
na. Mr. Isaac has been involved in numerous local and state organizations. He previously served as Chair-
man of the Myrtle Beach Chamber of Commerce and the South Carolina Department of Transportation.  
Mr. Isaac’s qualification to serve on the Company’s Board of Directors is attributable primarily to his ex-
perience of founding a successful business and his involvement in many leadership positions.

Michael P. Leddy, 72, has served as a member of the Company’s Board of Directors since 2013. 
Prior to joining the Board of Directors, Mr. Leddy was the President and Chief Executive Officer of Cres-
cent Mortgage Company from 2008 until 2011. Mr. Leddy has more than 40 years of mortgage banking 
experience and was a founding team member in the formation of Arvida Mortgage, a subsidiary of Walt 
Disney  Productions.  Mr.  Leddy  was  briefly  retired  from  2011  until  he  joined  the  Company’s  Board  of 
 Directors in 2013. Mr. Leddy served in the U.S. Navy on board the USS Thomas Jefferson. Mr. Leddy 
holds a Bachelors of Science degree in finance from University of Central Florida and a Juris Doctor de-
gree from Atlanta Law School. Mr. Leddy’s qualification as a member of the Board of Directors is primar-
ily attributed to his experience in founding two mortgage companies and previously holding the position of 
CEO of Crescent Mortgage Company, as well as his vast knowledge of the mortgage industry.

6

Thompson E. “Thom” Penney, 65, has served as a member of the Company’s Board of Directors 
since 2013. Mr. Penney is the Chairman of the Board and President/CEO (a position he has held since 
1989) of LS3P, a multi-disciplinary firm offering architecture, planning, and interior architecture services 
to clients throughout the U. S. With more than 275 personnel throughout the seven Southeastern offices, 
he is responsible for overall firm management, organizational vision, successful integration of professional 
services, marketing, and operations of the firm. Mr. Penney has more than 41 years of experience in the 
architectural  field  and  under  his  leadership,  LS3P  has  grown  to  become  a  firm  consistently  recognized 
by Engineering News and Record as one of the Top 500 Design Firms and Top 50 Architectural Firms 
in  the  United  States.  A  graduate  of  Clemson  University  with  a  bachelor’s  degree  (1972)  and  master’s 
degree (1974) in architecture, Penney received the Alumni Distinguished Service Award from Clemson 
 University, was recipient of the AIA South Carolina Medal of Distinction, its highest honor, he has re-
ceived  the  Joseph  P.  Riley  Leadership  Award  from  the  Charleston  Metro  Chamber  and  was  honored 
with the Award for Ethics and Civic Responsibility from The Free Enterprise Foundation. Mr. Penney 
generously volunteers his time to his profession and community, having served as National President of 
The American Institute of Architects (2003); Chairman of the Charleston Metro Chamber of Commerce 
(2008), and is current Co-Chair of the National AIA-AGC Joint Committee. He is also on the Boards 
of the South Carolina Aquarium, the  Charleston  Regional Development  Alliance,  the AIA large Firm 
Roundtable, and is Vice Chair of the Trident CEO Council. His qualifications as a member of the Board 
of Directors is attributed to his business expertise within the Company’s market areas.

THE  BOARD  OF  DIRECTORS  RECOMMENDS  THAT  STOCKHOLDERS  VOTE  “FOR” 

EACH OF THE NOMINEES LISTED IN THIS PROXY STATEMENT.

Information of Other Directors and Executive Officers 

Set forth below is also information about each of the Company’s other directors and executive 
officers, including their age, the period they have served as a director or executive officer, their business 
experience for at least the past five years, the names of other publicly-held companies where they currently 
serve as a director or served as a director during the past five years, and additional information about the 
specific experience, qualifications, attributes, or skills that led to the board’s conclusion that such person 
should serve as a director for the Company. 

Jerold L. Rexroad, 55, has served as the Company’s President and Chief Executive Officer since 
2012 and as a director since 2012. Mr. Rexroad also serves as Executive Chairman of the Board of the Bank 
and Executive Chairman of the Board of Crescent Mortgage Company. Mr. Rexroad joined the Compa-
ny in May 2008 as Executive Vice President. Mr. Rexroad began his career in 1982 with Peat, Marwick, 
Mitchell and Co., a predecessor to the international accounting firm KPMG LLP, and is a Certified Public 
Accountant. He became a KPMG partner in 1994 with responsibilities for all financial institutions in South 
Carolina. In 1995, Mr. Rexroad joined Coastal Financial Corporation as  Executive Vice President and 
Chief Financial Officer. Under his oversight, the bank grew organically from $375 million in total assets to 
over $1.8 billion in total assets. Coastal Financial Corporation was sold to BB&T in 2007. Mr. Rexroad is a 
member of the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants and the South Carolina Association of 
Certified Public Accountants. Mr. Rexroad is a graduate of Bob Jones University, cum laude. Mr. Rexroad 
is a director of the Myrtle Beach Economic Development Corporation. His leadership experience, includ-
ing over 30 years of experience in public accounting and financial institution management, as well as his 
service as the chief financial officer of a public bank holding company, enhance his ability to serve on the 
Company’s Board of Directors. These roles have required industry expertise combined with operational 
and global management expertise.

7

Annex AProxyDavid L. Morrow, 65, has served as an Executive Vice President of the Company since 2004 and 
has  served  as  a  member  of  the  Company’s  Board  of  Directors  since  2001.  Mr.  Morrow  is  a  graduate 
of Clemson University with a Bachelor of Science degree and has more than 41 years of experience in 
banking and financial institution management in South Carolina. Prior to founding Crescent Bank, a pre-
decessor to CresCom Bank, he served as President of Carolina First Savings Bank and also as Executive 
Vice President and member of the Board of Directors of Carolina First Bank. He is currently a member 
of the Clemson University Board of Visitors, a member of the Board of Directors and Treasurer for the 
S.C. Bankers Association (SCBA) and a member of the Board of Advisors of the Hollings Cancer Center 
at the Medical University of South Carolina. Most recently, Mr. Morrow was also named to a three-year 
appointment with the Federal Reserve Community Depository Institutions Advisory Council (CDIAC), as 
well as the ABA Community Bankers Council. He is also a past Board member of the Storm Eye Institute 
at the Medical University of South Carolina, a past member of the Board of Directors of Leadership South 
Carolina and a past member of the Board of Directors for the South Carolina Museum Foundation. His 
40+ years of experience in financial institution management, including previous service as a director of a 
state-wide financial institution and CEO of both predecessor banks of CresCom Bank, provide a valuable 
perspective as a director.

G. Manly Eubank, 79, has served as a member of the Company’s Board of Directors since 1996 
and currently serves as the Chairman of the Company’s Board of Directors. Mr. Eubank is Chairman of 
Palmetto Ford, Inc. and has been in the automotive business in Charleston for over 46 years. Mr. Eubank 
previously served as President of the Charleston Metro Chamber of Commerce and President of the South 
Carolina Automobile Dealers Association. Mr. Eubank is a graduate of Wofford College. His experience 
as the founder of a successful business and his involvement in leadership positions in his trade organiza-
tion enhance his ability to serve on the Board of Directors.

Robert M. Moïse, 67, has served as a member of the Company’s Board of Directors since 1996. 
Mr. Moïse is a partner with WebsterRogers LLP in the Charleston office. He holds Bachelor of Science 
and  Master  of  Accountancy  degrees  from  the  University  of  South  Carolina  and  has  been  admitted  to 
practice before the United States Tax Court. He serves as President of the Coastal Council BSA and is 
the Secretary of the Coastal Boys Council Board. He is a member of the American Institute of Certified 
Public Accountants, serving on their national Tax Practice Responsibilities Committee and is a member 
of the South Carolina Association of Certified Public Accountants. Mr. Moïse also continues to serve as 
a member of the Charleston County Business License Appeals Board. In his professional practice, Mr. 
Moïse has, after leaving the Internal Revenue Service, worked with national and local CPA firms and has 
concentrated his practice in the tax area with an emphasis on tax controversy matters and complicated 
mergers, acquisitions and liquidations for many clients around the state. Mr. Moïse brings to the board 
his 40 years of financial expertise and business skills. Mr. Moïse’s finance and accounting expertise also 
qualify  him  to  serve  as  Chairman  of  the  Company’s  Audit  Committee  and  to  be  considered  an  “audit 
committee financial expert.”

Robert G. Clawson, Jr., 73, has served as a member of the Company’s Board of Directors since 
1996. Mr. Clawson is a founding member of the law firm of Clawson and Staubes, LLC, and is a member 
of the South Carolina State Bar, the American Bar Association, the Metropolitan Exchange Club, and The 
Hibernian Society. Mr. Clawson is admitted to practice law before the South Carolina Supreme Court, the 
U.S. District Court for the District of South Carolina, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Fourth Circuit, the 
U.S. Court of Federal Claims, the U.S. Tax Court, and the U.S. Court of International Trade. Mr. Clawson 
previously served as President of the South Carolina Municipal Attorneys Association and the College of 
Charleston Cougar Club. He is a graduate of the University of North Carolina and the University of South 

8

Carolina School of Law. Mr. Clawson’s qualification as a member of the Board of Directors is primarily 
attributed to his experience in founding a successful law practice and his extensive legal experience.

Claudius E. “Bud” Watts IV, 54, has served as a member of the Company’s Board of Directors 
since 2015. Mr. Watts is a Partner and Managing Director of The Carlyle Group where he specializes in 
control equity investments in larger companies focused on software, software enabled services, semicon-
ductors, and electronic systems. Mr. Watts established the firm’s Technology Buyout Group in 2004 and 
led it until 2014. Mr. Watts led Carlyle’s investment in, and, currently serves on the Board of Directors of, 
CommScope (NASDAQ: COMM), where he has served as Director since 2011. Previously, Mr. Watts led 
Carlyle’s investments in and served on the Boards of Directors of technology companies SS&C Technol-
ogies, Open Link Financial, Open Solutions, Freescale Semiconductor, and Jazz Semiconductor, as well 
as aerospace companies Firth Rixon, Sippican, and CPU Technology. In addition to his current business 
activities, Mr. Watts also serves as the Chairman of the Board of The Citadel Foundation and The Citadel 
Trust, which manage the primary endowment funds supporting The Citadel. Prior to joining Carlyle in 
2000, Mr. Watts was a Managing Director in the Mergers & Acquisitions group of First Union Securities, 
Inc. He joined First Union Securities when First Union acquired Bowles Hollowell Conner & Co., where 
Mr. Watts was a principal. Prior to joining Bowles Hollowell, Mr. Watts was a fighter pilot in the U.S. Air 
Force. During his service, he was qualified as an instructor pilot in both the F-16 and A-10 aircraft and 
served in a number of leadership and operations management positions in the United States and abroad. 
Mr. Watts earned a B.S. in electrical engineering cum laude from The Citadel in Charleston, South Caro-
lina, and an M.B.A. from the Harvard Graduate School of Business Administration.

Other than Messrs. Morrow and Rexroad, for which disclosure is provided above, the following 

provides information regarding the Company’s other executive officers:

William  A.  Gehman,  III,  55,  has  served  as  the  Company’s  Executive  Vice  President  and  Chief 
 Financial Officer since 2012. Prior to being promoted to Chief Financial officer, Mr. Gehman was the Com-
pany’s Controller from 2008 to 2012. Mr. Gehman is also the Chief Financial Officer of the Bank, Crescent 
Mortgage Company and Carolina Services Corporation. Mr. Gehman, a Certified Public Accountant with 
over 13 years of experience in financial institutions, spent over nine years with Peat, Marwick, Mitchell & 
Co., a predecessor to the international CPA firm, KPMG. Mr. Gehman was also the Chief Financial Officer 
or Controller with other companies, after which he joined Coastal Financial Corporation in 2002 as Senior 
Vice President and Corporate Controller, where his responsibilities included public and regulatory report-
ing. Mr. Gehman is a member of the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants and the South Car-
olina Association of Certified Public Accountants. Mr. Gehman is a graduate of Liberty Baptist College.

M.  J.  Huggins,  III,  53,  has  served  as  the  Company’s  Executive  Vice  President  since  2010  and 
Secretary since 2012. Mr. Huggins is also a founding board member and former President, Chief Credit 
Officer and Secretary of Crescent Bank. Prior to joining the Company and assisting in the founding of 
Crescent Bank, Mr. Huggins served as Area Executive and Senior Vice President of Carolina First Bank, 
responsible  for  commercial  and  retail  operations  from  Georgetown  to  Myrtle  Beach,  South  Carolina. 
Prior to his tenure with Carolina First Bank, Mr. Huggins worked for C&S Bank. Mr. Huggins is a board 
member of the Wall College Board of Visitors at Coastal Carolina University. Mr. Huggins is a graduate 
of Coastal Carolina University (Wall College Alumnus of the Year in 2003) and The Graduate School of 
Banking at Louisiana State University.

Fowler  Williams,  41,  has  served  as  the  President  of  Crescent  Mortgage  Company  as  well  as  a 
Director of Crescent Mortgage Company since 2011. In 2016, Mr. Williams was promoted to CEO and 
President of Crescent Mortgage Company. In his 16 years at Crescent Mortgage Company, Mr. Williams 

9

Annex AProxyhas previously worked as National Sales Manager and Executive Vice President over Sales and Opera-
tions. Mr. Williams holds the highest designation in the mortgage industry as a Certified Mortgage Banker 
(CMB). Mr. Williams serves as Chairman of the Mortgage Action Alliance (MAA), the grassroots policy, 
advocacy and lobbying network for the real estate finance industry. Mr. Williams also has been named 
2015-2016 Chairman of the Community Bank and Credit Union Network (CBCUN) for the MBA where 
he serves on the Independent Mortgage Bankers Executive Counsel and the Regulatory Compliance Com-
mittee. Mr. Williams also has been named to the Customer Advisory Board of Freddie Mac, both the QM 
and TRID regulatory implementation committees for the MBA, and was named to the forty most influen-
tial mortgage professionals under 40 by National Mortgage Professional magazine for the past two years.

Family and Business Relationships. No director has a family relationship with any other director or 

executive officer of the Company.

10

PROPOSAL II — AMENDMENT OF THE CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION 
TO INCREASE THE NUMBER OF AUTHORIZED SHARES OF 
COMMON STOCK

The Board of Directors of the Company has adopted a resolution proposing an amendment to 
the Certificate of Incorporation to increase the number of the Company’s authorized shares of Common 
Stock from 15,000,000 shares to 25,000,000 shares. Stockholders are being asked to increase the Compa-
ny’s authorized shares of Common Stock in order to have shares available for potential transactions.

Reasons for Amendment

The Company’s Certificate of Incorporation currently provides for 15,000,000 shares of autho-
rized Common Stock and 1,000,000 shares of authorized Preferred Stock, of which 12,051,615 and zero 
shares, respectively, were issued and outstanding at the close of business on March 18, 2016.

The Board of Directors believes that the number of authorized but unissued shares of Common 
Stock is not adequate to enable the Company, as the need may arise, to take advantage of market con-
ditions and favorable opportunities involving the issuance of the Common Stock without the delay and 
expense associated with the holding of a special meeting of the Company’s stockholders. The availability 
of additional authorized shares will provide the Company with the flexibility in the future to issue shares 
of Common Stock for corporate purposes such as acquisitions, raising additional capital, paying dividends 
or effecting stock splits, providing equity incentives to employees, officers and directors, and other general 
corporate purposes.

Effect on Outstanding Common Stock

Authorized but unissued shares of Common Stock may be issued from time to time upon authori-
zation by the Board of Directors, at such times, to such persons and for such consideration as the Board of 
Directors may determine in its discretion and generally without further approval by stockholders, except 
as may be required for a particular transaction by applicable law, regulation or stock exchange rules. When 
and if such shares are issued, they would have the same voting and other rights and privileges as the cur-
rently issued and outstanding shares of Common Stock.

The authorization of the additional shares would not, by itself, have any effect on the rights of 
stockholders. However, holders of Common Stock have no preemptive rights to acquire additional shares 
of the Common Stock and thus the issuance of additional shares of Common Stock for corporate purposes 
other than a stock split or stock dividend would have a dilutive effect on the ownership and voting rights 
of the stockholders at the time of issuance.

Increasing the number of authorized shares of Common Stock could adversely affect the ability 
of third parties to take over or change the control of the Company. It is possible that an increase in autho-
rized shares could render such an acquisition more difficult under certain circumstances or discourage an 
attempt by a third party to obtain control of the Company by making possible the issuance of shares that 
would dilute the share ownership of a person attempting to obtain control or otherwise make it difficult to 
obtain any required stockholder approval for a proposed transaction for control. However, the Board of 
Directors is not aware of any attempts to take control of the Company and has not presented this Proposal 
II with the intent that it be utilized as an anti-takeover device.

11

Annex AProxyThe text of Article Four, Paragraph A, as it is proposed to be amended, is set forth as Exhibit A 
to this proxy statement. The affirmative vote of a majority of the outstanding shares of Common Stock 
entitled to vote hereon is required to approve this amendment.

THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS RECOMMENDS THAT STOCKHOLDERS VOTE “FOR” THE 
AMENDMENT  OF  THE  CERTIFICATE  OF  INCORPORATION  TO  INCREASE  THE  NUMBER  OF 
AUTHORIZED SHARES OF COMMON STOCK.

12

PROPOSAL III – RATIFICATION OF APPOINTMENT OF THE
INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

Our Audit Committee has appointed Elliott Davis Decosimo, LLC to be the Company’s indepen-
dent registered public accounting firm for the fiscal year ending December 31, 2016, subject to the ratifica-
tion of the appointment by the Company’s stockholders. Representatives of Elliott Davis Decosimo, LLC 
are expected to attend the Meeting to respond to appropriate questions and to make a statement if they so 
desire. Although stockholder ratification of the appointment of the registered public accounting firm for the 
Company is not required by the Company’s Bylaws or otherwise, the Company is submitting the selection of 
Elliott Davis Decosimo, LLC to its stockholders for ratification to permit stockholders to participate in this 
important corporate decision. If not ratified, the Audit Committee will reconsider the selection, although the 
Audit Committee will not be required to select a different independent registered public accounting firm.

THE  BOARD  OF  DIRECTORS  RECOMMENDS  THAT  STOCKHOLDERS  VOTE  “FOR” 
THE  RATIFICATION  OF  THE  APPOINTMENT  OF  ELLIOTT  DAVIS  DECOSIMO,  LLC  AS  THE 
 COMPANY’S  INDEPENDENT  REGISTERED  PUBLIC  ACCOUNTING  FIRM  FOR  THE  FISCAL 
YEAR ENDING DECEMBER 31, 2016.

Board Leadership Structure and Role in Risk Oversight

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE 

The  Board  of  Directors  is  focused  on  the  Company’s  corporate  governance  practices  and  val-
ue independent board oversight as an essential component of strong corporate performance to enhance 
stockholder value. The Board of Directors’ commitment to independent oversight is demonstrated by the 
fact that the majority of the Company’s directors are independent.

The Company believes that it is preferable for an independent director to serve as Chairman of 
the Board of Directors. The director elected as Chairman, G. Manly Eubank, has been one of the Compa-
ny’s directors since 1996 and is a long-time resident of the Company’s primary market area. The Company 
believes it is the Chief Executive Officer’s responsibility to run the Company and the Chairman’s responsi-
bility to run the Board of Directors. As directors continue to have more oversight responsibility than ever 
before, the Company believes it is beneficial to have an independent Chairman whose sole job is leading 
the Board of Directors. In making its decision to have an independent Chairman, the Company consid-
ered the time that Mr. Rexroad will be required to devote as Chief Executive Officer of the Company. By 
having another director serve as Chairman of the Board of Directors, Mr. Rexroad will be able to focus 
his entire energy on running the Company. This will also ensure there is no duplication of effort between 
the Chief Executive Officer and the Chairman. The Company believes this structure provides strong lead-
ership for the Board of Directors, while also positioning the Chief Executive Officer as the leader of the 
Company in the eyes of the Company’s customers, employees, and other stakeholders.

Risk  oversight  is  the  responsibility  of  the  Board  of  Directors  collectively  and  individually.  The 
Board  of  Directors  fulfills  this  responsibility  through  a  combination  of  oversight  with  respect  to  direct 
board reports from management and the delegation of specific risk monitoring to its committees, which in 
turn provide reports to the full Board of Directors at each regular meeting. Notwithstanding the foregoing, 
the Board of Directors believes that its role is one of oversight, recognizing that management is responsi-
ble for executing the Company’s risk management policies.

At each regular meeting, the Board of Directors’ standing agenda requires reports from the Chief 
Financial  Officer  and  other  executive  officers,  who  collectively  are  responsible  for  all  risk  areas.  Their 
agenda items are designed to elicit information with respect to each of these areas. The Board of Directors 

13

Annex AProxydoes not concentrate the delegation of its responsibility for risk oversight in a single committee. Instead, 
each of the Board of Directors’ committees concentrates on specific risks for which its members have an 
expertise, and each committee is required to regularly report to the Board of Directors on its findings. The 
Company believes this division of responsibility is the most effective approach for addressing the risks it 
faces and that the Board of Directors leadership structure supports this approach.

The Company recognizes that different board leadership structures may be appropriate for com-
panies in different situations. The Company will continue to reexamine its corporate governance policies 
and leadership structures on an ongoing basis to ensure that they continue to meet the Company’s needs.

Director Independence

The Board of Directors annually evaluates the independence of its members based on Item 407(a) 
of Regulation S-K and NASDAQ Rule 5605(a)(2). In addition, the Board of Directors annually evaluates 
the independence of its Audit Committee and Compensation Committee members based on NASDAQ 
Rules 5605(c)(2) and (d)(2), respectively. The Company’s corporate governance guidelines and principles 
require that a majority of the Board of Directors be composed of directors who meet the requirements for 
independence established by these standards. The Board of Directors has concluded that the Company 
has a majority of independent directors and that the Board of Directors meets the standards of NASDAQ 
Rule 5605(a)(2). The Board of Directors has also concluded that the members of the Audit Committee 
meet the standards of NASDAQ Rule 5605(c)(2) and that the members of the Compensation Committee 
meet the standards of NASDAQ Rule 5605(d)(2).

The Board of Directors has determined that Messrs. Brandon, Clawson, Deal, Eubank, Isaac (if 
elected), Leddy, Moïse, Penney and Watts are independent taking into account the matters discussed un-
der “Certain Relationships and Related Transactions.” Mr. Rexroad, the Company’s President and Chief 
Executive Officer, and Mr. Morrow, the Company’s Executive Vice President, are not considered to be 
independent as they are also executive officers of the Company.

Meetings and Committees of the Board of Directors

During 2015, the Board of Directors held six regular and special meetings. Each of the current di-
rectors attended at least 75% of the aggregate of such board meetings and meetings of each committee on 
which they served for the periods during which they served. The Board of Directors has not implemented a 
formal policy regarding director attendance at the Company’s Annual Meeting of Stockholders, although 
each director is expected to attend all Annual Meetings of Stockholders absent unusual or extenuating 
circumstances. All of the Company’s directors attended the 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders.

The Board of Directors has standing Executive, Audit, Compensation, Corporate Governance/
Nominating, Finance and Capital Allocation, each of which is described in more detail below. The Board 
of  Directors  previously  also  had  a  Mergers  and  Acquisitions  Committee;  however,  in  March  2015,  the 
Mergers and Acquisitions Committee was rolled into the Executive Committee.

Executive Committee

The Executive Committee is responsible for, among other things, exercising authority on behalf of 
the Board of Directors when it is otherwise impracticable for the full Board of Directors to act. The Exec-
utive Committee is composed of 10 members: Messrs. Eubank, Brandon, Deal, Moïse, Morrow, Penney, 
Rexroad, Rosen, Watts, and Wilson. The Executive Committee met nine times during the 2015 fiscal year.

14

The Executive Committee functions are set forth in its charter, which was adopted on April 24, 
2013. A copy of the Executive Committee Charter may be found under the Investor Relations section un-
der the Governance Documents tab of the Company’s website, https://www.haveanicebank.com.

Audit Committee

The Audit Committee is responsible for the review of the Company’s annual audit report prepared 
by the Company’s independent registered public accounting firm. The Audit Committee is composed of 
six members: Messrs. Moïse, Bellamy, Deal, Leddy, Watts, and Wilson, each of whom is a non-manage-
ment director. The Audit Committee met five times during the 2015 fiscal year.

The  Audit  Committee’s  review  includes  a  detailed  discussion  with  the  independent  registered 
public  accounting  firm  and  recommendation  to  the  full  Board  of  Directors  concerning  any  action 
to  be  taken  regarding  the  audit.  The  Audit  Committee  also  has  the  authority  to  conduct  or  authorize  
investigations into any matters within its scope of responsibility. The Audit Committee is empowered to:

•	

 appoint, compensate, retain, and oversee the work of any registered public accounting firm 
employed by the Company for the purpose of preparing or issuing an audit report or perform-
ing other audit, review, or attest services for the Company, with any such registered public 
accounting firm reporting directly to the Audit Committee;

•	

 resolve any disagreements between management and the independent registered public ac-
counting firm regarding financial reporting;

•	 pre-approve all external audit services;

•	

•	

 retain independent counsel, accountants, or others to advise the committee or assist in the 
conduct of an investigation;

 meet with the Company’s officers, employees, independent registered public accounting firm, 
or outside counsel as deemed necessary.

Under  its  charter,  all  members  of  the  Audit  Committee  must  be  independent  members.  Each 
of the current Audit Committee members is independent under NASDAQ rules. The Audit Committee 
Charter provides that at least one member of the committee shall be a “financial expert.” The financial 
expert on the Audit Committee is Robert M. Moïse.

The Audit Committee functions are set forth in its charter, which was adopted on June 18, 2014. 
A copy of the Audit Committee Charter may be found under the Investor Relations section under the 
Governance Documents tab of the Company’s website, https://www.haveanicebank.com.

Audit Committee Matters 

Report of the Audit Committee of the Board of Directors

The report of the Audit Committee shall not be deemed incorporated by reference by any general 
statement incorporating by reference this proxy statement into any filing under the Securities Act of 1933 
or the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, except to the extent that the Company specifically incorporates the 
information contained in the report by reference, and shall not be deemed filed under such acts.

15

Annex AProxyThe Audit Committee reviewed and discussed with management the audited financial statements. 
The Audit Committee also discussed with its independent registered public accounting firm those matters 
required to be discussed by the independent registered public accounting firm with the Audit Committee 
under the rules adopted by the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (the “PCAOB”). The Audit 
Committee received from the independent registered public accounting firm the written disclosures and 
letters required by applicable requirements of the PCAOB regarding the firm’s independence and has dis-
cussed with the firm its independence from the Company and its management. In reliance on the reviews 
and discussions referred to above, the Audit Committee recommended to the Board of Directors that the 
audited financial statements be included in the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year 
ended December 31, 2015 for filing with the SEC.

The report of the Audit Committee is included herein at the direction of its members, Messrs. 

Moïse, Bellamy, Deal, Leddy, Watts, and Wilson.

Independent Certified Public Accountants

Elliott  Davis  Decosimo,  LLC  was  the  Company’s  independent  certified  public  accountants 
during the fiscal years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014 and provided Audit and Audit-related ser-
vices. For the fiscal years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, Porter Keadle Moore, LLC provided tax 
services to the Company. Representatives of Elliott Davis Decosimo, LLC are expected to be present at 
the Meeting to respond to appropriate questions and to make a statement if they so desire. The following 
table shows the fees that the Company paid for services performed in the fiscal year ended December 31, 
2015 and 2014:

Audit Fees

Tax Fees

Audit-Related fees

Total

Year Ended 
December 31, 2015

Year Ended 
December 31, 2014

$

$

239,100    

$

82,845    

64,180   
386,125   

$

177,500

93,845

49,515

320,860

Audit Fees. This category includes the aggregate fees billed for professional services rendered by 
the Company’s independent registered public accounting firm during the 2015 and 2014 fiscal years for the 
audit of the Company’s annual financial statements, internal financial reporting controls under FDICIA, 
HUD audits, annual reports on Form 10-K, and quarterly reports on Form 10-Q.

Tax Fees. This category includes the aggregate fees billed for professional services rendered by the 

principal accountant for tax compliance, tax advice, and tax planning.

Audit-Related Fees. For 2015, audit-related fees consisted of services rendered in connection with 
the filing of SEC forms S-8, S-3, and S-4. For 2014, audit-related fees consisted of services rendered in 
connection with the filing of the Form S-8, Form 10, and the audit of the financial information submitted 
in connection with the Company’s acquisition of branches.

16

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Corporate Governance/Nominating Committee

The Corporate Governance/Nominating Committee is responsible for identifying potential direc-
tors and presenting them for nomination to the Board of Directors. The Corporate Governance/Nominat-
ing Committee is composed of six members: Messrs. Deal, Clawson, Leddy, Penney, Rosen and Wilson. 
The Corporate Governance/Nominating Committee met two times during the 2015 fiscal year.

Potential  director  candidates  may  come  to  the  attention  of  the  Corporate  Governance/Nomi-
nating Committee through current members of the Board of Directors, stockholders, or other persons. 
In evaluating such recommendations, the Corporate Governance/Nominating Committee uses the qual-
ifications and standards discussed below and seeks to achieve a balance of knowledge, experience, and 
capability on the Board of Directors. The Company does not pay a third party to assist in identifying and 
evaluating potential director candidates.

The Corporate Governance/Nominating Committee recommends to the Board of Directors cri-
teria for the selection of new directors, evaluates the qualifications and independence of potential candi-
dates for directors, including any nominees submitted by stockholders, in accordance with the provisions 
of the Company’s certificate of incorporation and bylaws, and recommends to the Board of Directors a 
slate of nominees for election by the stockholders at the annual meeting of stockholders. The Corporate 
Governance/Nominating Committee is also responsible for recommending to the Board of Directors any 
nominees to be considered to fill a vacancy or a newly created directorship resulting from any increase in 
the authorized number of directors. When considering a person to be recommended for nomination as a 
director, the Corporate Governance/Nominating Committee considers, among other factors, the skills and 
background needed by the Company and possessed by the person, diversity of the Board of Directors, and 
the ability of the person to devote the necessary time to service as a director. Each director must represent 
the interests of our stockholders.

Any stockholder may nominate persons for election to the Board of Directors by complying with 
the procedures set forth in our bylaws, which require that timely written notice be provided to the Secre-
tary of the Company in advance of the meeting of stockholders at which directors are to be elected. To be 
timely, such notice must be delivered or received not less than 90 days prior to the date of the meeting; 
provided, that if less than 100 days’ notice or prior disclosure of the date of the meeting is given or made to 
stockholders, such notice must be received not later than the close of business on the 10th day following the 
day on which such notice was given or made to stockholders. Each notice must set forth: (i) all information 
relating to such person that is required to be disclosed in solicitations of proxies for the election of direc-
tors, or is otherwise required, in each case pursuant to Regulation 14A under the Securities Exchange Act 
of 1934 (including such person’s written consent to being named in the proxy statement as a nominee and 
to serving as a director if elected); and (ii) as to the stockholder giving notice of (x) the name and address, 
as they appear on the Company’s books, of such stockholder and (y) the class and number of shares of the 
Company’s capital stock that are beneficially owned by such stockholder. The officer of the Company or 
other person presiding at the meeting may determine that a nomination was not made in accordance with 
the foregoing procedure and disregard the defective nomination.

The  Corporate  Governance/Nominating  Committee  annually  reviews  the  adequacy  of,  and  the 
Company’s compliance with, the corporate governance principals of the Company and recommends any 
proposed changes to the Board of Directors for approval. The Corporate Governance/Nominating Commit-
tee also administers the annual self-evaluation process for the Board of Directors and each of its committees.

17

Annex AProxy The Corporate Governance/Nominating Committee functions are set forth in its charter, which 
was adopted on April 24, 2013. A copy of the Corporate Governance/Nominating Charter may be found 
under the Investor Relations section under the Governance Documents tab of the Company’s website, 
https://www.haveanicebank.com.

Compensation/Benefits Committee

The  Compensation/Benefits  Committee  is  responsible  for  evaluating  the  performance  of  the 
Company’s principal officers and employees and determining the compensation and benefits to be paid 
to  such  persons.  The  Compensation/Benefits  Committee  is  composed  of  seven  members:  Messrs.  Pen-
ney, Clawson, Deal, Eubank, Leddy, Rosen, and Wilson. The Compensation/Benefits Committee met five 
times during the 2015 fiscal year.

The Compensation/Benefits Committee is authorized to (i) review and approve annually the cor-
porate goals and objectives relevant to the compensation of the chief executive officers of the Company 
and the Bank, (ii) conduct an annual evaluation of the performance of the Chief Executive Officer of the 
Company, and (iii) annually review and establish the base salary and incentive bonus levels and payments 
to the Chief Executive Officer and all other executive officers of the Company and the Bank. The Com-
pensation/Benefits  Committee  is  also  responsible  for  administering  the  Corporation’s  incentive  plans, 
including equity-based incentive plans, and for reviewing and granting equity awards to all eligible em-
ployees. The Compensation/Benefits Committee may delegate to one or more officers of the Company 
who are also directors the authority to designate officers and employees of the Company or its subsidiaries 
to receive equity awards and to determine the number of such awards to be granted to them; provided, 
that  such  delegation  shall  include  the  total  number  of  equity  awards  that  may  be  granted  under  such 
authority and that no officer may be delegated the power to designate himself or herself the recipient of 
such awards. In addition, the Compensation/Benefits Committee may engage compensation consultants 
or other advisors as it deems appropriate to assist it in performing its duties and responsibilities.

In  determining  the  compensation  for  executive  officers,  the  Compensation/Benefits  Commit-
tee’s objectives are to encourage the achievement of the Company’s long-range objectives by providing 
compensation that directly relates to the performance of the individual and the achievement of internal 
strategic objectives. The Compensation/Benefits Committee believes that its executive officers’ level of 
compensation is reasonable based upon the Company’s corporate goals and objectives, the business plan 
of the Company, normal and customary levels of compensation within the banking industry taking into 
consideration geographic and competitive factors, the Bank’s asset quality, capital level, operations and 
profitability and the duties performed and responsibilities held by the officer.

The Compensation/Benefits Committee functions are set forth in its charter, which was adopted 
on  June  18,  2014  and  revised  on  February  17,  2016.  A  copy  of  the  Compensation/Benefits  Committee 
Charter may be found under the Investor Relations section under the Governance Documents tab of the 
Company’s website, https://www.haveanicebank.com.

Finance and Capital Allocation Committee

The Finance and Capital Allocation Committee is responsible for reviewing the Company’s finan-
cial results and accounting policies. The Finance and Capital Allocation Committee is composed of seven 
members: Messrs. Brandon, Leddy, Moïse, Morrow, Rexroad, Rosen and Watts. The Finance and Capital 
Allocation Committee met four times during the 2015 fiscal year.

18

The Finance and Capital Allocation Committee functions are set forth in its charter, which was 
adopted  on  April  24,  2013.  A  copy  of  the  Finance  and  Capital  Allocation  Committee  Charter  may  be 
found under the Investor Relations section under the Governance Documents tab of the Company’s web-
site, https://www.haveanicebank.com

Mergers and Acquisitions Committee

The  Board  of  Directors  previously  had  a  Mergers  and  Acquisitions  Committee,  which  was  re-
sponsible for evaluating potential merger and acquisition candidates and transactions. The Mergers and 
Acquisitions Committee was composed eight members: Messrs. Watts, IV, Brandon, Eubank, Moïse, Mor-
row, Rexroad, Rosen, and Wilson. The Mergers and Acquisitions Committee met two times during the 
2015 fiscal year; however, beginning in March 2015, the Mergers and Acquisitions Committee was rolled 
into the Executive Committee. The Board of Directors no longer has a standing Mergers and Acquisitions 
Committee.

Stockholder Communications 

The  Board  of  Directors  has  implemented  a  process  for  stockholders  of  the  Company  to  send 
communications to the Board of Directors. Any stockholder desiring to communicate with the Board of 
Directors, or with specific individual directors, may so do by writing to M. J. Huggins, III, Secretary, Car-
olina Financial Corporation, 288 Meeting Street, Charleston, South Carolina 29401. The Secretary has 
been instructed by the Board of Directors to promptly forward all such communications to the addressees 
indicated thereon.

19

Annex AProxyCOMPENSATION OF DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS 

Director Compensation 

During fiscal 2015, directors of the Company received a retainer fee of $7,000 paid in cash and 
947 shares of the Company’s Common Stock. Those directors not employed by a subsidiary of the Com-
pany received $500 for each committee meeting attended. As directors of CresCom Bank, Messrs. Bran-
don, Clawson, Deal, Eubank, Moïse, Penney, Watts and Wilson received $1,000 per meeting. As directors 
of Crescent Mortgage Company, Messrs. Clawson, Moore and Rosen received $1,000 per meeting. The 
Chairman of the Company’s Board of Directors received an annual fee of $50,000, paid monthly. Addi-
tionally,  the  Chairmen  of  the  Company’s  Audit,  Governance/Nominating,  Compensation,  and  Finance 
and Capital each received a fee of $5,000 per year while the Bank Loan Committee Chairman received 
$1,000 per year.

2015 DIRECTOR COMPENSATION TABLE 

Director Name

Fees Earned or  
Paid in  
Cash(1)

Stock 
Awards

Total

William H. Alford(2)
Howell V. Bellamy, Jr.

W. Scott Brandon

Robert G. Clawson, Jr.

Jeffery L. Deal, M.D.

G. Manly Eubank

Michael P. Leddy

Robert M. Moïse, CPA

Thompson E. Penney

Benedict P. Rosen
Lt. General Claudius E. Watts, III (USAF, Retired)(2)
Claudius E. Watts IV

Bonum S. Wilson, Jr

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

5,500  

13,000  

35,500  

39,200  

41,400  

42,733  

47,500  

39,000  

39,700  

34,500  

16,667  

29,000  

34,500  

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

—   

10,999  

10,999  

10,999  

10,999  

10,999  

10,999  

10,999  

10,999  

10,999  

—   

10,999  

10,999  

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

 $

5,500  

23,999  

46,499  

50,199  

52,399  

53,732  

58,499  

49,999  

50,699  

45,499  

16,667  

39,999  

45,499  

(1)  Includes fees, if any, for serving on boards of the Company’s subsidiaries.
(2)  Retired from the Board of Directors with the 2014 annual meeting. 

20

 
 
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management

The following table shows how many shares of Common Stock are owned by the directors, the 
named executive officers, owners of more than 5% of the outstanding Common Stock, and all directors 
and executive officers as a group as of March 18, 2016. Unless otherwise indicated, the mailing address 
for each beneficial owner is care of Carolina Financial Corporation, 288 Meeting Street, Charleston, SC 
29401.

Directors and Named Executive Officers

Age

Number of  
Shares 
Beneficially Owned(1)(2)(3)(4)

Percent of  
Beneficial  
Ownership

Howell V. Bellamy, Jr.

W. Scott Brandon

Robert G. Clawson, Jr.

Jeffery L. Deal, M.D.

G. Manly Eubank

M.J. Huggins, III

Michael P. Leddy

David L. Morrow

Robert M. Moïse, CPA

Thompson E. Penney

Jerold L. Rexroad

Benedict P. Rosen

Claudius E. Watts IV

Bonum S. Wilson, Jr.
All Directors and Executive Officers as a Group  
(14 persons)

79

52

73

61

79

53

72

65

67

65

55

79

54

80

36,467

164,985

150,107

61,659

233,764

79,797

101,989

137,540

192,517

28,547

397,255

65,556

63,563

174,097

0.30%

1.37%

1.25%

0.51%

1.94%

0.66%

0.85%

1.14%

1.59%

0.24%

3.27%

0.54%

0.53%

1.45%

1,887,843

15.50%

(1) 

(2) 

(3) 

(4) 

 Includes shares for which the named person has sole voting and investment power, has shared voting and investment power with 
a spouse, holds in an IRA or SEP, or holds in a trust as trustee for the benefit of himself, unless otherwise indicated in these 
footnotes.
 Includes unvested shares of restricted stock, as to which the directors and executive officers have full voting privileges. The 
shares are as follows: Mr. Huggins, 24,000 shares; Mr. Morrow, 28,800 shares; Mr. Rexroad, 53,034 shares.
 Includes shares that may be acquired within 60 days of March 18, 2016 by exercising vested stock options or unvested stock 
options that will vest within 60 days of March 18, 2016. The shares are as follows: Mr. Huggins, 11,738 shares; Mr. Morrow, 
30,983 shares; Mr. Rexroad, 87,099 shares.
 Excludes shares of Common Stock owned by or for the benefit of family members of the following directors and executive of-
ficers, each of whom disclaims beneficial ownership of such shares: Mr. Clawson, 13,272 shares; Mr. Rosen, 9,600 shares; and 
Mr. Rexroad, 11,040 shares.

21

Annex AProxy 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
Executive Compensation

The following table shows the compensation the Company paid for the years ended December 31, 

2015 and 2014 to its named executive officers during such periods.

Summary Compensation Table

Name and Principal Position

Year Salary

Bonus

Stock 
Awards(2)

Option 
Awards(3)

All Other  
Compensation(4)

Total

Jerold L. Rexroad(1)

Director, President and Chief 
Executive Officer; Chairman 
and CEO of Crescent 
Mortgage Company; Chairman 
and Senior Executive Vice 
President of CresCom Bank

Director, President and Chief 
Executive Officer; Chairman 
and CEO of Crescent 
Mortgage Company; Senior 
Executive Vice President and 
Chief Administrative Officer of 
CresCom Bank

David L. Morrow

Director, Executive Vice  
President; Chief Executive  
Officer, President and Director  
of CresCom Bank

Director, Executive Vice 
President; Chief Executive 
Officer, President and Director 
of CresCom Bank

M. J. Huggins, III

Executive Vice President 
and Secretary; President of 
Commercial Banking, Secretary 
and Director of CresCom Bank

Executive Vice President 
and Secretary; President of 
Commercial Banking, Secretary 
and Director of CresCom Bank

2015 $450,000 $371,250

$160,046

$87,205

$  52,316 $1,120,817

2014 $312,000 $260,007

$  17,673

—

$  49,436 $   639,116

2015 $375,000 $222,773

$  68,786

$49,833

$  59,402 $   775,794

2014 $280,800 $210,600

—

—

$186,932 $   678,332

2015 $255,000 $139,915

$  27,763

$19,933

$  93,735 $   536,346

2014 $250,000 $187,500

$164,000

$20,276

$  84,291 $   706,067

(1) 

(2) 

 In 2015, Mr. Rexroad participated in the Company’s incentive compensation plan. In 2014, Mr. Rexroad’s bonus compensation 
arrangement was comprised of an incentive plan for Crescent Mortgage Company and an incentive plan for CresCom Bank. 
Crescent Mortgage Company incentive plan was for 2.00% of the pretax, pre-bonus earnings of Crescent Mortgage Company, 
with 40% of such bonus paid in shares of common stock. Common stock was issued from the 2013 Equity Incentive Plan. 
 All 2015 and 2014 stock awards were issued from the 2013 Equity Incentive Plan. In fiscal 2015, 7,554 shares of restricted stock 
and 4,320 shares of restricted stock units were awarded to Mr. Rexroad, 4,320 restricted stock units were awarded to Mr. Mor-
row and 1,296 restricted stock units were awarded to Mr. Huggins. In addition, Mr. Rexroad, Mr. Morrow and Mr. Huggins 
were awarded 1,359, 1,132, and 770 shares of common stock, respectively, for meeting certain performance thresholds related 

22

(3) 

(4) 

to their 2015 incentive plan.  In fiscal 2014, Mr. Rexroad was awarded 2,030 common shares related to the Crescent Mortgage 
Company bonus compensation plan and Mr. Huggins was awarded 19,200 shares of restricted stock. The value for each of 
these awards is its grant date fair value calculated by multiplying the number of shares subject to the award by the market price 
per share on the date such award was granted, computed in accordance with Financial Accounting Standards Board Account-
ing Standards Codification Topic 718.
 All 2015 and 2014 options awards were issued from the 2013 Equity Incentive Plan. In fiscal 2015, Mr. Rexroad was awarded 
24,590 options, Mr. Morrow was awarded 14,052 options and Mr. Huggins was awarded 5,621 options. Options granted to Mr. 
Rexroad, Mr. Morrow and Mr. Huggins in 2015 vest over three years ratably. In fiscal 2014, Mr. Huggins was awarded 6,576 
options. The value for each of these awards is its grant date fair value calculated by multiplying the number of shares subject to 
the award by the market price per share on the date such award was granted, computed in accordance with Financial Account-
ing Standards Board Accounting Standards Codification Topic 718. 
 All  other  compensation  included  the  Company’s  contributions  under  the  401(k)  Plan,  dividends  on  unvested  restricted 
stock, membership dues, and car allowances paid by the Company to the named executives. In addition, life insurance pre-
mium and other payments received in connection with life insurance arrangements “LifeComp” were paid for Mr. Morrow 
in 2014 and for Mr. Huggins in 2015 and 2014. Mr. Morrow stopped participating in the LifeComp plan and was subse-
quently paid out his portion of the cash surrender value in 2015. Under the agreement the Bank pays, among other things, 
the premiums on each policy and additional amounts to the executives to cover federal income taxes owed with respect to 
their deemed bonuses under the LifeComp Agreements. In 2015, the Company allocated $24,000 in life insurance premi-
um to Mr. Huggins. In 2014, the Company allocated $84,000 and $24,000 in life insurance premiums to Messrs. Morrow 
and Huggins, respectively, as compensation (an aggregate premium of $108,000). In 2015, the Company also paid $16,000 
in other compensation Mr. Huggins to cover federal income taxes owed with respect to the deemed bonuses. In 2014, the 
Company  also  paid  $56,000  and  $16,000  in  other  compensation  to  Messrs.  Morrow  and  Huggins,  respectively,  to  cover 
federal income taxes owed with respect to the deemed bonuses (aggregate bonuses of $72,000). See “Benefit Plans – Elite 
LifeComp Program” below for additional information regarding the LifeComp Agreements between the Bank and Messrs. 
Morrow and Huggins.

Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End

The  following  table  summarized  outstanding  equity  awards  to  our  named  executive  officers  at 

December 31, 2015:

Stock Options

Stock Awards

Equity  
Incentive 
Plan Awards: 
Market of 
Payout Value 
of Unearned 
Shares 
that have 
not Vested

$

$

$

827,172

518,400

432,000

Equity Incentive 
Plan Awards: 
Number of hares 
underlying 
Unexercised 
Options

Name

Exercisable

Unexercisable

Option 
Exercise 
Price

Option 
Expiration 
Date

Equity  
Incentive 
Plan Awards: 
Number of 
Unearned 
Shares that 
have not  
Vested

Jerold L. Rexroad

David L. Morrow

M.J. Huggins, III

78,902

—  

26,299

—  

6,576

3,288

—  

—  

24,590

—  

14,052

—  

3,288

5,620

4.17  

4/25/2023  

45,954  

11.58  

1/21/2025  

4.17  

4/25/2023  

28,800  

11.58  

1/21/2025  

4.17  

4/25/2023  

24,000  

8.54  

4/25/2024  

11.58  

1/21/2025  

  $

  $

  $

  $

  $

  $

  $

23

Annex AProxy 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Incentive Compensation Plan 

In  fiscal  2015  and  2014,  the  Board  of  Directors  implemented  an  incentive  compensation  plan 
for Messrs. Rexroad, Morrow, and Huggins which was tied to achieving certain earnings and operational 
targets. For 2015, Mr. Rexroad earned $371,250, Mr. Morrow earned $222,773, and Mr. Huggins earned 
$139,915. For 2014, Messrs. Morrow and Huggins earned $210,600 and $187,500, respectively.

In  2014,  the  Board  of  Directors  implemented  an  incentive  compensation  plan  for  Mr.  Rex-
road  that  consisted  of  two  components.  The  CresCom  Bank  incentive  was  tied  to  achieving  certain 
earnings and operational targets. Mr. Rexroad earned $234,000 for 2014 related to the CresCom Bank 
incentive. The Crescent Mortgage Company incentive was based upon pre-tax, pre-incentive earnings 
at Crescent Mortgage Company and is paid 60% in cash and 40% in the Company’s Common Stock. 
For 2014, Mr. Rexroad earned $43,680 of which $26,007 and $17,673 were paid in cash and Common 
Stock, respectively.

Employment Agreements 

The Company has entered into an employment agreement with Mr. Jerold L. Rexroad, its Pres-
ident and Chief Executive Officer, and the Bank has entered into employment agreements with Messrs. 
David  L.  Morrow  and  M.  J.  Huggins,  III,  its  President/Chief  Executive  Officer  and  President  of  Com-
mercial Banking, respectively. The employment agreements between the Bank and its two executives are 
substantially identical to the employment agreement of Mr. Rexroad, except that Mr. Huggins also partici-
pates in the Elite LifeComp program. Mr. Morrow terminated his participation in the Elite LifeComp pro-
gram as of December 31, 2014 and was paid out his portion in 2015. Under the employment agreements, 
Mr. Rexroad currently receives a base salary of $463,500, Mr. Morrow currently receives a base salary of 
$386,250, and Mr. Huggins currently receives a base salary of $262,650.

The employment agreements provide that upon the occurrence of an “Event of Termination,” as 
defined in the agreements, the Company or Bank, as applicable, will pay the executive, beneficiary, or es-
tate, three times the average over the past three years of the sum of the executive’s annualized base salary, 
other cash compensation paid to the executive and contributions made on the executive’s behalf to Com-
pany-sponsored employee benefit plans. If the executive’s employment is terminated without cause as an 
“Event of Termination,” the executive agrees that for a period of one year the employee will not compete 
with the Company or Bank within 30 miles of the Company’s main office.

The employment agreements also provide that upon the occurrence of a “Change in Control”, 
as defined in the agreements, the Company or Bank as applicable, will pay the executive, beneficiary, or 
estate 2.99 times the average over the past five years of the sum of the executive’s “annual compensation”, 
as  defined  in  the  agreements,  and  contributions  made  on  the  executive  behalf  to  Company-sponsored 
employee benefit plans.

If an event occurred that triggered an obligation to pay benefits to Messrs. Rexroad, Morrow and 
Huggins as of December 31, 2015, Carolina Financial Corporation and/or the Bank would be required to 
pay, in the aggregate, (i) approximately $5.7 million, exclusive of a possible gross-up for additional tax pay-
ments, in the event the executive’s employment terminated in connection with a Change in Control, and 
(ii) approximately $6.2 million in the event the executive’s employment terminated without cause upon an 
Event of Termination that does not include a Change in Control.

24

Elite LifeComp Program

A  life  insurance  policy  has  been  purchased  on  the  life  of  Mr.  Huggins  under  a  split-dollar  life 
insurance arrangements between the executive and the Bank in order to provide the executive with target 
retirement and death benefits following termination of employment. Under the arrangement, referred to 
as the LifeComp Agreement, the executive is named as the policy owner, but the Bank pays the premiums 
on his policy for a period of years and is entitled to recover a death benefit of $1.8 million under the policy 
as key man insurance. Until the executive attains an age specified in such executive’s agreement, the Bank 
annually pays to the executive an amount that is deemed to be, initially, a partial premium payment, and 
later, an incremental increase in the executive’s interest in the policy’s cash surrender value. Also, during 
the term of the executive’s employment, the Bank pays to the executive an amount sufficient to cover the 
interest payments owed by the executive to the Company on the loans, and also an additional amount to 
cover federal income taxes to which the executive becomes subject upon payment of bonuses.

Under an addendum to the LifeComp Agreement entered into and effective as of January 2007, if 
the executive’s employment with the Bank terminates for reasons other than for cause or due to a change 
in  control,  the  Company  has  agreed  to  continue  its  obligations  under  the  LifeComp  Agreement  until 
the date on which the split-dollar life insurance arrangement is terminated. Pursuant to the agreement 
with Mr. Huggins, the termination date is February 27, 2022. Until such termination date, the addendum 
requires the Company, or its successor, to make all premium payments that would become due after the 
change in control or event of termination and also to “gross-up” the executive’s income through a series 
of bonus payments in order to: (i) facilitate the executive’s payment of his portion of the premiums, (ii) 
enable the executive to partially repay the accumulated loan balance on the deemed loans made by the 
Bank  to  the  executive  to  pay  the  executive’s  portion  of  said  premiums,  (iii)  cover  the  deemed  interest 
due on such loans, and (iv) cover federal income taxes that the executive would owe with respect to the 
deemed bonuses and interest owed (but not paid) on the loans. Beginning at retirement age, the executive 
is entitled to draw a retirement benefit from the cash surrender value of the policy for a period of up to 15 
years. The annual target retirement benefit payable to Mr. Huggins is $75,000. In addition, the executive 
is entitled to a death benefit from the policy of $1 million prior to retirement, and a lesser amount once 
the executive begins to receive the retirement benefits under the policy. In the event the executive is ter-
minated for cause, the executive loses all rights under the agreement. Life insurance premium and other 
payments received in connection with life insurance arrangements “LifeComp” were paid for Mr. Morrow 
in 2014 and for Mr. Huggins in 2015 and 2014. Mr. Morrow stopped participating in the LifeComp plan 
and was subsequently paid out his portion of the cash surrender value in 2015. Under the agreement the 
Bank pays, among other things, the premiums on each policy and additional amounts to the executives to 
cover federal income taxes owed with respect to their deemed bonuses under the LifeComp Agreements. 
In 2015, the Company allocated $24,000 in life insurance premium to Mr. Huggins. In 2014, the Company 
allocated $84,000 and $24,000 in life insurance premiums to Messrs. Morrow and Huggins, respectively, 
as compensation (an aggregate premium of $108,000). In 2015, the Company also paid $16,000 in other 
compensation Mr. Huggins to cover federal income taxes owed with respect to the deemed bonuses. In 
2014, the Company also paid $56,000 and $16,000 in other compensation to Messrs. Morrow and Huggins, 
respectively, to cover federal income taxes owed with respect to the deemed bonuses (aggregate bonuses 
of $72,000).

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions

The Bank has followed a policy of granting commercial and consumer loans, and loans secured 
by one-to four-family real estate to officers, directors and employees. Loans to directors and executive 

25

Annex AProxyofficers are made in the ordinary course of business and on the same terms and conditions as those of 
comparable  transactions  with  the  general  public  prevailing  at  the  time,  in  accordance  with  the  Banks’ 
underwriting guidelines, and do not involve more than the normal risk of collectability or present other 
unfavorable features.

W. Scott Brandon, a director of the Company, owns 100% of The Brandon Agency, Inc. (“Bran-
don Agency”) which the Company engaged to provide marketing and advertising services. During the year 
ended December 31, 2015, the Company paid Brandon Agency $662,000 for services rendered.

All  loans  by  the  Bank  to  its  directors  and  executive  officers  are  subject  to  federal  regulations 
restricting loan and other transactions with affiliated persons of the Bank. Federal law generally requires 
that all loans to directors and executive officers be made on terms and conditions comparable to those 
for similar transactions with non-affiliates, subject to limited exceptions. Loans to all directors, executive 
officers, and their associates totaled $14.9 million at December 31, 2015, which was 10.7% of the Compa-
ny’s stockholders’ equity at that date. There were no loans outstanding to any director, executive officer 
or their affiliates at preferential rates or terms, which in the aggregate exceeded $100,000 during the year 
ended December 31, 2015. All loans to directors and officers were performing in accordance with their 
terms at December 31, 2015.

Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance

Section 16(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 requires directors, executive officers, and 
10% stockholders to file reports of holdings and transactions in the Company’s stock with the SEC. Based 
on a review of Section 16(a) reports and written representations from the Company’s directors and execu-
tive officers, the Company believes that all of its directors, executive officers, and 10% stockholders have 
made all filings required under Section 16(a) in a timely manner, with the exception of Messrs. Brandon, 
Eubank, Moïse, Watts, Huggins, and Rexroad, who each filed one late report (Form 4), and Mr. Wilson, 
who filed two late reports (Form 4).

Code of Ethics

The Company expects all of its employees to conduct themselves honestly and ethically. The Com-
pany has adopted a Code of Ethics that reflects the Company’s policy of responsible and ethical business 
practices, and applies to all directors, officers, and employees of the Company and its subsidiaries. Stock-
holders and other interested persons may view the Company’s Codes of Ethics on the Investor Relations 
section under the Governance Documents tab of the Company’s website, https://www.haveanicebank.com.

Stockholder Proposals for the 2016 Annual Meeting of Stockholders

Stockholders interested in submitting a proposal for inclusion in the proxy statement for the Com-
pany’s 2016 Annual Meeting of Stockholders may do so by following the procedures prescribed in SEC 
Rule 14a-8. To be eligible for inclusion, stockholder proposals must be received by the Company’s Chair-
man of the Board of Directors, Chief Executive Officer, or Corporate Secretary at 288 Meeting Street 
Charleston, SC 29401 no later than November 26, 2016. To ensure prompt receipt by the Company, the 
proposal should be sent certified mail, return receipt requested. Proposals must comply with the Compa-
ny’s Bylaws related to stockholder proposals in order to be included in the Company’s proxy materials.

26

EXHIBIT A

AMENDMENT TO INCREASE THE NUMBER OF AUTHORIZED SHARES OF 
THE COMPANY’S COMMON STOCK

Article FOURTH, Paragraph A of the Company’s Certificate of Incorporation is hereby deleted 

in its entirety and replaced with the following*:

FOURTH:   

A. 

 The total number of shares of all classes of stock which the Corporation shall have au-
thority to issue is twenty-six million (26,000,000) consisting of:

1. 

2. 

 One  million  (1,000,000)  shares  of  Preferred  Stock,  par  value  one  cent  ($.01)  per 
share (the “Preferred Stock”); and

 Twenty-five million (25,000,000) shares of Common Stock, par value one cent ($.01) 
per share (the “Common Stock”).

*  The  following  assumes  the  amendment  to  the  Company’s  Certificate  of  Incorporation  is  approved  at  the 
Meeting.  If  the  amendment  is  approved,  then,  upon  the  filing  of  the  Certificate  of  Amendment  with  the  
Delaware Secretary of State, the number of authorized shares of Common Stock will be increased accordingly.

27

Annex AProxy(This page intentionally left blank)

UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
FORM 10-K

(Mark One)

 ANNUAL  REPORT  PURSUANT  TO  SECTION  13  OR  15(D)  OF  THE  SECURITIES  
EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2015

OR

 TRANSITION  REPORT  PURSUANT  TO  SECTION  13  OR  15(D)  OF  THE  SECURITIES  
EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the transition period from                     to           

Commission file number 001-10897

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

Delaware 
(State of Incorporation) 

57-1039637
(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.) 

288 Meeting Street, Charleston, 
South Carolina 
(Address of principal executive offices) 

29401
(Zip Code)

(843) 723-7700
(Issuer’s Telephone Number)

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Exchange Act: None
Securities registered under Section 12(g) of the Exchange Act:
Title of each class: Common Stock, $0.01 par value per share
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes ®     No ˛
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Exchange Act.
Yes ®     No ˛
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities  
Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), 
and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes ˛     No ®
Indicate  by  check  mark  whether  the  registrant  has  submitted  electronically  and  posted  on  its  corporate  Web  site,  if  any,  every  
Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the 
preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). Yes ˛     No ®
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be 
contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of 
this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.        ®
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). Yes ®     No ˛
The aggregate market value of the voting and nonvoting common equity held by non-affiliates of the registrant (computed by reference 
to the price at which the stock was most recently sold) was $108,169,734 as of the last business day of the registrant’s most recently 
completed second fiscal quarter.
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller  
reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 
of the Exchange Act. (Check one):
  Large accelerated filer ®  Accelerated filer ˛ Non-accelerated filer ®  Smaller reporting company ®

(Do not check if a smaller reporting company)

Indicate the number of shares outstanding of each of the registrant’s classes of common stock, as of the latest practicable date.
Outstanding at March 14, 2016         

Class 
Common Stock, $.01 par value per share 

12,047,615 shares

Portions of the registrant’s Proxy Statement relating to the registrant’s Annual Meeting of Shareholders, to be held on May 3, 
2016, are incorporated by reference into Part III of this Annual Report on Form 10-K where indicated.

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
TABLE OF CONTENTS

PART 1

ITEM 1.  BUSINESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  

ITEM 1A.  RISK FACTORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  

ITEM 1B.  UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  

ITEM 2. 

PROPERTIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  

ITEM 3. 

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  

ITEM 4.  MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  

PAGE

4

29

48

48

49

49

PART II

ITEM 5. 

 MARKET PRICE OF AND DIVIDENDS ON THE REGISTRANT’S COMMON 
EQUITY AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50

ITEM 6. 

SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52

ITEM 7. 

 MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL  
CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54

ITEM 7A.   QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT  

MARKET RISK  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86

ITEM 8. 

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87

ITEM 9. 

 CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON  
ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155

ITEM 9A.  CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155

ITEM 9B.  OTHER INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156

PART III

ITEM 10.  DIRECTOR, EXECUTIVE OFFICER AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE  . . . 157

ITEM 11.  EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157

ITEM 12. 

 SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND  
MANAGEMENT AND RELATED SHAREHOLDER MATTERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157

ITEM 13.  CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157

ITEM 14.  PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157

ITEM 15.  FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND EXHIBITS  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157

SIGNATURES

EXHIBIT INDEX

 
CAUTIONARY NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This Annual Report on Form 10-K, including information included or incorporated by reference, 
contains statements which constitute forward-looking statements within the meaning of Section 27A of 
the Securities Act of 1933 (the “Securities “Act”) and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 
(the “Exchange Act”). Forward-looking statements may relate to our financial condition, results of op-
eration, plans, objectives, or future performance. These statements are based on many assumptions and 
estimates and are not guarantees of future performance. Our actual results may differ materially from 
those anticipated in any forward-looking statements, as they will depend on many factors about which we 
are unsure, including many factors which are beyond our control. The words “may,” “would,” “could,” 
“should,” “will,” “expect,” “anticipate,” “predict,” “project,” “potential,” “believe,” “continue,” “assume,” 
“intend,” “plan,” and “estimate,” as well as similar expressions, are meant to identify such forward-look-
ing statements. Potential risks and uncertainties that could cause our actual results to differ from those 
anticipated in any forward-looking statements include, but are not limited to, those described below under 
“Item 1A- Risk Factors” and the following:

•	

•	

•	

•	

•	

•	

•	

	our	 ability	 to	 maintain	 appropriate	 levels	 of	 capital	 and	 to	 comply	 with	 our	 capital	 ratio	 
requirements;

	examinations	by	our	regulatory	authorities,	including	the	possibility	that	the	regulatory	au-
thorities  may,  among  other  things,  require  us  to  increase  our  allowance  for  loan  losses  or 
write-down assets or otherwise impose restrictions or conditions on our operations, includ-
ing, but not limited to, our ability to acquire or be acquired;

	changes	in	economic	conditions,	either	nationally	or	regionally	and	especially	in	our	primary	
market areas, resulting in, among other things, a deterioration in credit quality;

	changes	in	interest	rates,	or	changes	in	regulatory	environment	resulting	in	a	decline	in	our	
mortgage production and a decrease in the profitability of our mortgage banking operations;

	greater	 than	 expected	 losses	 due	 to	 higher	 credit	 losses	 generally	 and	 specifically	 because	
losses in the sectors of our loan portfolio secured by real estate are greater than expected 
due to economic factors, including, but not limited to, declining real estate values, increasing 
interest rates, increasing unemployment, or changes in payment behavior or other factors;

	greater	than	expected	losses	due	to	higher	credit	losses	because	our	loans	are	concentrated	
by loan type, industry segment, borrower type, or location of the borrower or collateral;

	changes	in	the	amount	of	our	loan	portfolio	collateralized	by	real	estate	and	weaknesses	in	
the South Carolina, southeastern North Carolina and national real estate markets;

•	

the	rate	of	delinquencies	and	amount	of	loans	charged-off;

•	

	the	 adequacy	 of	 the	 level	 of	 our	 allowance	 for	 loan	 losses	 and	 the	 amount	 of	 loan	 loss	 
provisions required in future periods;

•	

the	rate	of	loan	growth	in	recent	or	future	years;

1

2015 Form 10-K•	

our	ability	to	attract	and	retain	key	personnel;

•	

our	ability	to	retain	our	existing	customers,	including	our	deposit	relationships;

•	

significant	increases	in	competitive	pressure	in	the	banking	and	financial	services	industries;

•	

adverse	changes	in	asset	quality	and	resulting	credit	risk-related	losses	and	expenses;

•	

changes	in	the	interest	rate	environment	which	could	reduce	anticipated	or	actual	margins;

•	

	changes	in	political	conditions	or	the	legislative	or	regulatory	environment,	including,	but	not	
limited to, the Dodd-Frank Act and regulations adopted thereunder, changes in federal or 
state tax laws or interpretations thereof by taxing authorities and other governmental initia-
tives affecting the banking, mortgage banking, and financial service industries;

•	

changes	occurring	in	business	conditions	and	inflation;

•	

•	

	increased	 funding	 costs	 due	 to	 market	 illiquidity,	 increased	 competition	 for	 funding,	 or	 
increased regulatory requirements with regard to funding;

	our	business	continuity	plans	or	data	security	systems	could	prove	to	be	inadequate,	resulting	
in a material interruption in, or disruption to, business and a negative impact on results of 
operations;

•	

changes	in	deposit	flows;

•	

changes	in	technology;

•	

changes	in	monetary	and	tax	policies;

•	

•	

•	

	changes	 in	 accounting	 policies,	 as	 may	 be	 adopted	 by	 the	 regulatory	 agencies,	 as	 well	 as	
the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board and the Financial Accounting Standards 
Board;

	loss	of	consumer	confidence	and	economic	disruptions	resulting	from	terrorist	activities	or	
other military actions;

	our	expectations	regarding	our	operating	revenues,	expenses,	effective	tax	rates	and	other	
results of operations;

•	

our	anticipated	capital	expenditures	and	our	estimates	regarding	our	capital	requirements;

•	

our	liquidity	and	working	capital	requirements;

•	

competitive	pressures	among	depository	and	other	financial	institutions;

•	

the	growth	rates	of	the	markets	in	which	we	compete;

2

•	

our	anticipated	strategies	for	growth	and	sources	of	new	operating	revenues;

•	

	our	 current	 and	 future	 products,	 services,	 applications	 and	 functionality	 and	 plans	 to	 pro-
mote them;

•	

anticipated	trends	and	challenges	in	our	business	and	in	the	markets	in	which	we	operate;

•	

the	evolution	of	technology	affecting	our	products,	services	and	markets;

•	

our	ability	to	retain	and	hire	necessary	employees	and	to	staff	our	operations	appropriately;

•	 management	compensation	and	the	methodology	for	its	determination;

•	

our	ability	to	compete	in	our	industry	and	innovation	by	our	competitors;

•	

increased	cybersecurity	risk,	including	potential	business	disruptions	or	financial	losses;

•	

•	

•	

	acquisition	integration	risks,	including	potential	deposit	attrition,	higher	than	expected	costs,	
customer loss and business disruption, including, without limitation, potential difficulties in 
maintaining relationships with key personnel and other integration related matters, and the 
inability  to  identify  and  successfully  negotiate  and  complete  additional  combinations  with 
potential merger or acquisition partners or to successfully integrate such businesses into the 
Company,	including	the	ability	to	realize	the	benefits	and	cost	savings	from,	and	limit	any	
unexpected liabilities associated with, any such business combinations;

	our	ability	to	stay	abreast	of	new	or	modified	laws	and	regulations	that	currently	apply	or	
become applicable to our business; and

	estimates	 and	 estimate	 methodologies	 used	 in	 preparing	 our	 consolidated	 financial	 
statements and determining option exercise prices and stock-based compensation.

If	any	of	these	risks	or	uncertainties	materialize,	or	if	any	of	the	assumptions	underlying	such	for-
ward-looking statements proves to be incorrect, our results could differ materially from those expressed 
in, implied or projected by, such forward-looking statements. For information with respect to factors that 
could cause actual results to differ from the expectations stated in the forward-looking statements, see 
“Risk  Factors”  under  Part  I,  Item  1A  of  this  report.  We  urge  investors  to  consider  all  of  these  factors 
carefully in evaluating the forward-looking statements contained in this report. We make these forward- 
looking as of the date of this document and we do not intend, and assume no obligation, to update the 
forward-looking statements or to update the reasons why actual results could differ from those expressed 
in, or implied or projected by, the forward-looking statements.

3

2015 Form 10-KPART I

ITEM 1.  BUSINESS

General Overview

Carolina	Financial	Corporation	is	a	Delaware	corporation	that	was	organized	in	February	1997	
to  serve  as  a  bank  holding  company.  It  operates  principally  through  CresCom  Bank,  a  South  Carolina 
state-chartered bank. CresCom Bank operates Crescent Mortgage Company and Carolina Service Corpo-
ration of Charleston as wholly-owned subsidiaries of CresCom Bank. Except where the context otherwise 
requires, the “Company”, “we”, “us” and “our” refer to Carolina Financial Corporation and its consoli-
dated subsidiaries and the “Bank” refers to CresCom Bank.

We offer a variety of traditional community banking services to individuals and businesses. Our 
product	line	includes	loans	to	small	and	medium-sized	businesses,	residential	and	commercial	construc-
tion and development loans, commercial real estate loans, residential mortgage loans, residential lot loans, 
home equity loans, consumer loans and a variety of commercial and consumer demand, savings and time 
deposit products. We also offer online and bill payment services, wire transfer services, safe deposit box 
rentals, debit card and ATM card services, and the availability of a network of ATMs for our customers.

Crescent Mortgage Company, acquired by us in 2003, was founded in February 1993 as a whole-
sale and correspondent mortgage lender for community banks in the Southeastern United States. Today, 
Crescent Mortgage Company lends in 45 states and has partnered with community banks, credit unions, 
and mortgage brokers. Crescent Mortgage Company is based in Atlanta, Georgia.

Carolina Services Corporation of Charleston, a Delaware financial services company incorporat-
ed in 2002 to provide financial processing services to, and otherwise support the operations of, the Bank 
and Crescent Mortgage Company.

In December 2002 and October 2003, respectively, the Company formed Carolina Financial Cap-
ital	Trust	I	and	Carolina	Financial	Capital	Trust	II,	which	are	special	purpose	subsidiaries	organized	in	
Delaware for the sole purpose of issuing an aggregate of $15 million of trust preferred securities.

On December 12, 2014, the Bank purchased 13 branches located in South Carolina and south-
eastern North Carolina from First Community Bank. In the transaction, the Bank acquired approximately 
$215.1 million of deposits, approximately $70.9 million of performing loans, and the bank facilities and 
certain other assets of the acquired branches.

On  January  5,  2016,  Carolina  Financial  Corporation  announced  the  execution  of  a  definitive 
agreement pursuant to which we will acquire Congaree Bancshares, Inc., the holding company of Conga-
ree State Bank, in a cash and stock transaction with a total current value of approximately $16.3 million 
including the assumption of approximately $1.6 million in preferred stock.

Our main office is located at 288 Meeting Street, Charleston, South Carolina 29401.

Our Market Area

Our primary market areas are the South Carolina coast, including the Charleston (Charleston, 
Dorchester, and Berkeley Counties) and Myrtle Beach (Horry and Georgetown Counties) market areas, 

4

and the southeastern coastal region of North Carolina, including Bladen, Brunswick, Columbus and New 
Hanover Counties. We currently operate 27 branches: eight in the Charleston market, eight in the Myrtle 
Beach market, nine in southeastern North Carolina and two in other South Carolina markets. We also 
operate loan production offices in Greenville, South Carolina and Wilmington, North Carolina.

The following table presents, for each of our above-described primary market areas, the number 
of branches of CresCom  Bank  in  the  market  area, the approximate amount of deposits with CresCom 
Bank in the market area as of June 30, 2015 and our approximate deposit market share in market area at 
June 30, 2015 (the latest date for which such data is available). This table does not include deposits held in 
Greenville, South Carolina branch, which opened on August 31, 2015 or those held in our Heath Springs, 
South Carolina branch.

Market Name

Charleston, South Carolina
Myrtle Beach, South Carolina
Southeastern North Carolina

  Number of 
Branches
8
8
9

    Deposits 

(in millions)

    Market 
Share

$
$
$

518.5     
294.4     
188.1     

4.60%
4.40%
2.49%

The	Charleston,	South	Carolina	is	heavily	influenced	by	the	diverse	economic	mix	of	the	Charleston	 
region. The region is home to the Port of Charleston, one of the busiest container ports along the South-
east and Gulf Coasts, as well as a number of national and international manufacturers, including Boeing 
South  Carolina  and  Robert  Bosch  LLC.  The  region  also  benefits  from  a  thriving  tourism  industry.  In 
addition, a number of academic institutions are located within the region, including the Medical Univer-
sity of South Carolina, The Citadel, The College of Charleston, Charleston Southern University, Trident 
Technical College and The Charleston School of Law. Charleston also hosts military installations for the 
U.S. Navy, Marine Corps, U.S. Air Force, U.S. Army and U.S. Coast Guard.

The Myrtle Beach area, also known as the Grand Strand, is a 60-mile stretch of beaches extending 
south from the South Carolina/North Carolina state line to Pawley’s Island and is consistently ranked as 
one of the top vacation destinations in the country. The economy of the region is dominated by the tourism 
and retail industries. The Myrtle Beach-Conway-North Myrtle Beach market area is also home to Coastal 
Carolina University in Conway and Webster University in Myrtle Beach.

Our markets in southeastern North Carolina are contiguous to  South Carolina and the Grand 
Strand. These markets are situated south and west of the Wilmington, North Carolina MSA. We currently 
maintain  a  loan  production  office  in  the  Wilmington  MSA,  and  we  believe  there  are  opportunities  for 
future expansion in the market. Wilmington has a diversified economy and is a major resort area and a 
center for light manufacturing. The city also serves as the retail and medical center for the region. Com-
panies in the Wilmington area produce fiber optic cables for the communications industry, aircraft engine 
parts, pharmaceuticals, nuclear fuel components and various textile products. This market area is home to 
several colleges including UNC-Wilmington.

In August 2015, we established a branch in the Greenville, South Carolina market. We had pre-
viously operated in Greenville through a loan production office. Greenville is located in the “Upstate” 
of South Carolina, which we believe represents a growing, business-friendly environment. Major indus-
tries in the Upstate include the automobile industry, which is concentrated primarily along the corridor 
between Greenville and Spartanburg around the BMW manufacturing facility in Greer, South Carolina. 
The Greenville Health System and Bon Secours St. Francis Health System represent the healthcare and 
pharmaceuticals industry in the area. The Upstate is also home to research and development facilities for 

5

2015 Form 10-K 
   
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 Michelin, Fuji and General Electric and research centers to support the automotive, life sciences, plastics 
and photonics industries. The Upstate also benefits from being an academic center and is home to col-
legiate and university education facilities such as Clemson University, Furman University, Presbyterian 
College, University of South Carolina-Upstate, Anderson University, Lander University, Bob Jones Uni-
versity, Wofford College and Converse College, among others.

Our markets have experienced steady economic and population growth over the past 10 years, and 
we expect that the areas, as well as the business and tourism industries needed to support it, will continue 
to grow.

Competition

The banking business is highly competitive, and we experience competition in our market areas 
from many other financial institutions.  Competition among financial institutions is based on interest rates 
offered on deposit accounts, interest rates charged on loans, other credit and service charges relating to 
loans, the quality and scope of the services rendered, the convenience of banking facilities, and, in the 
case of loans to commercial borrowers, relative lending limits.  We compete with commercial banks, credit 
unions, savings institutions, mortgage banking firms, consumer finance companies, securities brokerage 
firms, insurance companies, money market funds and other mutual funds, as well as super-regional, na-
tional and international financial institutions that operate offices in our market areas and elsewhere.

We compete with these institutions both in attracting deposits and in making loans.  In addition, we 
have to attract our customer base from other existing financial institutions and from new residents.  Many 
of our competitors are well-established, larger financial institutions, such as SunTrust, Bank of America, 
Wells Fargo and BB&T.  These institutions offer some services, including extensive and established branch 
networks, that we do not provide.  In addition, many of our non-bank competitors are not subject to the 
same extensive federal regulations that govern bank holding companies and federally insured banks.

Lending Activities

General.  We	 emphasize	 a	 range	 of	 lending	 services,	 including	 commercial	 and	 residential	 real	
 estate mortgage loans, real estate construction loans, commercial and industrial loans and consumer loans. 
Our	customers	are	generally	individuals	and	small	to	medium-sized	businesses	and	professional	firms	that	
are located in or conduct a substantial portion of their business in our market areas. We have focused 
our lending activities primarily on the professional market, including doctors, dentists, small business to 
	medium-sized	owners	and	commercial	real	estate	developers.

Certain credit risks are inherent in making loans. These include prepayment risks, risks resulting 
from uncertainties in the future value of collateral, risks resulting from changes in economic and industry 
conditions,  and  risks  inherent  in  dealing  with  individual  borrowers.  We  attempt  to  mitigate  repayment 
risks by adhering to internal credit policies and procedures. These policies and procedures include officer 
and customer lending limits, with approval processes for larger loans, documentation examination, and 
follow-up procedures for any exceptions to credit policies. Our loan approval policies provide for various 
levels of officer lending authority. When the amount of aggregate loans to a single borrower exceeds the 
maximum senior officer’s lending authority, the loan request will be considered by the management loan 
committee,  or  MLC,  which  is  comprised  of  five  members,  all  of  whom  are  part  of  the  senior  manage-
ment team of the Bank. The MLC meets weekly to approve loans with total loan commitments exceeding  
$1.0 million. The loan authority of the MLC is equal to two-thirds of the legal lending limit of the Bank 

6

which  is  equivalent  to  the  in-house  loan  limit.  Total  credit  exposure  above  the  in-house  limit  requires 
approval by the majority of the board of directors. We do not make any loans to any director, executive 
officer of the Bank, or the related interests of each, unless the loan is approved by the full Board of Di-
rectors of the Bank and is on terms not more favorable than would be available to a person not affiliated 
with the Bank.

Our lending activities are subject to a variety of lending limits imposed by federal law. In general, 
the Bank is subject to a legal limit on loans to a single borrower equal to 15% of the Bank’s capital and un-
impaired surplus. This legal lending limit will increase or decrease as the Bank’s level of capital increases 
or	decreases.	Based	upon	the	capitalization	of	the	Bank	at	December	31,	2015,	the	maximum	amount	we	
could lend to one borrower is $22.4 million. However, our internal lending limit without board approval at 
December 31, 2015 is $14.9 million. The board of directors will adjust the internal lending limit as deemed 
necessary to continue to mitigate risk and serve the Bank’s clients. We are able to sell participations in our 
larger loans to other financial institutions, which allow us to manage the risk involved in these loans and to 
meet the lending needs of our clients requiring extensions of credit in excess of these limits.

Real Estate Mortgage Loans. The principal component of our loan portfolio is loans secured by real 
estate mortgages. Real estate loans are subject to the same general risks as other loans and are particularly 
sensitive	to	fluctuations	in	the	value	of	real	estate.	Fluctuations	in	the	value	of	real	estate,	as	well	as	other	
factors	arising	after	a	loan	has	been	made,	could	negatively	affect	a	borrower’s	cash	flow,	creditworthiness,	
and ability to repay the loan. We obtain a security interest in real estate whenever possible, in addition to 
any other available collateral, in order to increase the likelihood of the ultimate repayment of the loan.

These loans generally fall into one of two categories:

•	

•	

	Residential Mortgage Loans and Home Equity Loans. We generally originate and hold short-
term and long-term first mortgages and traditional second mortgage residential real estate 
loans. Generally, we limit the loan-to-value ratio on our residential real estate loans to 90%. 
We offer fixed and adjustable rate residential real estate loans with terms of up to 30 years. 
We also offer a variety of lot loan options to consumers to purchase the lot on which they 
intend to build their home. The options available depend on whether the borrower intends 
to begin building within 12 months of the lot purchase or at an undetermined future date. 
We also offer traditional home equity loans and lines of credit. Our underwriting criteria for, 
and the risks associated with, home equity loans and lines of credit are generally the same 
as those for first mortgage loans. Home equity loans typically have terms of 10 years or less. 
We generally limit the extension of credit to 90% of the available equity of each property, 
although we may extend up to 100% of the available equity.

	Commercial Real Estate. Commercial real estate loans generally have terms of five years or 
less,	although	payments	may	be	structured	on	a	longer	amortization	basis.	We	evaluate	each	
borrower  on  an  individual  basis  and  attempt  to  determine  their  business  risks  and  credit 
profile. We attempt to reduce credit risk in the commercial real estate portfolio by empha-
sizing	 loans	 on	 owner-occupied	 office	 and	 retail	 buildings	 where	 the	 loan-to-value	 ratio,	
established by independent appraisals, generally does not exceed 80%. We also generally 
require	 that	 a	 borrower’s	 cash	 flow	 exceed	 120%	 of	 monthly	 debt	 service	 obligations.	 In	
order to ensure secondary sources of payment and liquidity to support a loan request, we 
typically review all of the personal financial statements of the principal owners and require 
their personal guarantees.

7

2015 Form 10-KReal  Estate  Construction  and  Development  Loans.  We  offer  fixed  and  adjustable  rate  residential 
and  commercial  construction  loan  financing  to  builders  and  developers  and  to  consumers  who  wish  to 
build their own home. The term of construction and development loans generally is limited to 18 months, 
although	payments	may	be	structured	on	a	longer	amortization	basis.	Most	loans	will	mature	and	require	
payment in full upon the sale of the property. We believe that construction and development loans gen-
erally  carry  a  higher  degree  of  risk  than  long-term  financing  of  existing  properties  because  repayment 
depends on the ultimate completion of the project and usually on the subsequent sale of the property. 
Specific risks include:

•	

cost	overruns;

•	 mismanaged	construction;

•	

inferior	or	improper	construction	techniques;

•	

economic	changes	or	downturns	during	construction;

•	

a	downturn	in	the	real	estate	market;

•	

rising	interest	rates	which	may	prevent	sale	of	the	property;	and

•	

failure	to	sell	completed	projects	in	a	timely	manner.

We attempt to reduce risk associated with construction and development loans by obtaining per-
sonal guarantees and by keeping the maximum loan-to-value ratio at or below 65%-85% of the lesser of 
cost or appraised value, depending on the project type. Generally, we do not have interest reserves built 
into	loan	commitments	but	require	periodic	cash	payments	for	interest	from	the	borrower’s	cash	flow.

Commercial Loans. We make loans for commercial purposes in various lines of businesses, includ-
ing  the  manufacturing  industry,  service  industry,  and  professional  service  areas.  Commercial  loans  are 
generally considered to have greater risk than first or second mortgages on real estate because they may 
be unsecured, or if they are secured, the value of the collateral may be difficult to assess and more likely 
to decrease than real estate.

Equipment loans typically will be made for a term of 10 years or less at fixed or variable rates, 
with	the	loan	fully	amortized	over	the	term	and	secured	by	the	financed	equipment.	Generally,	we	limit	
the loan-to-value ratio on these loans to 75% of cost. Working capital loans typically have terms not ex-
ceeding one year and usually are secured by accounts receivable, inventory, or personal guarantees of the 
principals of the business. For loans secured by accounts receivable or inventory, principal will typically 
be repaid as the assets securing the loan are converted into cash, and in other cases principal will typically 
be due at maturity. Trade letters of credit, standby letters of credit, and foreign exchange will generally be 
handled through a correspondent bank as agent for the Bank.

Our Charleston and Myrtle Beach markets have provided limited opportunities for us to develop 
a commercial and industrial (“C&I”) loan portfolio. The Company’s primary markets are generally con-
centrated in real estate lending. However, in order to diversify our lending portfolio, the Company began 
a syndicated loan program in 2014 to purchase nationally syndicated C&I loans to retain in the loan port-
folio.	These	loans	typically	have	terms	of	seven	years	and	are	tied	to	a	floating	rate	index	such	as	LIBOR	

8

or prime. To effectively manage this new line of lending, the Company hired an experienced senior lending 
executive with relevant experience to lead and manage this area of the loan portfolio and engaged a con-
sulting	firm	that	specializes	in	syndicated	loans.	The	Company’s	policy	currently	limits	the	syndicated	loan	
portfolio not to exceed 75% of the Bank’s Tier 1 regulatory capital.

Consumer Loans. We make a variety of loans to individuals for personal and household purposes, 
including secured and unsecured installment loans and revolving lines of credit. Consumer loans are un-
derwritten based on the borrower’s income, current debt level, past credit history, and the availability and 
value of collateral. Consumer rates are both fixed and variable, with negotiable terms. Our installment 
loans	typically	amortize	over	periods	up	to	72	months.	Although	we	typically	require	monthly	payments	
of interest and a portion of the principal on our loan products, we will offer consumer loans with a single 
maturity date when a specific source of repayment is available. Consumer loans are generally considered 
to have greater risk than first or second mortgages on real estate because they may be unsecured, or, if 
they are secured, the value of the collateral may be difficult to assess and more likely to decrease in value 
than real estate.

Mortgage Banking Activities

As	 summarized	 below,	 our	 mortgage	 banking	 segment	 associated	 with	 Crescent	 Mortgage	 

Company is comprised of two primary businesses: correspondent lending and loan servicing.

Correspondent  Lending. Our  mortgage  banking  operations  are  conducted  mainly  through  the 
Bank’s wholesale mortgage origination subsidiary, Crescent Mortgage Company, which is headquartered 
in Atlanta, Georgia. These operations consist of the purchase of mortgage loans and table funded origi-
nations as well as the sale and servicing of a variety of residential mortgage loan products. Crescent Mort-
gage Company lends in 45 states and partners with over 2,000 community banks, credit unions, and quality 
mortgage brokers. Crescent Mortgage Company focuses on originating residential real estate loans, some 
of which conform to Federal Housing Administration (FHA), Veterans Affairs (VA) and Rural Develop-
ment standards (RD). Loans originated that meet FHA standards qualify for the FHA’s insurance pro-
gram whereas loans that meet VA and RD standards are guaranteed by their respective federal agencies.

Mortgage loans that do not qualify under these programs are commonly referred to as conven-
tional loans. Conventional real estate loans could be conforming and non-conforming. Conforming loans 
are residential real estate loans that meet the standards for sale under the Federal National Mortgage 
Association (FNMA) and Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation (FHLMC) programs whereas loans 
that do not meet those standards are referred to as non-conforming residential real estate loans. In ad-
dition,  Crescent  Mortgage  Company  offers  certain  jumbo  mortgage  products  which  meet  underwriting 
requirements of certain correspondent lenders. The Company’s strategy is to grow market share through 
superior service and competitive pricing and high quality mortgage products. Crescent Mortgage Com-
pany generally sells mortgages it acquires to a number of investors like FNMA and FHLMC or major 
banking correspondents.

Our mortgage banking profitability depends on maintaining sufficient volume of loan originations 
combined with maintaining a profitable margin upon ultimate sale. Changes in the level of interest rates, 
competition and the local economy affect the number of loans originated and the amount of loan sales 
and loan fees earned.

9

2015 Form 10-KLoan Servicing. We retain the rights to service loans on a portion of loans we sell, and collect a 
servicing fee for loans we sell on the secondary market, as part of our mortgage banking activities. These 
rights are known as mortgage servicing rights, or MSRs, where the owner of the MSR acts on behalf of 
the	mortgage	loan	owner	and	has	the	contractual	right	to	receive	a	stream	of	cash	flows	in	exchange	for	
performing  specified  mortgage  servicing  functions.  These  duties  typically  include,  but  are  not  limited, 
to  performing  loan  administration,  collection,  and  default  activities,  collection  and  remittance  of  loan 
payments, responding to customer inquiries, accounting for principal and interest, holding custodial (im-
pound) funds for the payment of property taxes and insurance premiums, counseling delinquent mortgag-
ors,  modifying  loans,  supervising  foreclosures,  and  property  dispositions.  Crescent  Mortgage  Company 
uses a third party sub-servicer to perform the servicing duties and responsibilities for which we pay a fee.

Deposit Products

We  offer  a  full  range  of  deposit  services  that  are  typically  available  in  most  banks  and  savings 
institutions, including checking accounts, commercial accounts, savings accounts and other time deposits 
of various types, ranging from daily money market accounts to longer-term certificates of deposit.  Trans-
action accounts and time deposits are tailored to and offered at rates competitive to those offered in our 
primary market areas. In addition, we offer certain retirement accounts. We solicit accounts from indi-
viduals,	businesses,	associations,	organizations	and	governmental	authorities.	We	believe	that	our	branch	
infrastructure will assist us in obtaining deposits from local customers in the future. Our retail customer 
deposits were $882.9 million at December 31, 2015, or 85.6% of our total deposits.

Emerging Growth Company

We qualify as an “emerging growth company” as defined in the Jumpstart Our Business Startups 
Act of 2012 (the “JOBS Act”). As an “emerging growth company,” we may take advantage of some or 
all  of  the  reduced  disclosure  and  other  requirements  that  are  otherwise  applicable  generally  to  public 
 companies. These provisions include:

• 

• 

• 

• 

 only two years of audited financial statements in addition to any required unaudited interim 
financial statements with correspondingly reduced “Management’s Discussion and Analysis 
of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” disclosure;

reduced disclosure about our executive compensation arrangements;

 no  requirement  that  we  solicit  non-binding  advisory  votes  on  executive  compensation  or 
golden parachute arrangements; and

 exemption from the auditor attestation requirement in the assessment of our internal control 
over financial reporting.

As a result, the information that we provide to our stockholders may be different from the infor-
mation that you might receive from other public reporting companies in which you hold equity interests.

Section 107 of the JOBS Act also provides that an emerging growth company can take advan-
tage of the extended transition period provided in the Securities Act for complying with new or revised 
accounting standards. In other words, an emerging growth company can elect to delay the adoption of 

10

certain accounting standards until those standards would otherwise apply to private companies. We have 
irrevocably  elected  not  to  avail  ourselves  of  this  extended  transition  period  for  complying  with  new  or 
revised accounting standards and, as a result, we will adopt new or revised accounting standards on the 
relevant dates on which adoption of such standards is required for other companies.

We could remain an emerging growth company for up to five years, or until the earliest of (i) the 
last day of the first fiscal year in which our annual gross revenues exceed $1 billion, (ii) the date that we 
become a “large accelerated filer” as defined in Rule 12b-2 under the Exchange Act, which would occur if 
the market value of our common stock held by non-affiliates exceeds $700 million as of the last business 
day of our most recently completed second fiscal quarter, (iii) the date on which we have issued more than 
$1 billion in non-convertible debt during the preceding three-year period and (iv) the last day of the fiscal 
year following the fifth anniversary of the date of the first sale of our common equity securities pursuant to 
an effective registration statement under the Securities Act, which would be December 2019. At this time, 
we expect to remain an “emerging growth company” for the foreseeable future.

Employees

As of March 14, 2016, we had 421 total employees, including 402 full-time employees.

SUPERVISION AND REGULATION

Both the Company and the Bank are subject to extensive state and federal banking laws and regu-
lations that impose restrictions on and provide for general regulatory oversight of their operations.  These 
laws and regulations generally are intended to protect consumers and depositors and not stockholders.  
The  following  summary  is  qualified  by  reference  to  the  statutory  and  regulatory  provisions  discussed.  
Changes in applicable laws or regulations may have a material effect on our business and prospects. Our 
operations may be affected by legislative changes and the policies of various regulatory authorities. We 
cannot predict the effect that fiscal or monetary policies, economic control or new federal or state legisla-
tion may have on our business and earnings in the future.

The following discussion is not intended to be a complete list of all the activities regulated by the 
banking	laws	or	of	the	impact	of	those	laws	and	regulations	on	our	operations.		It	is	intended	only	to	briefly	
summarize	some	material	provisions.

Recent Legislative and Regulatory Initiatives to Address the Financial and Economic Crises

Markets in the United States and elsewhere experienced extreme volatility and disruption begin-
ning in the latter half of 2007 from which they have not fully recovered. These circumstances exerted sig-
nificant downward pressure on prices of equity securities and virtually all other asset classes, and resulted 
in substantially increased market volatility, severely constrained credit and capital markets, particularly 
for financial institutions, and caused an overall loss of investor confidence. Loan portfolio performances 
deteriorated at many institutions resulting from, among other factors, a weak economy and a decline in 
the value of the collateral supporting their loans. Dramatic slowdowns in the housing industry, due in part 
to falling home prices and increasing foreclosures and unemployment, have created strains on financial 
institutions. Many borrowers were unable to repay their loans, and the collateral securing these loans, in 
some cases, declined below the loan balance. In response to the challenges facing the financial services 
sector, the following regulatory and governmental actions were enacted.

11

2015 Form 10-KThe Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act

On  July  21,  2010,  President  Obama  signed  into  law  The  Dodd-Frank  Wall  Street  Reform  and 
Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”), which, among other things, changes the oversight and 
supervision of financial institutions, includes new minimum capital requirements, creates a new federal 
agency to regulate consumer financial products and services and implements changes to corporate gover-
nance and compensation practices. The Dodd-Frank Act is focused in large part on the financial services 
industry, particularly bank holding companies with consolidated assets of $50 billion or more, and contains 
a number of provisions that will affect us, including:

Minimum  Leverage  and  Risk-Based  Capital  Requirements.  Under  the  Dodd-Frank  Act,  the  ap-
propriate  Federal  banking  agencies  are  required  to  establish  minimum  leverage  and  risk-based  capital 
requirements on a consolidated basis for all insured depository institutions and bank holding companies, 
which can be no less than the currently applicable leverage and risk-based capital requirements for depos-
itory institutions. As a result, the Bank will be subject to at least the same capital requirements and must 
include the same components in regulatory capital.

Deposit Insurance Modifications. The Dodd-Frank Act modifies the FDIC’s assessment base upon 
which deposit insurance premiums are calculated. The new assessment base will equal our average total 
consolidated assets minus the sum of our average tangible equity during the assessment period. The Dodd-
Frank Act also permanently raises the standard maximum insurance amount to $250,000.

Creation of New Governmental Authorities. The Dodd-Frank Act creates various new governmen-
tal authorities such as the Financial Stability Oversight Council and the Consumer Financial Protection 
Bureau, or CFPB, an independent regulatory authority housed within the Federal Reserve. The CFPB has 
broad authority to regulate the offering and provision of consumer financial products. The CFPB officially 
came into being on July 21, 2011, and rulemaking authority for a range of consumer financial protection 
laws (such as the Truth in Lending Act, the Electronic Funds Transfer Act and the Real Estate Settlement 
Procedures Act, among others) transferred from the Federal Reserve and other federal regulators to the 
CFPB on that date. The Dodd-Frank Act gives the CFPB authority to supervise and examine depository 
institutions  with  more  than  $10  billion  in  assets  for  compliance  with  these  federal  consumer  laws.  The 
authority to supervise and examine depository institutions with $10 billion or less in assets for compliance 
with federal consumer laws will remain largely with those institutions’ primary regulators. However, the 
CFPB may participate in examinations of these smaller institutions on a “sampling basis” and may refer 
potential enforcement actions against such institutions to their primary regulators. The CFPB also has 
supervisory  and  examination  authority  over  certain  nonbank  institutions  that  offer  consumer  financial 
products.	The	Dodd-Frank	Act	identifies	a	number	of	covered	nonbank	institutions,	and	also	authorizes	
the CFPB to identify additional institutions that will be subject to its jurisdiction. Accordingly, the CFPB 
may participate in examinations of the Bank, which currently has assets of less than $10 billion, and could 
supervise and examine our other direct or indirect subsidiaries that offer consumer financial products or 
services. In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act permits states to adopt consumer protection laws and regula-
tions that are stricter than those regulations promulgated by the CFPB, and state attorneys general are 
permitted to enforce consumer protection rules adopted by the CFPB against certain institutions.

The	Dodd-Frank	Act	also	authorized	the	CFPB	to	establish	certain	minimum	standards	for	the	
origination of residential mortgages, including a determination of the borrower’s ability to repay. Under 
the Dodd-Frank Act, financial institutions may not make a residential mortgage loan unless they make a 
“reasonable and good faith determination” that the consumer has a “reasonable ability” to repay the loan. 
The Dodd-Frank Act allows borrowers to raise certain defenses to foreclosure but provides a full or partial 

12

safe harbor from such defenses for loans that are “qualified mortgages.” On January 10, 2013, the CFPB 
published final rules to, among other things, specify the types of income and assets that may be considered 
in the ability-to-repay determination, the permissible sources for verification, and the required methods of 
calculating the loan’s monthly payments. Since then the CFPB made certain modifications to these rules. 
The rules extend the requirement that creditors verify and document a borrower’s “income and assets” to 
include all “information” that creditors rely on in determining repayment ability. The rules also provide 
further examples of third-party documents that may be relied on for such verification, such as government 
records and check-cashing or funds-transfer service receipts. The rules took effect January 10, 2014. The 
rules also define “qualified mortgages,” imposing both underwriting standards - for example, a borrower’s 
debt-to-income ratio may not exceed 43% - and limits on the terms of their loans. Points and fees are 
subject to a relatively stringent cap, and the terms include a wide array of payments that may be made in 
the	course	of	closing	a	loan.	Certain	loans,	including	interest-only	loans	and	negative	amortization	loans,	
cannot be qualified mortgages.

Executive Compensation and Corporate Governance Requirements. The Dodd-Frank Act requires 
public companies to include, at least once every three years, a separate non-binding “say on pay” vote 
in their proxy statement by which stockholders may vote on the compensation of the company’s named 
executive officers. In addition, if such companies are involved in a merger, acquisition, or consolidation, 
or if they propose to sell or dispose of all or substantially all of their assets, stockholders have a right to 
an advisory vote on any golden parachute arrangements in connection with such transaction (frequently 
referred to as “say-on-golden parachute” vote). Other provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act may impact our 
corporate governance. For instance, the Dodd-Frank Act requires the SEC to adopt rules:

•	

•	

	prohibiting	the	listing	of	any	equity	security	of	a	company	that	does	not	have	an	independent	
compensation committee; and

	requiring	all	exchange-traded	companies	to	adopt	clawback	policies	for	incentive	compen-
sation paid to executive officers in the event of accounting restatements based on material 
non-compliance with financial reporting requirements.

The	Dodd-Frank	Act	also	authorizes	the	SEC	to	issue	rules	allowing	stockholders	to	include	their	
own nominations for directors in a company’s proxy solicitation materials. Many provisions of the Dodd-
Frank Act require the adoption of additional rules to implement the changes. In addition, the Dodd-Frank 
Act mandates multiple studies that could result in additional legislative Action. Governmental interven-
tion and new regulations under these programs could materially and adversely affect our business, finan-
cial condition and results of operations.

Basel Capital Standards

In December 2010, the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision, or BCBS, an international fo-
rum for cooperation on banking supervisory matters, announced the “Basel III” capital standards, which 
substantially	revised	the	existing	capital	requirements	for	banking	organizations.	On	July	2,	2013,	the	Fed-
eral Reserve adopted a final rule for the Basel III capital framework and, on July 9, 2013, the OCC also 
adopted a final rule and the FDIC adopted the same provisions in the form of an “interim” final rule. The 
rule applies to all national and state banks and savings associations and most bank holding companies and 
savings	and	loan	holding	companies,	which	we	collectively	refer	to	herein	as	“covered”	banking	organiza-
tions. In certain respects, the rule imposes more stringent requirements on “advanced approaches” bank-
ing	organizations—those	organizations	with	$250	billion	or	more	in	total	consolidated	assets,	$10	billion	
or more in total foreign exposures, or that have opted in to the Basel II capital regime. The requirements 

13

2015 Form 10-Kin	 the	 rule	 began	 to	 phase	 in	 on	 January	 1,	 2014	 for	 advanced	 approaches	 banking	 organizations,	 and	
on	January	1,	2015	for	other	covered	banking	organizations,	including	the	Company	and	the	Bank.	The	
 requirements in the rule will be fully phased in by January 1, 2019.

The rule imposes new and higher risk-based capital and leverage requirements than those previ-

ously in place. Specifically, the following minimum capital requirements apply to us:

• 

• 

• 

• 

a new Common Equity Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 4.5%;

a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6% (increased from the former 4% requirement);

a total risk-based capital ratio of 8% (unchanged from the former requirements); and

a leverage ratio of 4%; and

Under the rule, Tier 1 capital is redefined to include two components: Common Equity Tier 1 cap-
ital and additional Tier 1 capital. The new and highest form of capital, Common Equity Tier 1 capital, con-
sists solely of common stock (plus related surplus), retained earnings, accumulated other comprehensive 
income, and limited amounts of minority interests that are in the form of common stock. Additional Tier 1 
capital includes other perpetual instruments historically included in Tier 1 capital, such as non-cumulative 
perpetual preferred stock. The rule permits bank holding companies with less than $15 billion in total con-
solidated assets to continue to include trust preferred securities and cumulative perpetual preferred stock 
issued before May 19, 2010 in Tier 1 capital, but not in Common Equity Tier 1 capital, subject to certain 
restrictions. Tier 2 capital consists of instruments that currently qualify in Tier 2 capital plus instruments 
that the rule has disqualified from Tier 1 capital treatment. Cumulative perpetual preferred stock, former-
ly includable in Tier 1 capital is now included only in Tier 2 capital. Accumulated other comprehensive 
income (“AOCI”) is presumptively included in Common Equity Tier 1 capital and often would operate to 
reduce this category of capital. The rules provided for a one-time opportunity at the end of the first quarter 
of	2015	for	covered	banking	organization	to	opt-out	of	much	of	this	treatment	of	AOCI.	We	made	this	
opt-out election and, as a result, will retain the pre-existing treatment for AOCI.

In addition, in order to avoid restrictions on capital distributions or discretionary bonus payments 
to	executives,	a	covered	banking	organization	must	maintain	a	“capital	conservation	buffer”	on	top	of	its	
minimum risk-based capital requirements. This buffer must consist solely of Tier 1 common equity, but 
the buffer applies to all three measurements (Common Equity Tier 1, Tier 1 capital and total capital). The 
capital conservation buffer will be phased in incrementally over time, becoming fully effective on January 
1, 2019, and will consist of an additional amount of common equity equal to 2.5% of risk-based assets.

In general, the rule have had the effect of increasing capital requirements by increasing the risk 
weights on certain assets, including high volatility commercial real estate, certain loans past due 90 days or 
more or in nonaccrual status, mortgage servicing rights not includable in Common Equity Tier 1 capital, 
equity exposures, and claims on securities firms, that are used in the denominator of the three risk-based 
capital ratios.

Proposed Legislation and Regulatory Action

From time to time, various legislative and regulatory initiatives are introduced in Congress and 
state legislatures, as well as by regulatory agencies. Such initiatives may include proposals to expand or 

14

contract the powers of bank holding companies and depository institutions or proposals to substantially 
change the financial institution regulatory system. Such legislation could change banking statutes and the 
operating environment of the Company in substantial and unpredictable ways. If enacted, such legislation 
could increase or decrease the cost of doing business, limit or expand permissible activities or affect the 
competitive balance among banks, savings associations, credit unions, and other financial institutions. We 
cannot predict whether any such legislation will be enacted, and, if enacted, the effect that it, or any im-
plementing regulations, would have on the financial condition or results of operations of the Company. A 
change in statutes, regulations or regulatory policies applicable to the Company or the Bank could have a 
material effect on the business of the Company.

Volcker Rule

Section  619  of  the  Dodd-Frank  Act,  known  as  the  “Volcker  Rule,”  prohibits  any  bank,  bank 
holding company, or affiliate (referred to collectively as “banking entities”) from engaging in two types 
of activities: “proprietary trading” and the ownership or sponsorship of private equity or hedge funds 
that are referred to as “covered funds.” Proprietary trading includes the purchase or sale of principal of 
any security, derivative, commodity future, or option on any such instrument for the purpose of benefit-
ting	from	short-term	price	movements	or	realizing	short-term	profits.	In	December	2013,	our	primary	
federal  regulators,  the  Federal  Reserve  and  the  FDIC,  together  with  other  federal  banking  agencies 
and	the	SEC	and	the	Commodity	Futures	Trading	Commission,	finalized	a	regulation	to	implement	the	
Volcker Rule.

Exceptions  apply,  however.  Trading  in  U.S.  Treasuries,  obligations  or  other  instruments  issued 
by a government sponsored enterprise, state or municipal obligations, or obligations of the FDIC is per-
mitted. A banking entity also may trade for the purpose of managing its liquidity, provided that it has a 
bona fide liquidity management plan. Trading activities as agent, broker or custodian; through a deferred 
compensation or pension plan; as trustee or fiduciary on behalf of customers; in order to satisfy a debt 
previously contracted; or in repurchase and securities lending agreements are permitted. Additionally, the 
Volcker Rule permits banking entities to engage in trading that takes the form of risk-mitigating hedging 
activities.

The covered funds that a banking entity may not sponsor or hold an ownership interest in are, 
with certain exceptions, funds that are exempt from registration under the Investment Company Act of 
1940  because  they  either  have  100  or  fewer  investors  or  are  owned  exclusively  by  “qualified  investors” 
(generally, high net worth individuals or entities). Wholly-owned subsidiaries, joint ventures and acquisi-
tion vehicles, foreign pension or retirement funds, insurance company separate accounts (including bank-
owned life insurance), public welfare investment funds, and entities formed by the FDIC for the purpose 
of	disposing	of	assets	are	not	covered	funds,	and	a	bank	may	invest	in	them.	Most	securitizations	also	are	
not treated as covered funds.

The	regulation	as	issued	on	December	10,	2013,	treated	collateralized	debt	obligations	backed	
by trust preferred securities as covered funds and accordingly subject to divestiture. In an interim final 
rule	issued	on	January	14,	2014,	the	agencies	exempted	collateralized	debt	obligations,	or	CDOs,	issued	
before May 19, 2010, that were backed by trust preferred securities issued before the same date by a bank 
with total consolidated assets of less than $15 billion or by a mutual holding company, and that the bank 
holding the CDO interest had purchased before December 10, 2013, from the Volcker Rule prohibition. 
This  exemption  does  not  extend  to  CDOs  backed  by  trust-preferred  securities  issued  by  an  insurance 
company.

15

2015 Form 10-KCarolina Financial Corporation

The Company owns 100% of the outstanding capital stock of the Bank, and therefore is required 
to be and is registered as a bank holding company under the federal Bank Holding Company Act of 1956 
(the “BHCA”). As a result, the Company is primarily subject to the supervision, examination and reporting 
requirements of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve (the “Federal Reserve”) under the BHCA 
and its regulations promulgated thereunder. Moreover, as a bank holding company of a bank located in 
South Carolina, the Company also is subject to the South Carolina Banking and Branching Efficiency Act.

Permitted Activities. Under the BHCA, a bank holding company is generally permitted to engage 
in, or acquire direct or indirect control of more than 5% of the voting shares of any company engaged in 
the following activities:

• 

• 

• 

banking or managing or controlling banks;

furnishing services to or performing services for our subsidiaries; and

 any activity that the Federal Reserve determines to be so closely related to banking as to be a 
proper incident to the business of banking.

Activities that the Federal Reserve has found to be so closely related to banking as to be a proper 

incident to the business of banking include:

• 

factoring accounts receivable;

•  making, acquiring, brokering or servicing loans and usual related activities;

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

leasing personal or real property;

operating a non-bank depository institution, such as a savings association;

trust company functions;

financial and investment advisory activities;

conducting discount securities brokerage activities;

underwriting and dealing in government obligations and money market instruments;

providing specified management consulting and counseling activities;

performing selected data processing services and support services;

 acting  as  agent  or  broker  in  selling  credit  life  insurance  and  other  types  of  insurance  in  
connection with credit transactions; and

• 

performing selected insurance underwriting activities.

16

As  a  bank  holding  company  we  also  can  elect  to  be  treated  as  a  “financial  holding  company,” 
which would allow us to engage in a broader array of activities. In summary, a financial holding company 
can engage in activities that are financial in nature or incidental or complimentary to financial activities, 
including insurance underwriting, sales and brokerage activities, providing financial and investment advi-
sory services, underwriting services and limited merchant banking activities. We have not sought financial 
holding company status but may elect such status in the future as our business matures. If we were to elect 
financial holding company status, each insured depository institution we control would have to be well 
capitalized,	well	managed,	and	have	at	least	a	satisfactory	rating	under	the	Community	Reinvestment	Act	
(discussed below).

The Federal Reserve has the authority to order a bank holding company or its subsidiaries to ter-
minate any of these activities or to terminate its ownership or control of any subsidiary when it has reason-
able cause to believe that the bank holding company’s continued ownership, activity or control constitutes 
a serious risk to the financial safety, soundness or stability of it or any of its bank subsidiaries.

Change in Control. In addition, and subject to certain exceptions, the BHCA and the Change in 
Bank Control Act, together with regulations promulgated thereunder, require Federal Reserve approval 
prior to any person or company acquiring “control” of a bank holding company. Control is conclusively 
presumed to exist if an individual or company acquires 25% or more of any class of voting securities of a 
bank holding company. Following the relaxing of these restrictions by the Federal Reserve in September 
2008, control will be presumed to exist if a person acquires more than 33% of the total equity of a bank or 
bank holding company, of which it may own, control or have the power to vote not more than 15% of any 
class of voting securities.

Source of Strength. There are a number of obligations and restrictions imposed by law and regu-
latory policy on bank holding companies with regard to their depository institution subsidiaries that are 
designed	to	minimize	potential	loss	to	depositors	and	to	the	FDIC	insurance	funds	in	the	event	that	the	
depository institution becomes in danger of defaulting under its obligations to repay deposits. In accor-
dance with Federal Reserve policy, the Company is required to act as a source of financial strength to the 
Bank and to commit resources to support the Bank in circumstances in which it might not otherwise do so. 
Under the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporate Improvement Act of 1991, or FDICIA, to avoid receiver-
ship of its insured depository institution subsidiary, a bank holding company is required to guarantee the 
compliance	of	any	insured	depository	institution	subsidiary	that	may	become	“undercapitalized”	within	
the terms of any capital restoration plan filed by such subsidiary with its appropriate federal banking agen-
cy up to the lesser of (i) an amount equal to 5% of the institution’s total assets at the time the institution 
became	undercapitalized,	or	(ii)	the	amount	which	is	necessary	(or	would	have	been	necessary)	to	bring	
the institution into compliance with all applicable capital standards as of the time the institution fails to 
comply with such capital restoration plan.

Under the BHCA, the Federal Reserve may require a bank holding company to terminate any 
activity or relinquish control of a non-bank subsidiary, other than a non-bank subsidiary of a bank, upon 
the Federal Reserve’s determination that such activity or control constitutes a serious risk to the financial 
soundness or stability of any depository institution subsidiary of a bank holding company. Further, federal 
bank regulatory authorities have additional discretion to require a bank holding company to divest itself 
of any bank or non-bank subsidiaries if the agency determines that divestiture may aid the depository in-
stitution’s financial condition.

17

2015 Form 10-KIn addition, the “cross guarantee” provisions of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, FDIA, re-
quire insured depository institutions under common control to reimburse the FDIC for any loss suffered 
or reasonably anticipated by the FDIC as a result of the default of a commonly controlled insured depos-
itory institution or for any assistance provided by the FDIC to a commonly controlled insured depository 
institution in danger of default. The FDIC’s claim for damages is superior to claims of stockholders of the 
insured depository institution or its holding company, but is subordinate to claims of depositors, secured 
creditors  and  holders  of  subordinated  debt  (other  than  affiliates)  of  the  commonly  controlled  insured 
depository institutions.

The FDIA also provides that amounts received from the liquidation or other resolution of any 
insured depository institution by any receiver must be distributed (after payment of secured claims) to pay 
the deposit liabilities of the institution prior to payment of any other general or unsecured senior liability, 
subordinated liability, general creditor or stockholder. This provision would give depositors a preference 
over general and subordinated creditors and stockholders in the event a receiver is appointed to distribute 
the assets of the Bank.

Further, any capital loans by a bank holding company to a subsidiary bank are subordinate in right 
of payment to deposits and certain other indebtedness of the subsidiary bank. In the event of a bank hold-
ing company’s bankruptcy, any commitment by the bank holding company to a federal bank regulatory 
agency to maintain the capital of a subsidiary bank at a certain level would be assumed by the bankruptcy 
trustee and entitled to priority payment.  

Capital  Requirements. The  Federal  Reserve  imposes  certain  capital  requirements  on  the  bank 
holding company under the BHCA, including a minimum leverage ratio and a minimum ratio of “qualify-
ing” capital to risk-weighted assets. These requirements are essentially the same as those that apply to the 
Bank and are described below under “CresCom Bank.” Subject to our capital requirements and certain 
other restrictions, we are able to borrow money to make a capital contribution to the Bank, and these 
loans may be repaid from dividends paid from the Bank to the Company. We are also able to raise capital 
for contribution to the Bank by issuing securities without having to receive regulatory approval, subject to 
compliance with federal and state securities laws.

Dividends. Since the Company is a bank holding company, its ability to declare and pay dividends 
is dependent on certain federal and state regulatory considerations, including the guidelines of the Federal 
Reserve. The Federal Reserve has issued a policy statement regarding the payment of dividends by bank 
holding companies. In general, the Federal Reserve’s policies provide that dividends should be paid only 
out of current earnings and only if the prospective rate of earnings retention by the bank holding company 
appears	consistent	with	the	organization’s	capital	needs,	asset	quality,	and	overall	financial	condition.	The	
Federal Reserve’s policies also require that a bank holding company serve as a source of financial strength 
to its subsidiary banks by standing ready to use available resources to provide adequate capital funds to 
those	banks	during	periods	of	financial	stress	or	adversity	and	by	maintaining	the	financial	flexibility	and	
capital-raising capacity to obtain additional resources for assisting its subsidiary banks where necessary. 
Further, under the prompt corrective action regulations, the ability of a bank holding company to pay div-
idends	may	be	restricted	if	a	subsidiary	bank	becomes	undercapitalized.	These	regulatory	policies	could	
affect the ability of the Company to pay dividends or otherwise engage in capital distributions.

In  addition,  since  the  Company  is  a  legal  entity  separate  and  distinct  from  the  Bank  and  does 
not conduct stand-alone operations, its ability to pay dividends depends on the ability of the Bank to pay 
dividends to it, which is also subject to regulatory restrictions as described below in “CresCom Bank – 
Dividends.”

18

South  Carolina  State  Regulation.  As  a  South  Carolina  bank  holding  company  under  the  South 
Carolina Banking and Branching Efficiency Act, we are subject to limitations on sale or merger and to 
regulation by the South Carolina Board of Financial Institutions (the “SCBFI”). We are not required to 
obtain the approval of the SCBFI prior to acquiring the capital stock of a national bank, but we must notify 
them at least 15 days prior to doing so. We must obtain approval from the SCBFI prior to engaging in the 
acquisition of branches, a South Carolina state chartered bank, or another South Carolina bank holding 
company.

CresCom Bank

The Bank’s primary federal regulator is the FDIC. In addition, the Bank is regulated and exam-
ined by the SCBFI. Deposits in the Bank are insured by the FDIC up to a maximum amount of $250,000 
per depositor, per ownership category, pursuant to the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act.

The SCBFI and the FDIC regulate or monitor virtually all areas of the Bank’s operations, including:

•	

security	devices	and	procedures;

•	

adequacy	of	capitalization	and	loss	reserves;

•	

loans;

•	

investments;

•	

borrowings;

•	

deposits;

•	 mergers;

•	

issuances	of	securities;

•	

payment	of	dividends;

•	

interest	rates	payable	on	deposits;

•	

interest	rates	or	fees	chargeable	on	loans;

•	

establishment	of	branches;

•	

corporate	reorganizations;

•	 maintenance	of	books	and	records;	and

•	

adequacy	of	staff	training	to	carry	on	safe	lending	and	deposit	gathering	practices.

19

2015 Form 10-KThese agencies, and the federal and state laws applicable to the Bank’s operations, extensively 
regulate  various  aspects  of  our  banking  business,  including  among  other  things,  permissible  types  and 
amounts of loans, investments, and other activities capital adequacy, branching, interest rates on loans and 
deposits, maintenance of reserves and the safety and soundness of our banking practices. See additional 
discussion related to Basel III above.

All insured institutions must undergo regular on-site examinations by their appropriate banking 
agency. The cost of examinations of insured depository institutions and any affiliates may be assessed by 
the appropriate federal banking agency against each institution or affiliate as it deems necessary or ap-
propriate. Insured institutions are required to submit annual reports to the FDIC, their federal regulatory 
agency, and state supervisor when applicable. The FDIC has developed a method for insured depository 
institutions to provide supplemental disclosure of the estimated fair market value of assets and liabilities, 
to the extent feasible and practicable, in any balance sheet, financial statement, report of condition or any 
other report of any insured depository institution. The federal banking regulatory agencies to prescribe, by 
regulation, standards for all insured depository institutions and depository institution holding companies 
relating, among other things, to the following:

•	

internal	controls;

•	

information	systems	and	audit	systems;

•	

loan	documentation;

•	

credit	underwriting;

•	

interest	rate	risk	exposure;	and

•	

asset	quality.

Prompt Corrective Action. As an insured depository institution, the Bank is required to comply with 
the capital requirements promulgated under the Federal Deposit Insurance Act and the prompt corrective 
action regulations thereunder, which set forth five capital categories, each with specific regulatory conse-
quences. Under these regulations, the categories are:

As an insured depository institution, the Bank is required to comply with the capital requirements 
promulgated under the FDIA and the prompt corrective action regulations thereunder, which set forth 
five capital categories, each with specific regulatory consequences.  Under these regulations, the categories 
are:

•	

	Well	Capitalized	—	The	institution	exceeds	the	required	minimum	level	for	each	relevant	
capital	measure.		A	well	capitalized	institution	(i)	has	total	risk-based	capital	ratio	of	10%	or	
greater, (ii) has a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 8% or greater, (iii) has a Common Equity 
Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6.5% or greater, (iv) has a leverage capital ratio of 5% or 
greater, and (v) is not subject to any order or written directive to meet and maintain a specific 
capital level for any capital measure.

•	

	Adequately	Capitalized	—	The	institution	meets	the	required	minimum	level	for	each	rele-
vant capital measure.  No capital distribution may be made that would result in the institution 

20

becoming	undercapitalized.		An	adequately	capitalized	institution	(i)	has	a	total	risk-based	
capital  ratio  of  8%  or  greater,  (ii)  has  a  Tier  1  risk-based  capital  ratio  of  6%  or  greater,  
(iii) has a Common Equity Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 4.5% or greater, and (iv) has a 
leverage capital ratio of 4% or greater.

	Undercapitalized	—	The	institution	fails	to	meet	the	required	minimum	level	for	any	relevant	
capital	measure.		An	undercapitalized	institution	(i)	has	a	total	risk-based	capital	ratio	of	less	
than 8%, (ii) has a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of less than 6%, (iii) has a Common Equity 
Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of less than 4.5%, or (iv) has a leverage capital ratio of less than 
4%.

	Significantly	Undercapitalized	—	The	institution	is	significantly	below	the	required	minimum	
level	for	any	relevant	capital	measure.		A	significantly	undercapitalized	institution	(i)	has	a	
total risk-based capital ratio of less than 6%, (ii) has a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of less 
than 4%, (iii) has a Common Equity Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of less than 3%, or (iv) has 
a leverage capital ratio of less than 3%.

	Critically	Undercapitalized	—	The	institution	fails	to	meet	a	critical	capital	level	set	by	the	
appropriate	federal	banking	agency.		A	critically	undercapitalized	institution	has	a	ratio	of	
tangible equity to total assets that is equal to or less than 2%.

•	

•	

•	

If the applicable federal regulator determines, after notice and an opportunity for hearing, that 
the	institution	is	in	an	unsafe	or	unsound	condition,	the	regulator	is	authorized	to	reclassify	the	institution	
to the next lower capital

If the FDIC determines, after notice and an opportunity for hearing, that the bank is in an unsafe 
or	unsound	condition,	the	regulator	is	authorized	to	reclassify	the	bank	to	the	next	lower	capital	catego-
ry	(other	than	critically	undercapitalized)	and	require	the	submission	of	a	plan	to	correct	the	unsafe	or	
 unsound condition.

If	 a	 bank	 is	 not	 well	 capitalized,	 it	 cannot	 accept	 brokered	 deposits	 without	 prior	 regulatory	 
approval.	In	addition,	a	bank	that	is	not	well	capitalized	cannot	offer	an	effective	yield	in	excess	of	75	basis	
points	over	interest	paid	on	deposits	of	comparable	size	and	maturity	in	such	institution’s	normal	market	
area for deposits accepted from within its normal market area, or national rate paid on deposits of compa-
rable	size	and	maturity	for	deposits	accepted	outside	the	bank’s	normal	market	area.	Moreover,	the	FDIC	
generally prohibits a depository institution from making any capital distributions (including payment of a 
dividend) or paying any management fee to its parent holding company if the depository institution would 
thereafter	 be	 categorized	 as	 undercapitalized.	 Undercapitalized	 institutions	 are	 subject	 to	 growth	 lim-
itations	(an	undercapitalized	institution	may	not	acquire	another	institution,	establish	additional	branch	
offices or engage in any new line of business unless determined by the appropriate federal banking agency 
to be consistent with an accepted capital restoration plan, or unless the FDIC determines that the pro-
posed action will further the purpose of prompt corrective action) and are required to submit a capital 
restoration plan. The agencies may not accept a capital restoration plan without determining, among other 
things, that the plan is based on realistic assumptions and is likely to succeed in restoring the depository 
institution’s capital. In addition, for a capital restoration plan to be acceptable, the depository institution’s 
parent holding company must guarantee that the institution will comply with the capital restoration plan. 
The aggregate liability of the parent holding company is limited to the lesser of an amount equal to 5.0% of 
the	depository	institution’s	total	assets	at	the	time	it	became	categorized	as	undercapitalized	or	the	amount	

21

2015 Form 10-Kthat is necessary (or would have been necessary) to bring the institution into compliance with all capital 
standards applicable with respect to such institution as of the time it fails to comply with the plan. If a 
depository	institution	fails	to	submit	an	acceptable	plan,	it	is	categorized	as	significantly	undercapitalized.

Significantly	undercapitalized	categorized	depository	institutions	may	be	subject	to	a	number	of	
requirements	 and	 restrictions,	 including	 orders	 to	 sell	 sufficient	 voting	 stock	 to	 become	 categorized	 as	
adequately	capitalized,	requirements	to	reduce	total	assets,	and	cessation	of	receipt	of	deposits	from	cor-
respondent	banks.	The	appropriate	federal	banking	agency	may	take	any	action	authorized	for	a	signifi-
cantly	undercapitalized	institution	if	an	undercapitalized	institution	fails	to	submit	an	acceptable	capital	
restoration plan or fails in any material respect to implement a plan accepted by the agency. A critically 
undercapitalized	institution	is	subject	to	having	a	receiver	or	conservator	appointed	to	manage	its	affairs	
and for loss of its charter to conduct banking activities.

An insured depository institution may not pay a management fee to a bank holding company con-
trolling that institution or any other person having control of the institution if, after making the payment, 
the	institution	would	be	undercapitalized.	In	addition,	an	institution	cannot	make	a	capital	distribution,	
such as a dividend or other distribution that is in substance a distribution of capital to the owners of the 
institution	if	following	such	a	distribution	the	institution	would	be	undercapitalized.	Thus,	if	payment	of	
such	a	management	fee	or	the	making	of	such	would	cause	a	bank	to	become	undercapitalized,	it	could	not	
pay a management fee or dividend to the bank holding company.

As	of	December	31,	2015,	the	Bank	was	deemed	to	be	“well	capitalized.”

Standards for Safety and Soundness. The Federal Deposit Insurance Act also requires the federal 
banking regulatory agencies to prescribe, by regulation or guideline, operational and managerial standards 
for all insured depository institutions relating to: (i) internal controls, information systems and internal au-
dit systems; (ii) loan documentation; (iii) credit underwriting; (iv) interest rate risk exposure; and (v) asset 
growth. The agencies also must prescribe standards for asset quality, earnings, and stock valuation, as well 
as standards for compensation, fees and benefits. The federal banking agencies have adopted regulations 
and Interagency Guidelines Prescribing Standards for Safety and Soundness to implement these required 
standards. These guidelines set forth the safety and soundness standards that the federal banking agencies 
use to identify and address problems at insured depository institutions before capital becomes impaired. 
Under the regulations, if the FDIC determines that the Bank fails to meet any standards prescribed by 
the guidelines, the agency may require the Bank to submit to the agency an acceptable plan to achieve 
compliance with the standard, as required by the FDIC. The final regulations establish deadlines for the 
submission and review of such safety and soundness compliance plans.

Regulatory Examination. The FDIC also requires the Bank to prepare annual reports on the Bank’s 
financial condition and to conduct an annual audit of its financial affairs in compliance with its minimum 
standards and procedures.

All insured institutions must undergo regular on-site examinations by their appropriate banking 
agency. The cost of examinations of insured depository institutions and any affiliates may be assessed by 
the appropriate federal banking agency against each institution or affiliate as it deems necessary or ap-
propriate. Insured institutions are required to submit annual reports to the FDIC, their federal regulatory 
agency, and state supervisor when applicable. The FDIC has developed a method for insured depository 
institutions to provide supplemental disclosure of the estimated fair market value of assets and liabilities, 
to the extent feasible and practicable, in any balance sheet, financial statement, report of condition or any 

22

other report of any insured depository institution. The federal banking regulatory agencies prescribe, by 
regulation, standards for all insured depository institutions and depository institution holding companies 
relating, among other things, to the following:

•	

internal	controls;

•	

information	systems	and	audit	systems;

•	

loan	documentation;

•	

credit	underwriting;

•	

interest	rate	risk	exposure;	and

•	

asset	quality.

Transactions with Affiliates and Insiders. The Company is a legal entity separate and distinct from 
the Bank and its other subsidiaries. Various legal limitations restrict the Bank from lending or otherwise 
supplying funds to the Company or its non-bank subsidiaries. The Company and the Bank are subject to 
Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act and Federal Reserve Regulation W.

Section 23A of the Federal Reserve Act places limits on the amount of loans or extensions of cred-
it to, or investments in, or certain other transactions with, affiliates and on the amount of advances to third 
parties	collateralized	by	the	securities	or	obligations	of	affiliates.	Section	23A	also	applies	to	derivative	
transactions, repurchase agreements and securities lending and borrowing transactions that cause a bank 
to have credit exposure to an affiliate. The aggregate of all covered transactions is limited in amount, as 
to any one affiliate, to 10% of the Bank’s capital and surplus and, as to all affiliates combined, to 20% of 
the Bank’s capital and surplus. Furthermore, within the foregoing limitations as to amount, each covered 
transaction must meet specified collateral requirements. The Bank is forbidden to purchase low quality 
assets from an affiliate.

Section 23B of the Federal Reserve Act, among other things, prohibits  an institution  from  en-
gaging in certain transactions with certain affiliates unless the transactions are on terms substantially the 
same, or at least as favorable to such institution or its subsidiaries, as those prevailing at the time for com-
parable transactions with nonaffiliated companies.

Regulation W generally excludes all non-bank and non-savings association subsidiaries of banks 
from treatment as affiliates, except to the extent that the Federal Reserve decides to treat these subsidiar-
ies as affiliates.

The Bank is also subject to certain restrictions on extensions of credit to executive officers, direc-
tors, certain principal stockholders, and their related interests. Such extensions of credit (i) must be made 
on substantially the same terms, including interest rates and collateral requirements, as those prevailing at 
the time for comparable transactions with unrelated third parties and (ii) must not involve more than the 
normal risk of repayment or present other unfavorable features.

Dividends. The	Company’s	principal	source	of	cash	flow,	including	cash	flow	to	pay	dividends	to	
its stockholders, is dividends it receives from the Bank. Statutory and regulatory limitations apply to the 

23

2015 Form 10-KBank’s payment of dividends to the Company. As a South Carolina chartered bank, the Bank is subject to 
limitations on the amount of dividends that it is permitted to pay. Unless otherwise instructed by the SCBFI,  
the Bank is generally permitted under South Carolina state banking regulations to pay cash dividends of 
up to 100% of net income in any calendar year without obtaining the prior approval of the SCBFI. The 
FDIC also has the authority under federal law to enjoin a bank from engaging in what in its opinion consti-
tutes an unsafe or unsound practice in conducting its business, including the payment of a dividend under 
certain circumstances.

Branching. Federal legislation permits out-of-state acquisitions by bank holding companies, inter-
state branching by banks, and interstate merging by banks. The Dodd-Frank Act removed previous state 
law restrictions on de novo interstate branching in states such as South Carolina. This change effectively 
permits out-of-state banks to open de novo branches in states where the laws of such state where would 
permit a bank chartered by that state to open a de novo branch.

Anti-Tying Restrictions. Under amendments to the BHCA and Federal Reserve regulations, a bank 
is prohibited from engaging in certain tying or reciprocity arrangements with its customers. In general, a 
bank may not extend credit, lease, sell property, or furnish any services or fix or vary the consideration for 
these on the condition that (i) the customer obtain or provide some additional credit, property, or services 
from or to the bank, the bank holding company or subsidiaries thereof or (ii) the customer may not obtain 
some other credit, property, or services from a competitor, except to the extent reasonable conditions are 
imposed to assure the soundness of the credit extended. Certain arrangements are permissible: a bank 
may offer combined-balance products and may otherwise offer more favorable terms if a customer obtains 
two or more traditional bank products; and certain foreign transactions are exempt from the general rule. 
A bank holding company or any bank affiliate also is subject to anti-tying requirements in connection with 
electronic benefit transfer services.

Community Reinvestment Act. The Community Reinvestment Act, or CRA, requires that the FDIC 
evaluate the record of the Bank in meeting the credit needs of its local community, including low and mod-
erate income neighborhoods. These factors are also considered in evaluating mergers, acquisitions, and 
applications to open a branch or facility. Failure to adequately meet these criteria could impose additional 
requirements and limitations on our Bank.

The Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act, or GLBA, made various changes to the CRA. Among other chang-
es, CRA agreements with private parties must be disclosed and annual CRA reports must be made avail-
able to a bank’s primary federal regulator. A bank holding company will not be permitted to become a 
financial	holding	company	and	no	new	activities	authorized	under	the	GLBA	may	be	commenced	by	a	
holding company or by a bank financial subsidiary if any of its bank subsidiaries received less than a satis-
factory CRA rating in its latest CRA examination.

On May 15, 2015, the as of date of the most recent examination, the Bank received a “satisfactory” 

CRA rating.

Financial Subsidiaries. Under the GLBA, subject to certain conditions imposed by their respective 
banking regulators, national and state-chartered banks are permitted to form “financial subsidiaries” that 
may conduct financial or incidental activities, thereby permitting bank subsidiaries to engage in certain 
activities that previously were impermissible. The GLBA imposes several safeguards and restrictions on 
financial subsidiaries, including that the parent bank’s equity investment in the financial subsidiary be de-
ducted from the bank’s assets and tangible equity for purposes of calculating the bank’s capital adequacy. 

24

In addition, the GLBA imposes new restrictions on transactions between a bank and its financial subsid-
iaries similar to restrictions applicable to transactions between banks and non-bank affiliates.

Consumer Protection Regulations. Activities of the Bank are subject to a variety of statutes and reg-
ulations designed to protect consumers. Interest and other charges collected or contracted for by the Bank 
are subject to state usury laws and federal laws concerning interest rates. The Bank’s loan operations are 
also subject to federal laws applicable to credit transactions, such as:

•	

	the	federal	Truth-In-Lending	Act,	governing	disclosures	of	credit	terms	to	consumer	borrowers;

•	

•	

•	

•	

•	

	the	Home	Mortgage	Disclosure	Act	of	1975,	requiring	financial	institutions	to	provide	infor-
mation to enable the public and public officials to determine whether a financial institution is 
fulfilling its obligation to help meet the housing needs of the community it serves;

	the	Equal	Credit	Opportunity	Act,	prohibiting	discrimination	on	the	basis	of	race,	creed	or	
other prohibited factors in extending credit;

	the	 Fair	 Credit	 Reporting	 Act	 of	 1978,	 governing	 the	 use	 and	 provision	 of	 information	 to	
credit reporting agencies;

	the	Fair	Debt	Collection	Act,	governing	the	manner	in	which	consumer	debts	may	be	collect-
ed by collection agencies; and

	the	rules	and	regulations	of	the	various	federal	agencies	charged	with	the	responsibility	of	
implementing such federal laws.

The deposit operations of the Bank also are subject to:

•	

•	

•	

	the	Right	to	Financial	Privacy	Act,	which	imposes	a	duty	to	maintain	confidentiality	of	con-
sumer financial records and prescribes procedures for complying with administrative subpoe-
nas of financial records; and

	the	Electronic	Funds	Transfer	Act	and	Regulation	E,	which	governs	automatic	deposits	to	
and withdrawals from deposit accounts and customers’ rights and liabilities arising from the 
use of automated teller machines and other electronic banking services.

	the	 Truth	 in	 Savings	 Act	 and	 Regulation	 DD,	 which	 requires	 depositary	 institutions	 to	 
provide certain consumer disclosures.

Anti-Money  Laundering.  Financial  institutions  must  maintain  anti-money  laundering  programs 
that include established internal policies, procedures, and controls; a designated compliance officer; an 
ongoing employee training program; and testing of the program by an independent audit function. The 
Company  and  the  Bank  are  also  prohibited  from  entering  into  specified  financial  transactions  and  ac-
count relationships and must meet enhanced standards for due diligence and “knowing your customer” 
in their dealings with foreign financial institutions and foreign customers. Financial institutions must take 
reasonable steps to conduct enhanced scrutiny of account relationships to guard against money launder-
ing and to report any suspicious transactions, and recent laws provide law enforcement authorities with 
increased access to financial information maintained by banks. Anti-money laundering obligations have 

25

2015 Form 10-Kbeen  substantially strengthened as a result of the USA Patriot Act, enacted in 2001 and renewed in 2006. 
Bank regulators routinely examine institutions for compliance with these obligations and are required to 
consider compliance in connection with the regulatory review of applications. The regulatory authorities 
have  been  active  in  imposing  cease  and  desist  orders  and  money  penalty  sanctions  against  institutions 
found to be violating these obligations.

USA PATRIOT Act/Bank Secrecy Act. Financial institutions must maintain anti-money  laundering 
programs that include established internal policies, procedures, and controls; a designated compliance 
officer;  an  ongoing  employee  training  program;  and  testing  of  the  program  by  an  independent  audit 
function. The USA PATRIOT Act, amended, in part, the Bank Secrecy Act and provides for the facil-
itation of information sharing among governmental entities and financial institutions for the purpose 
of combating terrorism and money laundering by enhancing anti-money laundering and financial trans-
parency laws, as well as enhanced information collection tools and enforcement mechanics for the U.S. 
government, including: (i) requiring standards for verifying customer identification at account opening; 
(ii) rules to promote cooperation among financial institutions, regulators, and law enforcement entities 
in identifying parties that may be involved in terrorism or money laundering; (iii) reports by nonfinan-
cial  trades  and  businesses  filed  with  the  U.S.  Treasury  Department’s  Financial  Crimes  Enforcement 
Network for transactions exceeding $10,000; and (iv) filing suspicious activities reports if a bank believes 
a customer may be violating U.S. laws and regulations and requires enhanced due diligence require-
ments for financial institutions that administer, maintain, or manage private bank accounts or corre-
spondent accounts for non-U.S. persons. Bank regulators routinely examine institutions for compliance 
with these obligations and are required to consider compliance in connection with the regulatory review 
of applications.

Under the USA PATRIOT Act, the Federal Bureau of Investigation can send to the banking regu-
latory agencies lists of the names of persons suspected of involvement in terrorist activities. The Bank can 
be requested to search its records for any relationships or transactions with persons on those lists. If the 
Bank finds any relationships or transactions, it must file a suspicious activity report and contact the FBI.

The Office of Foreign Assets Control, or OFAC, which is a division of the Treasury, is responsible 
for helping to ensure that United States entities do not engage in transactions with “enemies” of the Unit-
ed States, as defined by various Executive Orders and Acts of Congress. OFAC has sent, and will send, our 
banking	regulatory	agencies	lists	of	names	of	persons	and	organizations	suspected	of	aiding,	harboring	or	
engaging in terrorist acts. If the Bank finds a name on any transaction, account or wire transfer that is on 
an	OFAC	list,	it	must	freeze	such	account,	file	a	suspicious	activity	report	and	notify	the	FBI.	The	Bank	
has appointed an OFAC compliance officer to oversee the inspection of its accounts and the filing of any 
notifications. The Bank actively checks high-risk OFAC areas such as new accounts, wire transfers and cus-
tomer	files.	The	Bank	performs	these	checks	utilizing	software,	which	is	updated	each	time	a	modification	
is made to the lists provided by OFAC and other agencies of Specially Designated Nationals and Blocked 
Persons.

Privacy,  Data  Security  and  Credit  Reporting.  Financial  institutions  are  required  to  disclose  their 
policies for collecting and protecting confidential information. Customers generally may prevent  financial 
institutions  from  sharing  nonpublic  personal  financial  information  with  nonaffiliated  third  parties 
 except under narrow circumstances, such as the processing of transactions requested by the consumer.  
Additionally, financial institutions generally may not disclose consumer account numbers to any nonaffili-
ated third party for use in telemarketing, direct mail marketing or other marketing to consumers. It is the 
Bank’s policy not to disclose any personal information unless required by law.

26

Recent	cyber	attacks	against	banks	and	other	institutions	that	resulted	in	unauthorized	access	to	
confidential customer information have prompted the Federal banking agencies to issue several warnings 
and extensive guidance on cyber security. The agencies are likely to devote more resources to this part of 
their safety and soundness examination than they have in the past.

In addition, pursuant to the Fair and Accurate Credit Transactions Act of 2003 (the “FACT Act”) 
and  the  implementing  regulations  of  the  federal  banking  agencies  and  Federal  Trade  Commission,  the 
Bank	is	required	to	have	in	place	an	“identity	theft	red	flags”	program	to	detect,	prevent	and	mitigate	
identity	theft.	The	Bank	has	implemented	an	identity	theft	red	flags	program	designed	to	meet	the	re-
quirements of the FACT Act and the joint final rules. Additionally, the FACT Act amends the Fair Credit 
Reporting Act to generally prohibit a person from using information received from an affiliate to make a 
solicitation for marketing purposes to a consumer, unless the consumer is given notice and a reasonable 
opportunity and a reasonable and simple method to opt out of the making of such solicitations.

Check 21. The Check Clearing for the 21st Century Act gives “substitute checks,” such as a digital 
image of a check and copies made from that image, the same legal standing as the original paper check. 
Some of the major provisions include:

•	

allowing	check	truncation	without	making	it	mandatory;

•	

•	

•	

•	

•	

	demanding	 that	 every	 financial	 institution	 communicate	 to	 accountholders	 in	 writing	 a	 
description of its substitute check processing program and their rights under the law;

	legalizing	 substitutions	 for	 and	 replacements	 of	 paper	 checks	 without	 agreement	 from	 
consumers;

	retaining	in	place	the	previously	mandated	electronic	collection	and	return	of	checks	between	
financial institutions only when individual agreements are in place;

	requiring	 that	 when	 accountholders	 request	 verification,	 financial	 institutions	 produce	 the	
original check (or a copy that accurately represents the original) and demonstrate that the 
account debit was accurate and valid; and

	requiring	the	re-crediting	of	funds	to	an	individual’s	account	on	the	next	business	day	after	a	
consumer proves that the financial institution has erred.

Effect of Governmental Monetary Policies. Our earnings are affected by domestic economic condi-
tions and the monetary and fiscal policies of the United States government and its agencies. The Federal 
Reserve’s  monetary  policies  have  had,  and  are  likely  to  continue  to  have,  an  important  impact  on  the 
operating results of commercial banks through its power to implement national monetary policy in order, 
among	other	things,	to	curb	inflation	or	combat	a	recession.	The	monetary	policies	of	the	Federal	Reserve	
have major effects upon the levels of bank loans, investments and deposits through its open market opera-
tions in United States government securities and through its regulation of the discount rate on borrowings 
of member banks and the reserve requirements against member bank deposits. It is not possible to predict 
the nature or impact of future changes in monetary and fiscal policies. On December 16, 2015, the federal 
open market committee raised the federal funds target rate by 25 basis point, which was the first increase 
in several years. Further increases may occur in 2016, but there is no announced timetable.

27

2015 Form 10-KInsurance of Accounts and Regulation by the FDIC. The Bank’s deposits are insured up to applicable 
limits by the Deposit Insurance Fund of the FDIC. As insurer, the FDIC imposes deposit insurance premi-
ums	and	is	authorized	to	conduct	examinations	of	and	to	require	reporting	by	FDIC	insured	institutions.	
It also may prohibit any FDIC insured institution from engaging in any activity the FDIC determines by 
regulation or order to pose a serious risk to the insurance fund. The FDIC also has the authority to initiate 
enforcement actions against savings institutions, after giving the bank’s regulatory authority an opportu-
nity to take such action, and may terminate the deposit insurance if it determines that the institution has 
engaged in unsafe or unsound practices or is in an unsafe or unsound condition.

FDIC insured institutions are required to pay a Financing Corporation assessment to fund the 
interest on bonds issued to resolve thrift failures in the 1980s. The Financing Corporation quarterly as-
sessment for the fourth quarter of 2013 equaled 1.085 basis points for each $100 of average consolidated 
total assets minus average tangible equity. These assessments, which may be revised based upon the level 
of deposits, will continue until the bonds mature in the years 2017 through 2019.

The FDIC may terminate the deposit insurance of any insured depository institution, including 
the Bank, if it determines after a hearing that the institution has engaged in unsafe or unsound practices, 
is in an unsafe or unsound condition to continue operations or has violated any applicable law, regulation, 
rule, order or condition imposed by the FDIC. It also may suspend deposit insurance temporarily during 
the hearing process for the permanent termination of insurance if the institution has no tangible capital. If 
insurance of accounts is terminated, the accounts at the institution at the time of the termination, less sub-
sequent withdrawals, shall continue to be insured for a period of six months to two years, as determined by 
the FDIC. Management is not aware of any practice, condition or violation that might lead to termination 
of the Bank’s deposit insurance.

Incentive  Compensation.  In  June  2010,  the  Federal  Reserve,  the  FDIC  and  the  OCC  issued  a 
comprehensive final guidance on incentive compensation policies intended to ensure that the incentive 
compensation	policies	of	banking	organizations	do	not	undermine	the	safety	and	soundness	of	such	or-
ganizations	by	encouraging	excessive	risk-taking.	The	guidance,	which	covers	all	employees	that	have	the	
ability	to	materially	affect	the	risk	profile	of	an	organization,	either	individually	or	as	part	of	a	group,	is	
based	upon	the	key	principles	that	a	banking	organization’s	incentive	compensation	arrangements	should	
(i)	 provide	 incentives	 that	 do	 not	 encourage	 risk-taking	 beyond	 the	 organization’s	 ability	 to	 effectively	
identify and manage risks, (ii) be compatible with effective internal controls and risk management, and 
(iii) be supported by strong corporate governance, including active and effective oversight by the organi-
zation’s	board	of	directors.

The  Federal  Reserve  will  review,  as  part  of  the  regular,  risk-focused  examination  process,  the 
incentive	compensation	arrangements	of	banking	organizations,	such	as	the	Company,	that	are	not	“large,	
complex	banking	organizations.”	These	reviews	will	be	tailored	to	each	organization	based	on	the	scope	
and	 complexity	 of	 the	 organization’s	 activities	 and	 the	 prevalence	 of	 incentive	 compensation	 arrange-
ments. The findings of the supervisory initiatives will be included in reports of examination. Deficiencies 
will	be	incorporated	into	the	organization’s	supervisory	ratings,	which	can	affect	the	organization’s	ability	
to make acquisitions and take other actions. Enforcement actions may be taken against a banking orga-
nization	if	its	incentive	compensation	arrangements,	or	related	risk-management	control	or	governance	
processes,	pose	a	risk	to	the	organization’s	safety	and	soundness	and	the	organization	is	not	taking	prompt	
and effective measures to correct the deficiencies.

28

The Dodd-Frank Act required the federal banking agencies, the SEC, and certain other federal 
agencies to jointly issue a regulation on incentive compensation. The agencies proposed such a rule in 
2011,	which	reflects	the	2010	guidance,	but	the	agencies	have	not	finalized	the	rule	as	of	December	31,	
2015.

ITEM 1A.  RISK FACTORS

Our business is subject to certain risks, including those described below.  If any of the events de-
scribed in the following risk factors actually occurs then our business, results of operations and financial 
condition  could  be  materially  adversely  affected.    More  detailed  information  concerning  these  risks  is 
contained in other sections of this report, including “Part I, Item 1: Business” and “Part II, Item 7: Man-
agement’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”

Risks Related to Our Business

Negative developments in the financial industry, the domestic and international credit markets, and the economy 
in general pose significant challenges for our industry and us and could adversely affect our business, financial 
condition and results of operations.

Negative developments that began in the latter half of 2007 and that have continued since then in 
the	global	credit	and	securitization	markets	have	resulted	in	unprecedented	volatility	and	disruption	in	the	
financial markets and a general economic downturn, both nationally and in our markets. The economy’s 
recovery from these negative developments has been slow and inconsistent in many markets, including 
some in the Carolinas. As a result of this “credit crunch,” commercial as well as consumer loan portfolio 
performances deteriorated at many institutions, and the competition for deposits and quality loans has 
increased significantly. In addition, the values of real estate collateral supporting many commercial loans 
and home mortgages have declined and may continue to decline. As a result, we may face the following 
risks:

•	

•	

•	

	economic	conditions	that	negatively	affect	housing	prices	and	the	job	market	may	cause	the	
credit quality of our loan portfolios to deteriorate;

	market	 developments	 that	 affect	 consumer	 confidence	 may	 cause	 adverse	 changes	 in	 
payment patterns by our customers, causing increases in delinquencies and default rates on 
loans and other credit facilities;

	the	processes	that	we	use	to	estimate	our	allowance	for	loan	and	lease	losses	and	reserves	
may  no  longer  be  reliable  because  they  rely  on  judgments,  such  as  forecasts  of  economic  
conditions, that may no longer be capable of accurate estimation;

•	

the	value	of	our	securities	portfolio	may	decline;	and

•	

	we	face	increased	regulation	of	our	industry,	and	the	costs	of	compliance	with	such	regulation	
may continue to increase.

These  conditions  or  similar  ones  may  continue  to  persist  or  worsen,  causing  us  to  experience 
continuing or increased adverse effects on our business, financial condition, results of operations and the 
price of our common stock.

29

2015 Form 10-KOur mortgage banking profitability could be significantly reduced if we are not able to originate and resell a high 
volume of mortgage loans.

Mortgage  production,  especially  refinancing  activity,  typically  declines  in  a  rising  interest  rate 
environment.  During  2009-2015,  there  was  a  period  of  historically  low  interest  rates;  however,  the  low 
interest rate environment likely will not continue indefinitely. Because we sell a substantial portion of the 
mortgage loans we originate, the profitability of our mortgage banking business depends in large part upon 
our ability to aggregate a high volume of loans and sell them in the secondary market at a gain. Thus, in 
addition to our dependence on the interest rate environment, we are dependent upon (i) the existence of 
an active secondary market and (ii) our ability to profitably sell loans or securities into that market. As our 
level of mortgage production declines, the profitability from our mortgage operations will depend upon 
our ability to reduce our costs commensurate with the reduction of revenue from our mortgage operations.

Our ability to originate and sell mortgage loans readily is dependent upon the availability of an 
active secondary market for single-family mortgage loans, which in turn depends in part upon the continu-
ation of programs currently offered by the government sponsored entities, or GSEs, and other institutional 
and non-institutional investors. These entities account for a substantial portion of the secondary market in 
residential mortgage loans. Because the largest participants in the secondary market are government-spon-
sored enterprises whose activities are governed by federal law, any future changes in laws that significantly 
affect the activity of the GSEs could, in turn, adversely affect our operations. In September 2008, the GSEs 
were placed into conservatorship by the U.S. government. Although to date the conservatorship has not 
had a significant or adverse effect on our operations, it remains unclear whether these events or further 
changes would significantly and adversely affect our operations. The government and others have provided 
options to reform the GSEs, but the results of any such reform, and their impact on us, are difficult to pre-
dict. To date, no reform proposal has been enacted. In addition, our ability to sell mortgage loans readily is 
dependent upon our ability to remain eligible for the programs offered by the GSEs and other institutional 
and	non-institutional	investors.	Our	ability	to	remain	eligible	to	originate	and	securitize	government	in-
sured loans may also depend on having an acceptable peer-relative delinquency ratio for FHA loans and 
maintaining a delinquency rate with respect to Ginnie Mae pools that are below Ginnie Mae guidelines.

Any  significant  impairment  of  our  eligibility  with  any  of  the  GSEs  would  materially  adversely 
affect our operations. Further, the criteria for loans to be accepted under such programs may be changed 
from time-to-time by the sponsoring entity which could result in a lower volume of corresponding loan 
originations. The profitability of participating in specific programs may vary depending on a number of 
factors, including our administrative costs of originating and purchasing qualifying loans and our costs of 
meeting such criteria.

An increase in our nonperforming assets would adversely impact our earnings.

Our nonperforming assets may increase in future periods. Nonperforming assets adversely affect 
our net income in various ways. We do not record interest income on non-accrual loans or investments or 
on real estate owned. We must establish an allowance for loan losses that reserves for losses inherent in 
the loan portfolio that are both probable and reasonably estimable through current period provisions for 
loan losses, which are recorded as a charge to income. From time to time, we also write down the other 
real	estate	owned	portfolio	to	reflect	changing	market	values.	Additionally,	there	are	legal	fees	associated	
with the resolution of problem assets as well as carrying costs such as taxes, insurance and maintenance 
related to the other real estate owned. Further, the resolution of nonperforming assets requires the active 
involvement of management, which can distract them from our overall supervision of operations and other 
income-producing activities.

30

We could record other-than-temporary impairment on our securities portfolio. In addition, we may not receive full 
future interest payments on these securities.

We review our investment securities portfolio at least quarterly and more frequently when eco-
nomic conditions warrant, assessing whether there is any indication of other-than-temporary impairment, 
OTTI.	Factors	considered	in	the	review	include	estimated	future	cash	flows,	length	of	time	and	extent	to	
which market value has been less than cost, the financial condition and near term prospect of the issuer, 
and our intent and ability to retain the security to allow for an anticipated recovery in market value. If 
the	review	determines	that	there	is	OTTI,	then	an	impairment	loss	is	recognized	in	earnings	equal	to	the	
difference between the investment’s cost and its fair value at the balance sheet date of the reporting period 
for	which	the	assessment	is	made,	or	a	portion	may	be	recognized	in	other	comprehensive	income.	The	
fair	value	of	investments	on	which	OTTI	is	recognized	then	becomes	the	new	cost	basis	of	the	investment.

At December 31, 2015, the Company had 45 individual securities available-for-sale in an unreal-
ized	loss	position.	The	Company	believes,	based	on	industry	analyst	reports	and	third-party	OTTI	evalua-
tions, that the deterioration in the value of these securities is attributable to a combination of the lack of 
liquidity in these securities, credit ratings and credit quality concerns. There are three additional trust pre-
ferred securities classified as available-for-sale securities that had OTTI expense recorded in prior years, 
but did not incur OTTI expense during fiscal 2015 or 2014. Management believes that there are no other 
securities other-than-temporarily impaired at December 31, 2015. The Company does not intend to sell 
these securities, and it is more likely than not that the Company will not be required to sell these securities 
before	recovery	of	their	amortized	cost.	Management	continues	to	monitor	these	securities	with	a	high	
degree of scrutiny. There can be no assurance that the Company will not conclude in future periods that 
conditions existing at that time indicate some or all of the securities may be sold or are other-than-tempo-
rarily impaired, which would require a charge to earnings in such periods.

A number of factors or combinations of factors could require us to conclude in one or more future 
reporting	periods	that	an	unrealized	loss	that	exists	with	respect	to	our	securities	portfolio	constitutes	ad-
ditional impairment that is other than temporary, which could result in material losses to us. These factors 
include, but are not limited to, a continued failure by an issuer to make scheduled interest payments, an in-
crease	in	the	severity	of	the	unrealized	loss	on	a	particular	security,	an	increase	in	the	continuous	duration	
of	the	unrealized	loss	without	an	improvement	in	value	or	changes	in	market	conditions	and/or	industry	or	
issuer specific factors that would render us unable to forecast a full recovery in value. In addition, the fair 
values of securities could decline if the overall economy and the financial condition of some of the issuers 
continue to deteriorate and there remains limited liquidity for these securities.

We may not be able to continue to support the realization of our deferred tax asset.

We calculate income taxes in accordance with Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) 
Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) Topic 740, Income Taxes, which requires the use of the asset 
and liability method. In accordance with this, we regularly assess available positive and negative evidence 
to determine whether it is more likely than not that our deferred tax asset balances will be recovered from 
reversals	of	deferred	tax	liabilities,	potential	utilization	of	net	operating	loss	carrybacks,	tax	planning	strat-
egies and future taxable income. At December 31, 2015, our net deferred tax asset was $5.3 million. We 
recognized	the	deferred	tax	asset	because	management	believes,	based	on	earnings	and	detailed	financial	
projections,	that	it	is	more	likely	than	not	that	we	will	have	sufficient	future	earnings	to	utilize	this	asset	
to	offset	future	income	tax	liabilities.	Realization	of	a	deferred	tax	asset	requires	us	to	apply	significant	
judgment  and  is  inherently  speculative  because  it  requires  the  future  occurrence  of  circumstances  that 

31

2015 Form 10-Kcannot be predicted with certainty. There can be no assurance that we will achieve sufficient future taxable 
income	as	the	basis	for	the	ultimate	realization	of	our	deferred	tax	asset	and	therefore	we	may	have	to	
establish a full or partial valuation allowance at some point in the future. If we determine that a valuation 
allowance is necessary, this would require us to incur a charge to operations that would adversely affect 
our capital position.

At December 31, 2015, we had $5.3 million of allowable net deferred tax assets for regulatory cap-
ital purposes, which is the amount that is expected to be recovered based on a two-year net operating loss 
carryback and the next four quarters calculation. There is no assurance that we will be able to continue to 
recognize	any,	or	all,	of	the	deferred	tax	asset	for	regulatory	capital	purposes.

We may be terminated as a servicer of mortgage loans, be required to repurchase a mortgage loan or reimburse 
investors for credit losses on a mortgage loan, or incur costs, liabilities, fines and other sanctions if we fail to 
satisfy our servicing obligations, including our obligations with respect to mortgage loan foreclosure actions.

We act as servicer for approximately $2.0 billion of mortgage loans owned by third parties as of 
December 31, 2015. As a servicer for those loans we have certain contractual obligations, including fore-
closing on defaulted mortgage loans or, to the extent applicable, considering alternatives to foreclosure 
such as loan modifications or short sales. If we commit a material breach of our obligations as servicer, 
we may be subject to termination as servicer if the breach is not cured within a specified period of time 
following notice, causing us to lose servicing income.

In some cases, we may be contractually obligated to repurchase a mortgage loan or reimburse the 
investor for credit losses incurred on the loan as a remedy for servicing errors with respect to the loan. If 
we have increased repurchase obligations because of claims that we did not satisfy our obligations as a ser-
vicer, or increased loss severity on such repurchases, we may have a significant reduction to net servicing 
income within our mortgage banking noninterest income. We may incur costs if we are required to, or if 
we elect to, re-execute or re-file documents or take other action in our capacity as a servicer in connection 
with pending or completed foreclosures. We may incur litigation costs if the validity of a foreclosure action 
is challenged by a borrower. If a court were to overturn a foreclosure because of errors or deficiencies in 
the foreclosure process, we may have liability to the borrower and/or to any title insurer of the property 
sold in foreclosure if the required process was not followed. These costs and liabilities may not be legally 
or otherwise reimbursable to us. In addition, if certain documents required for a foreclosure action are 
missing or defective, we could be obligated to cure the defect or repurchase the loan. We may incur liabil-
ity	to	securitization	investors	relating	to	delays	or	deficiencies	in	our	processing	of	mortgage	assignments	
or other documents necessary to comply with state law governing foreclosures. The fair value of our mort-
gage servicing rights may be negatively affected to the extent our servicing costs increase because of higher 
foreclosure costs. We may be subject to fines and other sanctions imposed by federal or state regulators 
as a result of actual or perceived deficiencies in our foreclosure practices or in the foreclosure practices 
of other mortgage loan servicers. Any of these actions may harm our reputation or negatively affect our 
home lending or servicing business.

We may be required to repurchase mortgage loans or indemnify buyers against losses in some circumstances, 
which could harm liquidity, results of operations and financial condition.

When	mortgage	loans	are	sold,	whether	as	whole	loans	or	pursuant	to	a	securitization,	we	are	re-
quired to make customary representations and warranties to purchasers, guarantors and insurers, including 
the government sponsored enterprises, about the mortgage loans and the manner in which they were orig-

32

inated. Whole loan sale agreements require repurchase or substitute mortgage loans, or indemnification 
of buyers against losses, in the event we breach these representations or warranties. In addition, we may 
be required to repurchase mortgage loans as a result of early payment default of the borrower on a mort-
gage loan. With respect to loans that are originated through our broker or correspondent channels, the  
remedies  available  against  the  originating  broker  or  correspondent,  if  any,  may  not  be  as  broad  as  the 
remedies available to purchasers, guarantors and insurers of mortgage loans against us. We face further 
risk that the originating broker or correspondent, if any, may not have financial capacity to perform reme-
dies that otherwise may be available. Therefore, if a purchaser, guarantor or insurer enforces its remedies 
against us, we may not be able to recover losses from the originating broker or correspondent. If repurchase 
and indemnity demands increase and such demands are valid claims and are in excess of our provision for 
potential losses, our liquidity, results of operations and financial condition may be adversely affected.

Our decisions regarding credit risk and reserves for loan losses may materially and adversely affect our business.

Making  loans  and  other  extensions  of  credit  is  an  essential  element  of  our  business.  Although 
we seek to mitigate risks inherent in lending by adhering to specific underwriting practices, our loans and 
other extensions of credit may not be repaid. The risk of nonpayment is affected by a number of factors, 
including:

•	

the	duration	of	the	credit;

•	

credit	risks	of	a	particular	customer;

•	

changes	in	economic	and	industry	conditions;	and

•	

	in	the	case	of	a	collateralized	loan,	risks	resulting	from	uncertainties	about	the	future	value	
of the collateral.

We attempt to maintain an appropriate allowance for loan losses to provide for potential losses 
in our loan portfolio. We periodically determine the amount of the allowance based on consideration of 
several factors, including:

•	

an	ongoing	review	of	the	quality,	mix,	and	size	of	our	overall	loan	portfolio;

•	

our	historical	loan	loss	experience;

•	

evaluation	of	economic	conditions;

•	

regular	reviews	of	loan	delinquencies	and	loan	portfolio	quality;	and

•	

the	amount	and	quality	of	collateral,	including	guarantees,	securing	the	loans.

There is no precise method of predicting credit losses; therefore, we face the risk that charge-offs 
in future periods will exceed our allowance for loan losses and that additional increases in the allowance 
for loan losses will be required. Additions to the allowance for loan losses would result in a decrease of our 
net income, and possibly our capital.

33

2015 Form 10-KFederal and state regulators periodically review our allowance for loan losses and may require us 
to	increase	our	provision	for	loan	losses	or	recognize	further	loan	charge-offs,	based	on	judgments	differ-
ent than those of our management. Any increase in the amount of our provision or loans charged-off as 
required by these regulatory agencies could have a negative effect on our operating results.

We may have higher loan losses than we have allowed for in our allowance for loan losses.

Like all financial institutions, we maintain an allowance for loan losses to provide for probable 
losses caused by customer loan defaults. The allowance for loan losses may not be adequate to cover actual 
loan losses, and in this case additional and larger provisions for loan losses would be required to replenish 
the allowance. Provisions for loan losses are a direct charge against income.

We establish the amount of the allowance for loan losses based on historical loss rates, as well as 
estimates and assumptions about future events. Because of the extensive use of estimates and assump-
tions,  our  actual  loan  losses  could  differ,  possibly  significantly,  from  our  estimate.  We  believe  that  our 
allowance for loan losses is adequate to provide for probable losses, but it is possible that the allowance 
for loan losses will need to be increased for credit reasons or that regulators will require us to increase this 
allowance. Either of these occurrences could materially and adversely affect our earnings and profitability.

A significant portion of our loan portfolio is secured by real estate, and events that negatively impact the real estate 
market could hurt our business.

A significant portion of our loan portfolio is secured by real estate. The real estate collateral in 
each case provides an alternate source of repayment in the event of default by the borrower and may de-
teriorate in value during the time the credit is extended. A weakening of the real estate market in our pri-
mary market areas could result in an increase in the number of borrowers who default on their loans and a 
reduction in the value of the collateral securing their loans, which in turn could have an adverse effect on 
our profitability and asset quality. If we are required to liquidate the collateral securing a loan to satisfy the 
debt during a period of reduced real estate values, our earnings and capital could be adversely affected. 
Acts	of	nature,	including	hurricanes,	tornados,	earthquakes,	fires	and	floods,	which	could	be	exacerbated	
by potential climate change and may cause uninsured damage and other loss of value to real estate that 
secures these loans, may also negatively impact our financial condition.

We have a concentration of credit exposure in commercial real estate and challenges faced by the commercial real 
estate market could adversely affect our business, financial condition, and results of operations. 

As of December 31, 2015, we had approximately $342.4 million in loans outstanding to borrowers 
whereby the collateral securing the loan was commercial real estate, representing approximately 37.1% 
of our total loans outstanding as of that date. Approximately 36.9%, or $126.5 million, of this real estate 
are owner-occupied properties. Commercial real estate loans are generally viewed as having more risk of 
default than residential real estate loans. They are also typically larger than residential real estate loans 
and	consumer	loans	and	depend	on	cash	flows	from	the	owner’s	business	or	the	property	to	service	the	
debt.	Cash	flows	may	be	affected	significantly	by	general	economic	conditions,	and	a	downturn	in	the		local	
economy  or  in  occupancy  rates  in  the  local  economy  where  the  property  is  located  could  increase  the 
likelihood of default. Because our loan portfolio contains a number of commercial real estate loans with 
relatively large balances, the deterioration of one or a few of these loans could cause a significant increase 
in our level of nonperforming loans. An increase in nonperforming loans could result in a loss of earnings 
from these loans, an increase in the related provision for loan losses and an increase in charge-offs, all of 
which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

34

The banking regulators are giving commercial real estate lending greater scrutiny, and may re-
quire banks with higher levels of commercial real estate loans to implement more stringent underwrit-
ing, internal controls, risk management policies and portfolio stress testing, as well as possibly higher 
levels of allowances for losses and capital levels as a result of commercial real estate lending growth 
and exposures.

Repayment of our commercial business loans is often dependent on the cash flows of the borrower, which may be 
unpredictable, and the collateral securing these loans may fluctuate in value.

At December 31, 2015, commercial business loans comprised 12.7% of our total loan portfolio. 
Our	 commercial	 business	 loans	 are	 originated	 primarily	 based	 on	 the	 identified	 cash	 flow	 and	 general	
liquidity of the borrower and secondarily on the underlying collateral provided by the borrower and/or 
repayment	capacity	of	any	guarantor.	The	borrower’s	cash	flow	may	be	unpredictable,	and	collateral	se-
curing	these	loans	may	fluctuate	in	value.	Although	commercial	business	loans	are	often	collateralized	
by equipment, inventory, accounts receivable, or other business assets, the liquidation of collateral in the 
event of default is often an insufficient source of repayment because accounts receivable may be uncol-
lectible  and  inventories  may  be  obsolete  or  of  limited  use.  In  addition,  business  assets  may  depreciate 
over	time,	may	be	difficult	to	appraise,	and	may	fluctuate	in	value	based	on	the	success	of	the	business.	
Accordingly,	the	repayment	of	commercial	business	loans	depends	primarily	on	the	cash	flow	and	credit	
worthiness of the borrower and secondarily on the underlying collateral value provided by the borrower 
and liquidity of the guarantor.

Further downturns or a slower recovery in the real estate markets in our primary market areas could significantly 
adversely impact our business.

Our business activities and credit exposure are primarily concentrated in Charleston, Dorchester, 
and Horry counties in South Carolina. The Company’s primary markets in Charleston and Dorchester 
counties	are	heavily	influenced	by	the	Port	of	Charleston,	the	military,	the	medical	industry	and	national	
and international industries. The Company’s primary market areas in Horry County and adjacent counties 
in	North	Carolina	are	heavily	influenced	by	tourism,	retirement	living,	and	retail.	The	real	estate	markets	
have experienced a significant decline in these markets in recent years and, if these economic drivers ex-
perience further downturns or recover more slowly than expected, real estate in the Company’s markets 
may experience further declines. If real estate values in our markets decline, the collateral for these loans 
will provide less security. As a result, the borrower’s ability to pay, or the Company’s ability to recover on 
defaulted loans by selling the underlying collateral, would be diminished.

Our focus on lending to small to mid-sized community-based businesses may increase our credit risk.

Most of our commercial business and commercial real estate loans are made to small business 
or  middle  market  customers.  These  businesses  generally  have  fewer  financial  resources  in  terms  of 
capital  or  borrowing  capacity  than  larger  entities  and  have  a  heightened  vulnerability  to  econom-
ic conditions. If general economic conditions in the markets in which we operate  negatively  impact 
this  important   customer  sector,  our  results  of  operations  and  financial  condition  and  the  value  of 
our  common  stock  may  be   adversely  affected.  Moreover,  a  portion  of  these  loans  have  been  made 
by us in recent years and the borrowers may not have experienced a complete business or economic 
cycle. Furthermore, the  deterioration of our borrowers’ businesses may hinder their ability to repay 
their loans with us, which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results  
of operations.

35

2015 Form 10-KWe face strong competition for customers, which could prevent us from obtaining customers and may cause us to 
pay higher interest rates to attract customers.

The banking business is highly competitive, and we experience competition in our markets from 
many  other  financial  institutions.  We  compete  with  commercial  banks,  credit  unions,  savings  and  loan 
associations, mortgage banking firms, consumer finance companies, securities brokerage firms, insurance 
companies, money market funds, and other mutual funds, as well as other super-regional, national, and 
international  financial  institutions  that  operate  offices  in  our  primary  market  areas  and  elsewhere.  We 
compete with these institutions both in attracting deposits and in making loans. In addition, we have to 
attract our customer base from other existing financial institutions and from new residents. Many of our 
competitors are well-established, larger financial institutions. These institutions offer some services, such 
as extensive and established branch networks, that we do not provide. There is a risk that we will not be 
able to compete successfully with other financial institutions in our markets, and that we may have to pay 
higher interest rates to attract deposits, resulting in reduced profitability. In addition, competitors that are 
not depository institutions are generally not subject to the extensive regulations that apply to us.

Our deposit insurance premiums could be substantially higher in the future, which could have a material adverse 
effect on our future earnings.

The FDIC insures deposits at FDIC-insured depository institutions, such as the Bank, up to appli-
cable limits. The amount of a particular institution’s deposit insurance assessment is based on that institu-
tion’s risk classification under an FDIC risk-based assessment system. An institution’s risk classification is 
assigned based on its capital levels and the level of supervisory concern the institution poses to its regula-
tors. Recent market developments and bank failures significantly depleted the FDIC’s Deposit Insurance 
Fund and reduced the ratio of reserves to insured deposits. As a result of recent economic conditions and 
the enactment of the Dodd-Frank Act, banks are now assessed deposit insurance premiums based on the 
bank’s average consolidated total assets, and the FDIC has modified certain risk-based adjustments, which 
increase or decrease a bank’s overall assessment rate. This has resulted in increases to the deposit insur-
ance assessment rates and thus raised deposit premiums for many insured depository institutions. If these 
increases are insufficient for the Deposit Insurance Fund to meet its funding requirements, further special 
assessments or increases in deposit insurance premiums may be required. We are generally unable to con-
trol the amount of premiums that we are required to pay for FDIC insurance. If there are additional bank 
or financial institution failures, we may be required to pay even higher FDIC premiums than the recently 
increased levels. Any future additional assessments, increases or required prepayments in FDIC insurance 
premiums could reduce our profitability, may limit our ability to pursue certain business opportunities or 
otherwise negatively impact our operations.

The accuracy of our financial statements and related disclosures could be affected if the judgments, assumptions 
or estimates used in our critical accounting policies are inaccurate.

The preparation of financial statements and related disclosure in conformity with accounting prin-
ciples generally accepted in the United States requires us to make judgments, assumptions and estimates 
that affect the amounts reported in our consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes. Our 
critical accounting policies, which are included in the section captioned “Management’s Discussion and 
Analysis of Results of Operations and Financial Condition”, describe those significant accounting policies 
and methods used in the preparation of our consolidated financial statements that we consider “critical” 
because they require judgments, assumptions and estimates that materially affect our consolidated finan-
cial statements and related disclosures. As a result, if future events differ significantly from the judgments, 

36

assumptions and estimates in our critical accounting policies, those events or assumptions could have a 
material impact on our consolidated financial statements and related disclosures.

Our funding sources may prove insufficient to replace deposits and support future growth.

We rely on customer deposits, including brokered deposits, advances from the Federal Home Loan 
Bank of Atlanta (the “FHLB”) and the Federal Reserve, and other borrowings to fund operations. Although 
the Company has historically been able to replace maturing deposits and advances, if desired, no assurance 
can be given that we would be able to replace such funds in the future if the financial condition of the FHLB 
or programs sponsored by the Federal Reserve, regulatory restrictions on brokered deposits or regulatory 
restrictions on the pricing of local deposits or other market conditions were to change. In addition, certain 
borrowing sources are on a secured basis. The FHLB has become more restrictive on the types of collateral it 
will accept and the amount of borrowings allowed on acceptable collateral. Due to changes applied by rating 
agencies on bonds, changes in collateral requirements or deteriorating loan quality, outstanding borrowings 
could	be	required	to	be	repaid,	incurring	prepayment	penalties.	Our	financial	flexibility	will	be	severely	con-
strained if we are unable to maintain access to funding at acceptable interest rates. Finally, if we are required 
to rely more heavily on more expensive funding sources to support future operations, our revenues may not 
increase proportionally to cover these costs. In addition, Crescent Mortgage Company funds mortgage loans 
held for sale through a purchase and sale agreement with the Bank. A decline in economic conditions could 
affect Crescent Mortgage Company’s ability to fund loans held for sale.

Our operating results may fluctuate based upon the results of our mortgage subsidiary, Crescent Mortgage Com-
pany.

There are a number of items that could adversely affect the volumes and margin of the Company’s 
mortgage banking operations. These include, but are not limited to, the Federal Reserve’s monetary policy 
including its quantitative easing program, aggressively low rates, reduction in prices paid by the mortgage 
banking aggregators, aggressive competition, the housing market recovery, the status and financial condi-
tion of Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac, potential changes in Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac lending guide-
lines and programs, proposed changes in the FHA lending requirements, extensive regulatory changes and 
liquidity. Should these factors significantly impact production of mortgages, it is likely that the Company’s 
earnings would be adversely affected.

Our mortgage subsidiary’s operations are exposed to significant repurchase risk.

Crescent Mortgage Company is exposed to significant repurchase risk on mortgage loan produc-
tion related to potential reimbursements for loans sold to third parties for borrower fraud, underwriting 
and  documentation  issues,  early  defaults  and  prepayments  of  sold  loans.  If  the  Company  experiences 
significant losses related to repurchase risk, it is possible that the reserve established for such exposure 
is not adequate. The Company continues to receive repurchase requests. The Company evaluates each 
request and provides estimated reserves as necessary. We believe that the reserve related to repurchase 
risk is adequate to absorb probable losses; however, we cannot predict these losses or whether our reserve 
will be adequate. Any of these occurrences could materially and adversely affect our business, financial 
condition and profitability.

The value of our loan servicing portfolio may become impaired in the future.

As  of  December  31,  2015,  Crescent  Mortgage  Company  serviced  approximately  $2.0  billion  of 
loans. At that date, our mortgage loan servicing rights were recorded as an asset with a carrying value 

37

2015 Form 10-Kof approximately $11.4 million. We expect that our loan servicing portfolio will increase in the future. If 
interest rates decline and the actual and expected mortgage loan prepayment rates increase or other fac-
tors that cause a reduction of the valuation of our mortgage servicing asset, the Company could incur an 
impairment of its mortgage loan servicing asset.

Hurricanes and other natural disasters may adversely affect loan portfolios and operations and increase the cost 
of doing business.

The Company operates in markets that are susceptible to hurricanes and other natural disasters. 
Large-scale natural disasters may significantly affect loan portfolios by damaging properties pledged as 
collateral, affecting the economies our borrowers live in, and by impairing the ability of the borrower to 
repay their loans.

Changes in prevailing interest rates may reduce our profitability.

Our results of operations depend in large part upon the level of our net interest income, which is 
the difference between interest income from interest-earning assets, such as loans and investment securi-
ties, and interest expense on interest-bearing liabilities, such as deposits and borrowings. Depending on the 
terms and maturities of our assets and liabilities, we believe it is more likely than not a significant change 
in interest rates could have a material adverse effect on our profitability. Many factors cause changes in 
interest rates, including governmental monetary policies and domestic and international economic and 
political conditions. While we intend to manage the effects of changes in interest rates by adjusting the 
terms, maturities, and pricing of our assets and liabilities, our efforts may not be effective and our financial 
condition and results of operations could suffer.

We are dependent on key individuals, and the loss of one or more of these key individuals could curtail our growth 
and adversely affect our prospects.

Jerold  L.  Rexroad,  the  Company’s  President  and  Chief  Executive  Officer,  has  extensive  and 
long-standing  ties  within  our  primary  markets.  Mr.  Rexroad  has  substantial  experience  in  banking  op-
erations, wholesale mortgage operations, investment securities, and mergers and acquisitions. If we lose 
the services of Mr. Rexroad he would be difficult to replace and our business and development could be 
materially and adversely affected.

David  L.  Morrow,  the  Bank’s  President  and  Chief  Executive  Officer,  also  has  extensive  and 
long-standing ties within our primary markets and substantial commercial lending experience within our 
Charleston and Myrtle Beach markets. If we lose the services of Mr. Morrow, he would be difficult to re-
place and our business and development could be materially and adversely affected.

Fowler C. Williams, Crescent Mortgage Company’s President and Chief Executive Officer, has 
extensive knowledge and long-standing ties with the mortgage Industry. If we lose the services of Mr. Wil-
liams, he would be difficult to replace and our wholesale mortgage company results could be materially 
and adversely affected.

Our success also depends, in part, on our continued ability to attract and retain experienced loan 
originators, as well as other management personnel. Competition for personnel is intense, and we may not 
be successful in attracting or retaining qualified personnel. Our failure to compete for these personnel, or 

38

the loss of the services of several of such key personnel, could adversely affect our business strategy and 
seriously harm our business, results of operations, and financial condition.

The Dodd-Frank Act may have a material adverse effect on our operations.

The Dodd-Frank Act imposes significant regulatory and compliance changes on banks and bank 

holding companies. The key effects of the Dodd-Frank Act on our business are:

•	

changes	to	regulatory	capital	requirements;

•	

•	

	exclusion	of	hybrid	securities,	including	trust	preferred	securities,	issued	on	or	after	May	19,	
2010 from Tier 1 capital;

	creation	of	new	government	regulatory	agencies	(such	as	the	Financial	Stability	Oversight	
Council, which oversees systemic risk, and the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau, which 
develops and enforces rules for bank and non-bank providers of consumer financial prod-
ucts);

•	

potential	limitations	on	federal	preemption;

•	

changes	to	deposit	insurance	assessments;

•	

regulation	of	debit	interchange	fees	we	earn;

•	

	changes	in	retail	banking	regulations,	including	potential	limitations	on	certain	fees	we	may	
charge; and

•	

changes	in	regulation	of	consumer	mortgage	loan	origination	and	risk	retention.

In  addition,  the  Dodd-Frank  Act  restricts  the  ability  of  banks  to  engage  in  certain  proprietary 
trading or to sponsor or invest in private equity or hedge funds. The Dodd-Frank Act also contains pro-
visions designed to limit the ability of insured depository institutions, their holding companies and their 
affiliates to conduct certain swaps and derivatives activities and to take certain principal positions in finan-
cial instruments.

Some provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act became effective immediately upon its enactment. Many 
provisions, however, will require regulations to be promulgated by various federal agencies in order to be 
implemented,	some	but	not	all	of	which	have	been	proposed	or	finalized	by	the	applicable	federal	agen-
cies. The provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act may have unintended effects, which will not be clear until after 
implementation. Certain changes resulting from the Dodd-Frank Act may impact the profitability of our 
business activities, require changes to certain of our business practices, impose upon us more stringent 
capital, liquidity and leverage requirements or otherwise adversely affect our business. These changes may 
also require us to invest significant management attention and resources to evaluate and make any chang-
es necessary to comply with new statutory and regulatory requirements. Failure to comply with the new 
requirements may negatively impact our results of operations and financial condition. While we cannot 
predict what effect any presently contemplated or future changes in the laws or regulations or their inter-
pretations would have on us, these changes could be materially adverse to investors in our common stock.

39

2015 Form 10-KNew capital rules that were recently issued generally require insured depository institutions and their holding 
companies to hold more capital.  The impact of the new rules on our financial condition and operations is uncer-
tain but could be materially adverse.

On July 2, 2013, the Federal Reserve adopted a final rule for the Basel III capital framework and, 
on July 9, 2013, the OCC also adopted a final rule and the FDIC adopted the same provisions in the form 
of an “interim final.”  The requirements in the rule began to phase in on January 1, 2014 for advanced 
approaches	banking	organizations,	and	on	January	1,	2015	for	other	covered	banking	organizations,	in-
cluding the Company and the Bank. The requirements in the rule will be fully phased in by January 1, 2019. 
These rules substantially amend the regulatory risk-based capital rules applicable to us.  

The final rules increase capital requirements and generally include two new capital measurements 
that will affect us, a risk-based Common Equity Tier 1 ratio and a capital conservation buffer. Common 
Equity Tier 1 (CET1) capital is a subset of Tier 1 capital and is limited to common equity (plus related sur-
plus), retained earnings, accumulated other comprehensive income and certain other items. Other instru-
ments that have historically qualified for Tier 1 treatment, including non-cumulative perpetual preferred 
stock, are consigned to a category known as additional Tier 1 capital and must be phased out over a period 
of nine years beginning in 2015. The rules permit bank holding companies with less than $15 billion in as-
sets (such as us) to continue to include trust preferred securities and non-cumulative perpetual preferred 
stock issued before May 19, 2010 in Tier 1 capital, but not CET1. Tier 2 capital consists of instruments that 
have historically been placed in Tier 2, as well as cumulative perpetual preferred stock.

The final rules adjust all three categories of capital by requiring new deductions from and adjust-
ments to capital that will result in more stringent capital requirements and may require changes in the 
ways we do business. Among other things, the current rule on the deduction of mortgage servicing assets 
from Tier 1 capital has been revised in ways that are likely to require a greater deduction than we currently 
make and that will require the deduction to be made from CET1.  This deduction phases in over a three-
year period from 2015 through 2017.  We closely monitor our mortgage servicing assets, and we expect to 
maintain our mortgage servicing asset at levels close to the deduction thresholds by a combination of sales 
of	portions	of	these	assets	from	time	to	time	either	on	a	flowing	basis	as	we	originate	mortgages	or	through	
bulk	sale	transactions.	Additionally,	any	gains	on	sales	from	mortgage	loans	sold	into	securitizations	must	
be deducted in full from CET1.  This requirement phases in over three years from 2015 through 2017.  
Under the earlier rule and through 2014, no deduction was required.

Beginning in 2015, our minimum capital requirements were increased to (i) a CET1 ratio of 4.5%, 
(ii) a Tier 1 capital (CET1 plus Additional Tier 1 capital) of 6% (up from 4%) and (iii) a total capital ratio 
of  8%  (the  current  requirement).  Our  leverage  ratio  requirement  will  remain  at  the  4%  level  now  re-
quired. Beginning in 2016, a capital conservation buffer will phase in over three years, ultimately resulting 
in a requirement of 2.5% on top of the CET1, Tier 1 and total capital requirements, resulting in a require 
CET1 ratio of 7%, a Tier 1 ratio of 8.5%, and a total capital ratio of 10.5%. Failure to satisfy any of these 
three  capital  requirements  will  result  in  limits  on  paying  dividends,  engaging  in  share  repurchases  and 
paying discretionary bonuses. These limitations will establish a maximum percentage of eligible retained 
income	that	could	be	utilized	for	such	actions.	While	the	final	rules	will	result	in	higher	regulatory	capital	
standards, it is difficult at this time to predict when or how any new standards will ultimately be applied 
to us.

In addition to the higher required capital ratios and the new deductions and adjustments, the final 
rules increased the risk weights for certain assets, meaning that we will have to hold more capital against 

40

these assets. For example, commercial real estate loans that do not meet certain new underwriting require-
ments must be risk-weighted at 150%, rather than the previous requirement of 100%. There are also new 
risk weights for unsettled transactions and derivatives. We also are required to hold capital against short-
term commitments that are not unconditionally cancelable; currently, there are no capital requirements 
currently for these off-balance sheet assets.

In addition, in the current economic and regulatory environment, bank regulators may impose 
capital requirements that are more stringent than those required by applicable existing regulations. The 
application of more stringent capital requirements for us could, among other things, result in lower returns 
on equity, require the raising of additional capital, and result in regulatory actions if we were to be unable 
to comply with such requirements. Implementation of changes to asset risk weightings for risk-based cap-
ital calculations, items included or deducted in calculating regulatory capital or additional capital conser-
vation buffers, could result in management modifying our business strategy and could limit our ability to 
make distributions, including paying dividends or buying back our shares.

We face a risk of noncompliance and enforcement action with the Bank Secrecy Act and other anti-money laun-
dering statutes and regulations.

The federal Bank Secrecy Act, the Uniting and Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate 
Tools Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001 (the “USA PATRIOT Act”), and other 
laws and regulations require financial institutions, among other duties, to institute and maintain effective 
anti-money laundering programs and file suspicious activity and currency transaction reports as appro-
priate.  The  federal  Financial  Crimes  Enforcement  Network,  established  by  the  Treasury  to  administer 
the	 Bank	 Secrecy	 Act,	 is	 authorized	 to	 impose	 significant	 civil	 money	 penalties	 for	 violations	 of	 those	
requirements  and  has  recently  engaged  in  coordinated  enforcement  efforts  with  the  individual  federal 
banking regulators, as well as the Department of Justice, Drug Enforcement Administration and Internal 
Revenue Service. There is also increased scrutiny of compliance with the rules enforced by OFAC. Federal 
and state bank regulators also have begun to focus on compliance with Bank Secrecy Act and anti-money 
laundering regulations. If our policies, procedures and systems are deemed deficient we would be subject 
to liability, including fines and regulatory actions, such as restrictions on our ability to pay dividends, which 
would negatively impact our business, financial condition and results of operations. Failure to maintain 
and implement adequate programs to combat money laundering and terrorist financing could also have 
serious reputational consequences for us.

Federal, state and local consumer lending laws may restrict our ability to originate certain mortgage loans or 
increase our risk of liability with respect to such loans and could increase our cost of doing business.

Federal, state and local laws have been adopted that are intended to eliminate certain lending 
practices considered “predatory.” These laws prohibit practices such as steering borrowers away from 
more affordable products, selling unnecessary insurance to borrowers, repeatedly refinancing loans and 
making  loans  without  a  reasonable  expectation  that  the  borrowers  will  be  able  to  repay  the  loans  ir-
respective  of  the  value  of  the  underlying  property.  Since  2013,  the  CFPB  has  issued  several  rules  on 
mortgage lending, notably a rule requiring all home mortgage lenders to determine a borrower’s ability 
to repay the loan.  Loans with certain terms and conditions and that otherwise meet the definition of 
a “qualified mortgage” may be protected from liability to a borrower for failing to make the necessary 
determinations.    In  either  case,  we  may  find  it  necessary  to  tighten  our  mortgage  loan  underwriting 
 standards in response to the CFPB rules, which may constrain our ability to make loans consistent with 
our business strategies. It is our policy not to make predatory loans and to determine borrowers’ ability 

41

2015 Form 10-Kto repay, but the law and related rules create the potential for increased liability with respect to our 
lending and loan investment activities. They increase our cost of doing business and, ultimately, may 
prevent us from making certain loans and cause us to reduce the average percentage rate or the points 
and fees on loans that we do make.

The requirements of being a public company may strain our resources, divert management’s attention and affect 
our ability to attract and retain executive management and qualified board members.

Our common stock was registered under the Exchange Act in 2014, thereby subjecting the Com-
pany to the reporting requirements of the Exchange Act, the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, the Dodd-Frank Act, 
and other applicable securities rules and regulations. Compliance with these rules and regulations have 
and will continue to increase our legal and financial compliance costs, make some activities more difficult, 
time-consuming or costly and increase demand on our systems and resources. The Exchange Act requires, 
among other things, that we file annual, quarterly and current reports with respect to our business and 
operating results. The Sarbanes-Oxley Act requires, among other things, that we maintain effective dis-
closure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting. In order to maintain and, if 
required, improve our disclosure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting to 
meet this standard, significant resources and management oversight may be required. As a result, manage-
ment’s attention may be diverted from other business concerns, which could adversely affect our business 
and operating results. Although we have hired additional employees to comply with these requirements, 
we may need to hire more employees in the future or engage outside consultants, which will increase our 
costs and expenses.

In addition, changing laws, regulations and standards relating to corporate governance and pub-
lic disclosure are creating uncertainty for public companies, increasing legal and financial compliance 
costs and making some activities more time consuming. These laws, regulations and standards are sub-
ject to varying interpretations, in many cases due to their lack of specificity, and, as a result, their appli-
cation in practice may evolve over time as new guidance is provided by regulatory and governing bodies. 
This could result in continuing uncertainty regarding compliance matters and higher costs necessitated 
by ongoing revisions to disclosure and governance practices. We intend to invest resources to comply 
with evolving laws, regulations and standards, and this investment may result in increased general and 
administrative expenses and a diversion of management’s time and attention from revenue-generating 
activities  to  compliance  activities.  If  our  efforts  to  comply  with  new  laws,  regulations  and  standards 
differ from the activities intended by regulatory or governing bodies due to ambiguities related to their 
application and practice, regulatory authorities may initiate legal proceedings against us and our busi-
ness may be adversely affected.

We	also	expect	that	being	a	public	reporting	company,	our	higher	market	capitalization,	and	these	
new  rules  and  regulations  will  increase  the  costs  of  our  director  and  officer  liability  insurance,  and  we 
may be required to accept reduced coverage or incur substantially higher costs to obtain coverage. These 
factors could also make it more difficult for us to attract and retain qualified members of our board of 
directors, particularly to serve on our audit committee and compensation committee, and qualified exec-
utive officers.

As a result of disclosure of information in this report and in filings required of a public company, 
our business and financial condition will become more visible, which may result in threatened or actual 
litigation,  including  by  competitors  and  other  third  parties.  If  such  claims  are  successful,  our  business 

42

and operating results could be adversely affected, and even if the claims do not result in litigation or are 
resolved in our favor, these claims, and the time and resources necessary to resolve them, could divert the 
resources of our management and adversely affect our business and operating results.

We may be adversely affected by the soundness of other financial institutions.

Financial services institutions are interrelated as a result of trading, clearing, counterparty, or oth-
er relationships. We have exposure to many different industries and counterparties, and routinely execute 
transactions with counterparties in the financial services industry, including commercial banks, brokers 
and  dealers,  investment  banks,  and  other  institutional  clients.  Many  of  these  transactions  expose  us  to 
credit risk in the event of a default by a counterparty or client. In addition, our credit risk may be exacer-
bated	when	the	collateral	held	by	the	bank	cannot	be	realized	upon	or	is	liquidated	at	prices	not	sufficient	
to recover the full amount of the credit or derivative exposure due to the bank. Any such losses could have 
a material adverse affect on our financial condition and results of operations.

We may face risks if we seek to expand through acquisitions or mergers.

From time to time, we may seek to acquire other financial institutions or parts of those institu-
tions. We may also expand into new markets or lines of business or offer new products or services. These 
activities would involve a number of risks, including:

•	

•	

•	

	the	potential	inaccuracy	of	the	estimates	and	judgments	used	to	evaluate	credit,	operations,	
management, and market risks with respect to a target institution;

	the	time	and	costs	of	evaluating	new	markets,	hiring	or	retaining	experienced	local	manage-
ment, and opening new offices and the time lags between these activities and the generation 
of sufficient assets and deposits to support the costs of the expansion;

	the	incurrence	and	possible	impairment	of	goodwill	associated	with	an	acquisition	and	possi-
ble adverse effects on our results of operations; and

•	

the	risk	of	loss	of	key	employees	and	customers.

We depend on the accuracy and completeness of information about clients and counterparties and our financial 
condition could be adversely affected if we rely on misleading information.

In deciding whether to extend credit or to enter into other transactions with clients and coun-
terparties,  we  may  rely  on  information  furnished  to  us  by  or  on  behalf  of  clients  and  counterparties, 
including financial statements and other financial information, which we do not independently verify. We 
also may rely on representations of clients and counterparties as to the accuracy and completeness of that 
information and, with respect to financial statements, on reports of independent auditors. For example, 
in deciding whether to extend credit to clients, we may assume that a customer’s audited financial state-
ments conform with GAAP and present fairly, in all material respects, the financial condition, results of 
operations	and	cash	flows	of	the	customer.	Our	financial	condition	and	results	of	operations	could	be	
negatively impacted to the extent we rely on financial statements that do not comply with GAAP or are 
materially misleading.

43

2015 Form 10-KOur ability to pay cash dividends is limited, and we may be unable to pay future dividends even if we desire to do 
so.

The Federal Reserve has issued a policy statement regarding the payment of dividends by bank 
holding companies. In general, the Federal Reserve’s policies provide that dividends should be paid only 
out of current earnings and only if the prospective rate of earnings retention by the bank holding company 
appears	consistent	with	the	organization’s	capital	needs,	asset	quality	and	overall	financial	condition.	The	
Federal Reserve’s policies also require that a bank holding company serve as a source of financial strength 
to its subsidiary banks by standing ready to use available resources to provide adequate capital funds to 
those	banks	during	periods	of	financial	stress	or	adversity	and	by	maintaining	the	financial	flexibility	and	
capital raising capacity to obtain additional resources for assisting its subsidiary banks where necessary. 
In addition, under the prompt corrective action regulations, the ability of a bank holding company to pay 
dividends	may	be	restricted	if	a	subsidiary	bank	becomes	undercapitalized.	These	regulatory	policies	could	
affect the ability of the Company to pay dividends or otherwise engage in capital distributions.

Our ability to pay cash dividends may be limited by regulatory restrictions, by our Bank’s ability 
to pay cash dividends to the Company and by our need to maintain sufficient capital to support our oper-
ations. As a South Carolina chartered bank, the Bank is subject to limitations on the amount of dividends 
that  it  is  permitted  to  pay.  Unless  otherwise  instructed  by  the  SCBFI,  the  Bank  is  generally  permitted 
under South Carolina state banking regulations to pay cash dividends of up to 100% of net income in any 
calendar year without obtaining the prior approval of the SCBFI. If our Bank is not permitted to pay cash 
dividends to the Company, it is unlikely that we would be able to pay cash dividends on our common stock. 
Moreover, holders of our common stock are entitled to receive dividends only when, and if declared by 
our board of directors. Although we have historically paid cash dividends on our common stock, we are 
not required to do so and our board of directors could reduce or eliminate our common stock dividend in 
the future.

A failure in or breach of our operational or security systems or infrastructure, or those of our third party ven-
dors and other service providers or other third parties, including as a result of cyber attacks, could disrupt our 
businesses, result in the disclosure or misuse of confidential or proprietary information, damage our reputation, 
increase our costs, and cause losses.

We rely heavily on communications and information systems to conduct our business. Information 
security risks for financial institutions such as ours have generally increased in recent years in part because 
of the proliferation of new technologies, the use of the internet and telecommunications technologies to 
conduct	 financial	 transactions,	 and	 the	 increased	 sophistication	 and	 activities	 of	 organized	 crime,	 hack-
ers, and terrorists, activists, and other external parties. As customer, public, and regulatory expectations 
regarding operational and information security have increased, our operating systems and infrastructure 
must continue to be safeguarded and monitored for potential failures, disruptions, and breakdowns. Our 
business, financial, accounting, and data processing systems, or other operating systems and facilities may 
stop operating properly or become disabled or damaged as a result of a number of factors, including events 
that are wholly or partially beyond our control. For example, there could be electrical or telecommunica-
tion outages; natural disasters such as earthquakes, tornadoes, and hurricanes; disease pandemics; events 
arising from local or larger scale political or social matters, including terrorist acts; and as described below, 
cyber attacks.

As  noted  above,  our  business  relies  on  our  digital  technologies,  computer  and  email  systems, 
software and networks to conduct its operations. Although we have information security procedures and 

44

controls in place, our technologies, systems, networks, and our customers’ devices may become the target 
of	cyber	attacks	or	information	security	breaches	that	could	result	in	the	unauthorized	release,		gathering,	
monitoring, misuse, loss, or destruction of our or our customers’ or other third parties’ confidential in-
formation.  Third  parties  with  whom  we  do  business  or  that  facilitate  our  business  activities,  including 
financial intermediaries, or vendors that provide service or security solutions for our operations, and other 
unaffiliated third parties could also be sources of operational and information security risk to us, including 
from breakdowns or failures of their own systems or capacity constraints.

While we have disaster recovery and other policies and procedures designed to prevent or lim-
it the effect of the failure, interruption or security breach of our information systems, there can be no 
assurance that any such failures, interruptions or security breaches will not occur or, if they do occur, 
that  they  will  be  adequately  addressed.  Our  risk  and  exposure  to  these  matters  remains  heightened 
because of the evolving nature of these threats. As a result, cyber security and the continued devel-
opment and enhancement of our controls, processes, and practices designed to protect our systems, 
computers,	software,	data,	and	networks	from	attack,	damage	or	unauthorized	access	remain	a	focus	
for us. As threats continue to evolve, we may be required to expend additional resources to continue 
to  modify  or  enhance  our  protective  measures  or  to  investigate  and  remediate  information  security 
vulnerabilities. Disruptions or failures in the physical infrastructure or operating systems that support 
our businesses and clients, or cyber attacks or security breaches of the networks, systems or devices 
that our clients use to access our products and services could result in client attrition, regulatory fines, 
penalties  or  intervention,  reputation  damage,  reimbursement  or  other  compensation  costs,  and/or 
additional compliance costs, any of which could have a material effect on our results of operations or 
financial condition.

Negative public opinion surrounding our Company and the financial institutions industry generally could dam-
age our reputation and adversely impact our earnings and our ability to make loans or to acquire deposits.

Reputation  risk,  or  the  risk  to  our  business,  earnings  and  capital  from  negative  public  opinion 
surrounding  our  company  and  the  financial  institutions  industry  generally,  is  inherent  in  our  business. 
Negative public opinion can result from our actual or alleged conduct in any number of activities, includ-
ing lending practices, corporate governance and acquisitions, and from actions taken by government regu-
lators	and	community	organizations	in	response	to	those	activities.	Negative	public	opinion	can	adversely	
affect our ability to keep and attract clients and employees and can expose us to litigation and regulatory 
action.	Although	we	take	steps	to	minimize	reputation	risk	in	dealing	with	our	clients	and	communities,	
this risk will always be present given the nature of our business.

We are an emerging growth company and we cannot be certain if the reduced disclosure requirements applicable 
to emerging growth companies will make our common stock less attractive to investors.

We are an emerging growth company. Under the JOBS Act, emerging growth companies can take 
advantage of certain exemptions from various reporting requirements that are applicable to other public 
companies including, without limitation, reduced disclosure obligations regarding executive compensation 
in our periodic reports and proxy statements, exemptions from the requirements of holding a nonbinding 
advisory stockholder vote on executive compensation and any golden parachute payments not previously 
approved, exemption from the requirement of auditor attestation in the assessment of our internal control 
over financial reporting and exemption from any requirement that may be adopted by the Public Company 
Accounting Oversight Board regarding mandatory audit firm rotation or a supplement to the auditor’s 
report providing additional information about our audit and the financial statements (auditor discussion 

45

2015 Form 10-Kand analysis). As a result of the foregoing, the information that we provide stockholders may be different 
than what is available with respect to other public companies. We cannot predict if investors will find our 
common stock less attractive because we will rely on these exemptions. If investors find our common stock 
less attractive as a result of our status as an emerging growth company, there may be less liquidity for our 
common stock and our stock price may be more volatile.

We will remain an emerging growth company until the earliest of (i) the end of the fiscal year in 
which the market value of our common stock that is held by non-affiliates exceeds $700 million as of the 
end of the second fiscal quarter, (ii) the end of the fiscal year in which we have total annual gross reve-
nues of $1 billion or more during such fiscal year, (iii) the date on which we issue more than $1 billion in 
non-convertible debt in a three-year period or (iv) the end of the fiscal year following the fifth anniversary 
of the date of the first sale of our common stock pursuant to an effective registration statement filed under 
the Securities Act, which will be in December of 2019.

Risks Related to Our Common Stock

Our stock price may be volatile, which could result in losses to our investors and litigation against us.

Several	factors	could	cause	our	stock	price	to	fluctuate	substantially	in	the	future.	These	factors	
include but are not limited to: actual or anticipated variations in earnings, changes in analysts’ recom-
mendations  or  projections,  our  announcement  of  developments  related  to  our  businesses,  operations 
and stock performance of other companies deemed to be peers, new technology used or services offered 
by traditional and non-traditional competitors, news reports of trends, irrational exuberance on the part 
of investors, new federal banking regulations, and other issues related to the financial services industry. 
Our	 stock	 price	 may	 fluctuate	 significantly	 in	 the	 future,	 and	 these	 fluctuations	 may	 be	 unrelated	 to	
our performance. General market declines or market volatility in the future, especially in the financial 
institutions sector, could adversely affect the price of our common stock, and the current market price 
may not be indicative of future market prices. Stock price volatility may make it more difficult for you 
to resell your common stock when you want and at prices you find attractive. Moreover, in the past, se-
curities class action lawsuits have been instituted against some companies following periods of volatility 
in the market price of its securities. We could in the future be the target of similar litigation. Securities 
litigation  could  result  in  substantial  costs  and  divert  management’s  attention  and  resources  from  our 
normal business.

Future sales of our stock by our stockholders or the perception that those sales could occur may cause our stock 
price to decline.

Although our common stock is listed on the Nasdaq Global Market under the symbol “CARO,” 
the trading volume in our common stock is lower than that of other larger financial services companies . 
A public trading market having the desired characteristics of depth, liquidity and orderliness depends on 
the presence in the marketplace of willing buyers and sellers of our common stock at any given time. This 
presence depends on the individual decisions of investors and general economic and market conditions 
over which we have no control. Given the relatively low trading volume of our common stock, significant 
sales of our common stock in the public market, or the perception that those sales may occur, could cause 
the trading price of our common stock to decline or to be lower than it otherwise might be in the absence 
of those sales or perceptions.

46

Economic and other circumstances may require us to raise capital at times or in amounts that are unfavorable to 
us. If we have to issue shares of common stock, they will dilute the percentage ownership interest of existing stock-
holders and may dilute the book value per share of our common stock and adversely affect the terms on which we 
may obtain additional capital.

We may need to incur additional debt or equity financing in the future to make strategic acquisi-
tions or investments or to strengthen our capital position. Our ability to raise additional capital, if needed, 
will depend on, among other things, conditions in the capital markets at that time, which are outside of our 
control and our financial performance. We cannot provide assurance that such financing will be available 
to us on acceptable terms or at all, or if we do raise additional capital that it will not be dilutive to existing 
stockholders.

If we determine, for any reason, that we need to raise capital, our board generally has the author-
ity,	without	action	by	or	vote	of	the	stockholders,	to	issue	all	or	part	of	any	authorized	but	unissued	shares	
of stock for any corporate purpose, including issuance of equity-based incentives under or outside of our 
equity compensation plans. Additionally, we are not restricted from issuing additional common stock or 
preferred stock, including any securities that are convertible into or exchangeable for, or that represent the 
right to receive, common stock or preferred stock or any substantially similar securities. The market price 
of our common stock could decline as a result of sales by us of a large number of shares of common stock 
or preferred stock or similar securities in the market or from the perception that such sales could occur. 
Any issuance of additional shares of stock will dilute the percentage ownership interest of our stockhold-
ers and may dilute the book value per share of our common stock. Shares we issue in connection with any 
such offering will increase the total number of shares and may dilute the economic and voting ownership 
interest of our existing stockholders.

Our board of directors may issue shares of preferred stock that would adversely affect the rights of our common 
stockholders.

Our	authorized	capital	stock	includes	1,000,000	shares	of	preferred	stock	of	which	no	preferred	
shares are issued and outstanding. Our board of directors, in its sole discretion, may designate and issue 
one	or	more	series	of	preferred	stock	from	the	authorized	and	unissued	shares	of	preferred	stock.	Subject	
to limitations imposed by law or our certificate of incorporation, our board of directors is empowered to 
determine:

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

the designation of, and the number of, shares constituting each series of preferred stock;

the dividend rate for each series;

the terms and conditions of any voting, conversion and exchange rights for each series;

 the amounts payable on each series on redemption or our liquidation, dissolution or wind-
ing-up;

the provisions of any sinking fund for the redemption or purchase of shares of any series; and

the preferences and the relative rights among the series of preferred stock.

47

2015 Form 10-KWe could issue preferred stock with voting and conversion rights that could adversely affect the 
voting power of the shares of our common stock and with preferences over the common stock with respect 
to dividends and in liquidation.

Our securities are not FDIC insured.

Our securities, including our common stock, are not savings or deposit accounts or other obliga-
tions of the Bank, are not insured by the Deposit Insurance Fund, the FDIC or any other governmental 
agency and are subject to investment risk, including the possible loss of principal.

ITEM 1B.  UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS.

None.

ITEM 2.  PROPERTIES.

Our  main  office  is  located  at  288  Meeting  Street,  Charleston,  South  Carolina  29401-1575.    In 
addition, the Bank operates 26 additional branches located primarily along the South Carolina coast and 
southeastern coastal region of North Carolina.  The addresses of these offices are provided below. In Au-
gust 2015, we opened a branch in Greenville, South Carolina. We also operate loan production offices in 
Greenville, South Carolina and Wilmington, North Carolina. In addition to our main office and branches, 
we also operate Crescent Mortgage Company, which is headquartered in Atlanta, Georgia, and Carolina 
Services Corporation of Charleston, with Carolina Services Corporation’s operations conducted from our 
West Ashley location. We believe these premises will be adequate for present and anticipated needs and 
that we have adequate insurance to cover our owned and leased premises. For each property that we lease, 
we believe that upon expiration of the lease we will be able to extend the lease on satisfactory terms or 
relocate to another acceptable location.

Office

Myrtle Beach Office

Address
  991 38th Avenue N.

City, State, Zip

  Myrtle Beach, South Carolina 

  Lease/Own
  Own

29577

North Myrtle Beach  

  700 Main Street

  North Myrtle Beach, South 

  Land Lease

Office

Conway Office

  2069 Highway 501 East

Carolina 29582
  Conway, South Carolina 

29526

  Land Lease

Garden City Office

  2636 South Highway 17  

  Garden City, South Carolina 

  Own

Socastee Office

Business
  4506 Highway 707

29576

  Myrtle Beach, South Carolina 

  Own

29588

Meeting Street Office   288 Meeting Street

  Charleston, South Carolina 

  Lease

West Ashley Office

  884 Orleans Road

  Charleston, South Carolina 

  Own

29407-4937

James Island Office

  430 Folly Road

  Charleston, South Carolina 

  Own

29412-2641

Summerville Office

  200 North Cedar Street

  Summerville, South Carolina 

  Own

29483-6404

29401-1575

48

 
 
Mount Pleasant Office   1492 Stuart Engals Blvd

  Mt. Pleasant, South Carolina 

  Own

29464

North Charleston 

  8485 Dorchester Road

  N. Charleston, South 

  Own

Office

Litchfield/Pawleys 
Island Office
St. George Office

  13021 Ocean Highway

Carolina 29420-7307

  Pawleys Island, South 
Carolina 29585

  Own

  5561 Memorial Boulevard

  St. George, South Carolina 

  Own

29477

Cane Bay Office

  1274 State Road, Suite 4C

  Summerville, South Carolina 

  Lease

29483

Conway 16th Ave 

  1230 16th Avenue

  Conway, South Carolina 

  Lease

Office

29526

Little River Office

  1180 Highway 17

  Little River, South Carolina 

  Own

Heath Springs Office   202 N. Main Steet

29566

  Heath Springs, South 
Carolina 29058

  Own

Greenville Office

  3695 E. North Street

  Greenville, South Carolina 

  Own

29615

Whiteville Office

  110 N J K Powell Blvd

  Whiteville, North Carolina 

  Own

28472

Chadbourn Office

  111 Strawberry Blvd

  Chadbourn, North Carolina 

  Own

28431

Tabor City Office

  105 Hickman Rd

  Tabor City, North Carolina 

  Lease

Elizabethtown	Office   306 S. Poplar Street

28463

  Elizabethtown,	North	
Carolina 28337

  Land Lease

Shallotte Office

  200 Smith Avenue

  Shallotte, North Carolina 

  Own

Sunset Beach Office

  7290-17 Beach Drive SW

28459

  Ocean Isle Beach, North 
Carolina 28469

  Lease

Holden Beach Office   3178 Holden Beach Road SW   Supply, North Carolina 28462   Lease
  Lease
Southport Howe St 

  Southport, North Carolina 

  115 North Howe Street

Office

48461

Southport Supply Rd 

  4945 Southport-Supply Road   Southport, North Carolina 

  Land Lease

Office

48461

Crescent Mortgage 

  5901 Peachtree Dunwoody 

  Atlanta, Georgia 30328

  Lease

Company

Road NE

ITEM 3.  LEGAL PROCEEDINGS.

In the ordinary course of operations, we may be a party to various legal proceedings from time 
to time. We do not believe that there is any pending or threatened proceeding against us, which, if deter-
mined adversely, would have a material effect on our business, results of operations, or financial condition.

ITEM 4.  MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES.

None.

49

2015 Form 10-KPART II

ITEM 5.  MARKET FOR COMMON EQUITY AND RELATED SHAREHOLDER MATTERS.

As of March 14, 2016, there were approximately 258 stockholders of record of our common stock. 
Our common stock is listed on the NASDAQ Capital Market on July 1, 2014. From October 9, 2013 to 
June 30, 2014, our common stock was quoted on the OTCQB marketplace (the “OTCQB”) and a spon-
soring broker-dealer matched buy and sell orders for our common stock. Although our common stock 
was  quoted  on  the  OTCQB  during  this  period,  the  trading  markets  on  the  OTCQB  lacked  the  depth, 
liquidity, and orderliness necessary to maintain a liquid market. The OTCQB prices are quotations, which 
reflect	 inter-dealer	 prices,	 without	 retail	 mark-up,	 mark-down	 or	 commissions	 and	 may	 not	 represent	
actual transactions. The following table sets forth the high and low sales price information as reported by 
NASDAQ or OTCQB quotations, as applicable, for each quarter of 2014 and 2015, and the dividends per 
share declared on our common stock in each quarter of 2014 and 2015. All information has been adjusted 
for any stock splits and stock dividends effected during the periods presented.

2015
Quarter Ended December 31, 2015
Quarter Ended September 30, 2015
Quarter Ended June 30, 2015
Quarter Ended March 31, 2015
2014
Quarter Ended December 31, 2014
Quarter Ended September 30, 2014
Quarter Ended June 30, 2014
Quarter Ended March 31, 2014

  High     Low     Dividends 

  $

  $

  $

  $

18.20 
17.00 
14.78 
11.87 

   14.50 
   13.13 
   10.85 
   10.83 

12.51 
12.08 
8.96 
9.79 

   10.56 
8.27 
8.08 
6.41 

0.03 
0.03 
0.03 
0.03 

0.03 
0.03 
0.03 
0.03 

We	are	authorized	to	pay	dividends	as	declared	by	our	board	of	directors,	provided	that	no	such	
distribution results in our insolvency on a going concern or balance sheet basis. Future dividends will be 
subject  to  board  approval.  As  we  are  a  legal  entity  separate  and  distinct  from  the  Bank,  our  principal 
source  of funds with which we can pay dividends  to our shareholders is  dividends  we receive from the 
Bank. For that reason, our ability to pay dividends is subject to the limitations that apply to the Bank. For 
more information on restrictions on payments of dividends, see Note 20 “Capital Requirements and Other 
Restrictions” included in Part II, Item 8 – Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.

50

 
   
 
   
 
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Equity Compensation Plan Information

The following table provides information as of December 31, 2015, with respect to shares of our 

common stock that may be issued under existing equity compensation plans.

Plan Category

Equity compensation plans approved 

by security holders

Equity compensation plans not 
approved by security holders

Total

Number of securities 
to be issued upon  
exercise of 
outstanding options, 
warrants and rights   

Weighted-average 
exercise price 
of outstanding 
options, warrants 
and rights

Number of securities 
remaining available 
for future issuance 
under equity compen- 
sation plans

191,570  $

—   
191,570  $

6.61   

—   
6.61   

453,022 

— 
453,022 

On January 15, 2014, the Board of Directors of the Company declared a two-for-one stock split to 

stockholders of record dated February 10, 2014, payable on February 28, 2014.

On October 15, 2014, the Board of Directors of the Company declared an additional two-for-one 

stock split to stockholders of record as of October 31, 2014, payable on November 14, 2014.

On June 22, 2015, the Board of Directors of the Company declared a six-for-five stock split repre-

senting a 20% stock dividend to stockholders of record as of July 15, 2015, payable on July 31, 2015.

All	share,	earnings	per	share,	and	per	share	data	have	been	retroactively	adjusted	to	reflect	these	

stock splits for all periods presented in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

51

2015 Form 10-K 
  
 
  
  
  
ITEM 6.  SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

2015

For The Years Ended December 31,
2013
(In thousands)

2012

2014

Operating Data:
Interest income
Interest expense
Net interest income
Provision for loan losses
Net interest income after provision for loan 

losses

Noninterest income
Noninterest expense
Income (loss) before income taxes
Income tax expense (benefit)
Net income (loss)

$

$

49,604    
6,604    
43,000    
—    

  37,656 
5,602 
  32,054 

  32,948  
5,718  
  27,230  

—  

(860)  

43,000    
27,679    
49,199    
21,480    
7,060    
14,420    

  32,054 
  21,148 
  41,443 
  11,759 
3,448 
8,311 

  28,090  
  44,086  
  45,972  
  26,204  
9,386  
  16,818  

  35,356 
7,513 
  27,843 
2,707 

  25,136 
  53,524 
  51,387 
  27,273
  10,395

  16,878

2011

38,441 
11,113 
27,328 
10,735 

16,593 
19,721 
37,413 
(1,099)
(128)

(971)

Balance Sheet Data:

Total assets
Interest-bearing cash
Securities available for sale
Securities held to maturity
Federal Home Loan Bank stock
Loans held for sale
Loans receivable, net
Allowance for loan losses
Deposits
Short-term borrowed funds
Long-term debt
Stockholders’ equity

2015

2014

2013

2012

2011

At December 31,

(In thousands)

$ 1,409,669   
16,421   
306,474   
17,053   
9,919   
41,774   
912,582   
10,141   
  1,031,528   
120,000   
103,465   
139,859   

  1,199,017   
10,694   
251,717   
25,544   
5,405   
40,912   
768,122   
9,035   
964,190   
57,800   
61,740   
93,700   

  881,584   
34,176   
  167,535   
24,554   
4,103   
36,897   
  535,221   
8,091   
  697,581   
10,300   
74,540   
82,227   

  888,724   
11,340   
  148,407   
9,166   
6,413   
  144,849   
  501,691   
9,520   
  653,247   
82,482   
64,840   
67,514   

  826,218 
16,679 
  136,944 
9,401 
7,185 
80,007 
  513,335 
12,039 
  621,803 
63,484 
80,390 
45,655 

52

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Selected Average Balances:
Total assets
Loans receivable
Deposits
Stockholders’ equity
Performance Ratios:
Return on average equity
Return on average assets
Average earning assets to average total assets
Average loans receivable to average deposits
Average equity to average assets
Net interest margin
Net interest margin - tax equivalent (1)
Net (recovery) charge-offs to average loans receivable   
Non-performing assets to total loans receivable
Non-performing assets to total assets
Non-performing loans to total loans receivable
Allowance for loan losses as a percentage of loans  
  receivable (end of period) (2)
Allowance for loan losses as a percentage of  
  nonperforming loans

For The Years Ended December 31,

2015

2014  

  2013  

  2012  

  2011  

(Dollars in thousands)

  $ 1,303,402 
827,787 
    1,012,659 
101,896 

    990,773 
    613,144 
    777,622 
    88,474 

   889,851 
   509,455 
   696,784 
   76,322 

    837,066 
    495,889 
    641,085 
    54,002 

   858,432 
   545,556 
   649,002 
   47,003 

14.15%    
1.11%    
91.92%    
81.74%    
7.82%    
3.59%    
3.68%    
(0.13)%   
0.72%    
0.47%    
0.47%    

9.39%   
0.84%   
91.43%   
78.85%   
8.93%   
3.54%   
3.62%   
(0.15)%  
0.73%   
0.47%   
0.31%   

22.04%   
1.89%   
91.38%   
73.12%   
8.58%   
3.35%   
3.41%   
0.11%   
3.24%   
1.97%   
2.04%   

31.25%  
2.02%  
92.29%  
77.35%  
6.45%  
3.60%  
3.61%  
1.05%  
4.29%  
2.42%  
2.98%  

(2.07)%
(0.11)%
92.24%
84.06%
5.48%
3.45%
3.45%
2.38%
7.84%
4.87%
6.50%

1.10%    

1.16%   

1.49%   

1.86%  

2.29%

235.73%     371.20%   

73.03%   

62.43%  

35.24%

At or For The Years Ended December 31,

2015

2014

2013

2012

2011

Per Share Data:
Book value (end of period)
Basic earnings (loss)
Diluted earnings (loss)

  $

11.92  
1.51  
1.48  

10.02  
0.89  
0.87  

8.91    
1.83    
1.77    

7.33    
1.83    
1.83    

4.96 
(0.11)
(0.11)

Average common shares - basic
Average common shares - diluted

    9,537,358  
    9,718,356  

 9,314,048  
 9,507,425  

 9,218,952    9,211,162    9,211,162 
 9,500,987    9,211,162    9,211,162 

Note: Book value is calculated using common shares less unvested restricted shares.

(1)	
(2) 

The	tax	equivalent	net	interest	margin	reflects	tax-exempt	income	on	a	tax-equivalent	basis.	
 Included in loans receivable are approximately $64.1 million and $80.3 million in acquired loans at December 31, 
2015 and 2014. 

53

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
  
   
   
   
  
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
  
   
   
   
  
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
   
    
 
    
 
      
      
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
On January 15, 2014, the Board of Directors of the Company declared a two-for-one stock split to 

stockholders of record dated February 10, 2014, payable on February 28, 2014.

On October 15, 2014, the Board of Directors of the Company declared an additional two-for-one 

stock split to stockholders of record as of October 31, 2014, payable on November 14, 2014.

On June 22, 2015, the Board of Directors of the Company declared a six-for-five stock split repre-

senting a 20% stock dividend to stockholders of record as of July 15, 2015, payable on July 31, 2015.

All	share,	earnings	per	share,	and	per	share	data	have	been	retroactively	adjusted	to	reflect	these	

stock splits for all periods presented in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

ITEM 7. 

 MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND  
RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

The following discussion and analysis of our consolidated financial condition and results of opera-
tions should be read in conjunction with our consolidated financial statements and related notes included 
elsewhere  in  this  report.    Historical  results  of  operations  and  the  percentage  relationships  among  any 
amounts included, and any trends that may appear, may not indicate trends in operations or results of 
operations for any future periods.

We  have  made,  and  will  continue  to  make,  various  forward-looking  statements  with  respect  to 
financial and business matters.  Comments regarding our business that are not historical facts are consid-
ered forward-looking statements that involve inherent risks and uncertainties.  Actual results may differ 
materially from those contained in these forward-looking statements.  For additional information regard-
ing our cautionary disclosures, see the “Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements” at the 
beginning of this report.

Company Overview

The  Company  is  a  Delaware  corporation  and  bank  holding  company  that  was  incorporated  in 
1996  and  began  operations  in  1997.  It  operates  principally  through  CresCom  Bank,  a  South  Carolina 
state-chartered bank. Crescent Mortgage Company and Carolina Service Corporation operate as a whol-
ly-owned subsidiaries of CresCom Bank. CresCom Bank provides a full range of commercial and retail 
banking financial services designed to meet the financial needs of our customers through its branch net-
work  in  South  Carolina  and  North  Carolina.  Crescent  Mortgage  Company,  headquartered  in  Atlanta, 
Georgia, is a wholesale mortgage company that provides mortgage banking services to over 45 states and 
has partnered with community banks, credit unions and mortgage brokers.

During 2014, we registered our common stock with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the 
“SEC”) and became a public reporting company and listed our common stock on the NASDAQ Capital 
Market under the ticker symbol “CARO”. We experienced strong organic loan and deposit growth and 
completed two branch acquisitions in contiguous markets that have more than doubled our branch net-
work. In addition, the Company added a branch in the Charleston market and a branch in the  Myrtle Beach 
market along with two loan production offices, one each in Greenville, South Carolina and  Wilmington, 
North Carolina.

54

Like most community banks, we derive a significant portion of our income from interest we re-
ceive on our loans and investments. Our primary source of funds for making these loans and investments is 
our deposits, both interest-bearing and noninterest-bearing. Consequently, one of the key measures of our 
success is our amount of net interest income, or the difference between the income on our interest-earning 
assets, such as loans and investments, and the expense on our interest-bearing liabilities, such as deposits 
and	borrowed	funds.	In	order	to	maximize	our	net	interest	income,	we	must	not	only	manage	the	volume	
of these balance sheet items, but also the yields that we earn on our interest-earning assets and the rates 
that we pay on interest-bearing liabilities.

There are risks inherent in all loans, so we maintain an allowance for loan losses to absorb prob-
able losses on existing loans that may become uncollectible. We establish and maintain this allowance by 
charging a provision for loan losses against our operating earnings.

In addition to earning interest on our loans and investments, we derive a portion of our income 
from Crescent Mortgage Company through mortgage banking income as well as servicing income. We also 
earn income through fees that we charge to our customers. Likewise, we incur other operating expenses 
as well.

Economic conditions, competition, and the monetary and fiscal policies of the federal government 
significantly affect most financial institutions, including the Bank. Lending and deposit activities and fee 
income	generation	are	influenced	by	levels	of	business	spending	and	investment,	consumer	income,	con-
sumer spending and savings, capital market activities, and competition among financial institutions as well 
as client preferences, interest rate conditions and prevailing market rates on competing products in our 
market areas.

Executive Summary of Operating Results

At December 31, 2015, our total assets were $1.4 billion, an increase of $210.7 million, from total 
assets of $1.2 billion at December 31, 2014. The largest components of our total assets are loans receiv-
able, net and securities which were $912.6 million and $323.5 million, respectively at December 31, 2015. 
Comparatively, our loans receivable and securities totaled $768.1 million and $277.2 million, respectively, 
at December 31, 2014. At December 31, 2015 loans held for sale were $41.8 million compared to $40.9 
million as of December 31, 2014. Our liabilities and stockholders’ equity at December 31, 2015 totaled $1.3 
billion and $139.9 million, respectively, compared to liabilities of $1.1 billion and stockholders’ equity of 
$93.7 million at December 31, 2014. The principal components of our liabilities are deposits which were 
$1.0 billion and $964.2 million at December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. The increase in total assets 
and deposits during 2015 primarily related strong organic growth during the current year.

The  Company  reported  net  income  available  to  common  stockholders  of  approximately  $14.4 
million, or $1.48 per diluted share, for the year ended December 31, 2015, compared to $8.3 million, or 
$0.87 per diluted share for the year ended December 31, 2014. Our 2014 results include pretax acquisition 
related expenses associated with branch acquisitions of $1.4 million. The increase in net income from pe-
riod to period is attributable to the significant growth in loans and securities, increased checking fees, and 
improved results from the Company’s retail mortgage team and Crescent Mortgage Company.

Asset quality remained steady, with nonperforming assets to total assets of 0.47% as of December 
31, 2015 and 2014. Nonperforming loans were $4.3 million as of December 31, 2015 as compared to $2.4 
million at December 31, 2014.

55

2015 Form 10-KThe  allowance  for  loan  losses  was  $10.1  million,  or  1.10%  of  total  loans  (1.18%  of  total  non- 
acquired loans), at December 31, 2015, compared to $9.0 million, or 1.16% of total loans (1.28% of to-
tal non-acquired loans) at December 31, 2014. The Company experienced net recoveries of $1.1 million 
during  2015  compared  to  net  recoveries  of  $944,000  during  2014.  No  provision  expense  was  recorded 
during 2015 or 2014 due to the sustained low level of NPAs as well as the net recoveries experienced.

At	 December	 31,	 2015,	 the	 Company’s	 capital	 ratios	 exceeded	 “well	 capitalized”	 levels	 under	
applicable law. Stockholders’ equity totaled $139.9 million as of December 31, 2015, compared to $93.7 
million at December 31, 2014. On December 14, 2015, the Company closed a public offering of 2,262,296 
shares of its common stock with net proceeds of approximately $32.1 million after deducting underwriting 
discounts, commissions and offering expenses incurred by the Company.

Critical Accounting Policies

We have adopted various accounting policies that govern the application of accounting principles 
generally  accepted  in  the  United  States  and  with  general  practices  within  the  banking  industry  in  the 
preparation  of  our  financial  statements.  Our  significant  accounting  policies  are  described  in  the  notes 
to our consolidated financial statements within Item 8 “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” 
elsewhere in this report.

Certain accounting policies involve significant judgments and assumptions by us that have a mate-
rial impact on the carrying value of certain assets and liabilities. We consider these accounting policies to 
be critical accounting policies. The judgment and assumptions we use are based on historical experience 
and other factors, which we believe to be reasonable under the circumstances. Because of the nature of the 
judgment and assumptions we make, actual results could differ from these judgments and estimates that 
could have a material impact on the carrying values of our assets and liabilities and our results of opera-
tions. Management has reviewed and approved these critical accounting policies and discussed them with 
the audit committee of the Board of Directors.

Allowance  for  Loan  Losses.  The  allowance  for  loan  losses  is  the  critical  accounting  policy  that 
requires the most significant judgment  and estimates used in preparation of our  consolidated  financial 
statements. Some of the more critical judgments supporting the amount of our allowance for loan losses 
include judgments about the credit worthiness of borrowers, the estimated value of the underlying collat-
eral,	the	assumptions	about	cash	flow,	determination	of	loss	factors	for	estimating	credit	losses,	the	impact	
of current events, and conditions, and other factors impacting the level of probable inherent losses. Under 
different conditions or using different assumptions, the actual amount of credit losses incurred by us may 
be different from management’s estimates provided in our consolidated financial statements. Refer to the 
portion of this discussion that addresses our allowance for loan losses for a more complete discussion of 
our processes and methodology for determining our allowance for loan losses.

Other-Than Temporary Impairment. The evaluation and recognition of other-than-temporary im-
pairment,  or  OTTI,  on  certain  investments  including  our  private  label  mortgage-backed  securities  and 
trust preferred securities requires significant judgment and estimates. Some of the more critical judgments 
supporting	the	evaluation	of	OTTI	include	projected	cash	flows	including	prepayment	assumptions,	de-
fault rates and severities of losses on the underlying collateral within the security. Under different condi-
tions	or	utilizing	different	assumptions,	the	actual	OTTI	realized	by	us	may	be	different	from	the	actual	
amounts	 recognized	 in	 our	 consolidated	 financial	 statements.	 See	 Note	 4	 to	 the	 consolidated	 financial	
statements to within Item 8 “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” for the disclosure of certain 
assumptions used in the financial statements during the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014.

56

Derivatives. The determination of fair value related to derivatives of the Company requires signifi-
cant judgment and estimates. The primary uses of derivative instruments are related to the mortgage banking 
activities of the Company. As such, the Company holds derivative instruments, which consist of rate lock 
agreements related to expected funding of fixed-rate mortgage loans to customers (“interest rate lock com-
mitments”) and forward commitments to sell mortgage-backed securities and individual fixed-rate mortgage 
loans (“forward commitments”). The Company’s objective in obtaining the forward commitments is to miti-
gate the interest rate risk associated with the interest rate lock commitments and the mortgage loans that are 
held for sale. Derivatives related to these commitments are recorded as either a derivative asset or a deriva-
tive liability in the balance sheet and are measured at fair value. Both the interest rate lock commitments and 
the forward commitments are reported at fair value, with adjustments recorded in current period earnings in 
mortgage banking within noninterest income section of the consolidated statements of operations. Deriva-
tive instruments not related to mortgage banking activities primarily relate to interest rate swap agreements.

For additional discussion related to the determination of fair value related to derivative instru-
ments, see Note 5 to the consolidated financial statements within Item 8 “Financial Statements and Sup-
plementary Data.”

Mortgage Repurchase Reserve. The establishment of the mortgage repurchases reserves related to var-
ious representations and warranties related to mortgages sold in the secondary market. Management’s esti-
mate of losses require significant judgment and estimates. Some of the more critical factors are  incorporated 
into  the  estimation  of  the  mortgage  repurchase  reserve  include  the  defects  on  internal  quality  assurance, 
default  expectations,  historical  investor  repurchase  demand  and  appeals  success  rates,  reimbursement  by 
correspondent and other third party originators, changes in regulatory repurchase framework, and projected 
loss severity. The Company establishes a reserve at the time loans are sold and continually updates the reserve 
estimate during the estimated loan life. To the extent that economic conditions and the housing market do 
not recover or future investor repurchase demand and appeals success rates differ from past experience, the 
Company could continue to have increased demands and increased loss severities on repurchases, causing fu-
ture additions to the repurchase reserve. Refer to the “Mortgage Operations” below for additional discussion.

Income Taxes. Income taxes are provided for the tax effects of the transactions reported in our con-
solidated financial statements and consist of taxes currently due plus deferred taxes related to differences 
between the tax basis and accounting basis of certain assets and liabilities, including available for sale se-
curities, allowance for credit losses, writedowns of real estate acquired in settlement of loans, accumulated 
depreciation, net operating loss carry forwards, mortgage servicing rights and other intangible assets. The 
deferred tax assets and liabilities represent the future tax return consequences of those differences, which 
will either be taxable or deductible when the assets and liabilities are recovered or settled. Deferred tax as-
sets	and	liabilities	are	reflected	at	income	tax	rates	applicable	to	the	period	in	which	the	deferred	tax	assets	
or	liabilities	are	expected	to	be	realized	or	settled.	A	valuation	allowance	is	recorded	in	situations	where	it	is	
“more	likely	than	not”	that	a	deferred	tax	asset	is	not	realizable.	As	changes	in	tax	laws	or	rates	are	enacted,	
deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted through the provision for income taxes. We file a consolidated 
federal income tax return for the Company and the Bank. In addition, we evaluate the need for income tax 
reserves related to uncertain income tax positions but had no such reserves at December 31, 2015 or 2014.

Business Combinations. The Company accounts for its acquisitions under ASC Topic 805, Business 
Combinations, which requires the use of the acquisition method of accounting. All identifiable assets ac-
quired, including loans, are recorded at fair value. No allowance for loan losses related to the acquired 
loans is recorded on the acquisition date because the fair value of the loans acquired incorporates assump-
tions regarding credit risk. As provided for under GAAP, management has up to twelve months following 
the	date	of	the	acquisition	to	finalize	the	fair	values	of	acquired	assets	and	assumed	liabilities.	Once	man-

57

2015 Form 10-Kagement	has	finalized	the	fair	values	of	acquired	assets	and	assumed	liabilities	within	this	twelve	month	
period, management considers such values to be the day 1 fair values (“Day 1 Fair Values”).

Recent Accounting Standards and Pronouncements

For information relating to recent accounting standards and pronouncements, see Note 1 to the 
audited consolidated financial statements within Item 8 “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.”

Results of Operations

Summary

The  Company  reported  net  income  available  to  common  stockholders  of  approximately  $14.4 
million, or $1.48 per diluted share, for the year ended December 31, 2015, compared to $8.3 million, or 
$0.87 per diluted share for the year ended December 31, 2014. Our 2014 results include pretax acquisition 
related expenses associated with branch acquisitions of $1.4 million. The increase in net income from pe-
riod to period is attributable to the significant growth in loans and securities, increased checking fees, and 
improved results from the Company’s retail mortgage team and Crescent Mortgage Company.

Details of the changes in the various components of net income are further discussed below.

Net Interest Income and Margin

Net interest income is a significant component of our net income. Net interest income is the differ-
ence between income earned on interest-earning assets and interest paid on deposits and borrowings. Net 
interest income is determined by the yields earned on interest-earning assets, rates paid on interest-bearing 
liabilities, the relative balances of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, the degree of mis-
match, and the maturity and repricing characteristics of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities.

For the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, our net interest income was $43.0 million and 
$32.1 million, respectively. The $10.9 million, or 34.1%, increase in net interest income during 2015 was 
related to several factors including an increase in average earnings assets balances as well as a decrease in 
rates paid on interest-bearing liabilities and a shift to lower cost of funding. Included in interest income 
for	loans	for	the	years	ended	December	31,	2014	was	$793,000	of	nonaccrual	interest	recognized	related	
to the resolution of nonperforming loan that paid off during the fourth quarter.

The	Company	is	focused	on	continuing	to	improve	the	utilization	of	its	capital.	To	accomplish	this,	
the Bank has incorporated various strategies to increase the loan and securities portfolio. Accordingly, 
the increase in average earnings assets for the year ended December 31, 2015, is primarily the result of 
increased balances of loans receivable and securities.

The growth in average loan balances was primarily the result of the following:

• 

 Residential mortgage – In addition to selling a portion of its production, the Company has 
retained a portion of the mortgage production. Due to the emphasis to grow the  residential 
mortgage  portfolio,  gross  loans  receivable  within  the  one-to-four  family  portfolio  have  in-
creased  $90.9  million  since  December  31,  2014.  This  growth  includes  the  purchase  of  a 
non-conforming  residential  loan  pool  during  the  fourth  quarter  of  2015  with  a  balance  of 
$36.6 million as of December 31, 2015.

58

• 

• 

 Commercial  lending  –  during  2014  and  2015,  the  Company  expanded  its  commercial 
lending team by hiring additional loan officers in its Charleston and Myrtle Beach mar-
kets  of  South  Carolina.  The  Company  also  has  opened  its  first  branch  in  the  upstate  of 
South  Carolina,  and  a  loan  production  office  in  Wilmington,  North  Carolina.  As  a  re-
sult,  gross  loans  receivable  within  commercial  real  estate  increased  $24.5  million  since  
December 31, 2014.

 Syndicated loans – The Charleston and Myrtle Beach markets of South Carolina have pro-
vided limited opportunities for the Bank to develop a Commercial and Industrial (“C&I”) 
loan  portfolio.  The  Company’s  primary  markets  are  generally  concentrated  in  real  estate 
lending.  However,  in  order  to  diversify  our  lending  portfolio,  the  Company  began  a  syn-
dicated loan program in 2014 to purchase C&I loans to retain in the loan portfolio. These 
loans	typically	have	terms	of	seven	years	and	are	tied	to	a	floating	rate	index	such	as	LIBOR	
or prime. To effectively manage this new line of lending, the Company hired an experienced 
senior lending executive in 2014 with relevant experience to lead and manage this area of the 
loan	portfolio	and	retained	a	consulting	firm	that	specializes	in	syndicated	loans.	Syndicat-
ed loans have grown $32.9 million since December 31, 2014. As of December 31, 2015, the 
syndicated loan portfolio outstanding was $83.1 million and is grouped within commercial 
business loans. The Company’s policy currently limits the syndicated loan portfolio not to 
exceed 75% of the Bank’s Tier 1 regulatory capital. As of December 31, 2015, the Moody’s 
weighted  average  credit  facility  rating  of  the  syndicated  loan  portfolio  was  Ba2,  with  no 
credit rated less than B2.

The growth in securities is a result of the Company’s continued effort to deploy capital into earn-

ing assets as we grow the balance sheet.

The  decrease  in  rates  paid  on  interest-bearing  liabilities  is  based  on  the  continued  historical-
ly low interest rates that have positively impacted our ability to reduce funding cost and an increase in 
average balances of checking, savings and money markets, which typically yield less than other forms of 
interest-bearing accounts. The increase in the average balance of deposits is primarily due to the deposits 
acquired in a branch acquisition completed in December of 2014 where the Company assumed approxi-
mately $152.8 million of checking, savings, and money markets.

Short term borrowings increased period over period as a result of the rise in mortgage production 
as	well	as	the	growth	in	loans	and	securities	during	2015.	Syndicated	loans	as	well	as	collateralized	loan	
obligations	securities,	which	are	typically	tied	to	floating	rate	indexes,	have	grown	$32.9	million	and	$12.9	
million, respectively, since December 31, 2014.

The following table sets forth information related to our average balance sheet, average yields on 
assets, and average costs of liabilities for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013. We derived 
these yields or costs by dividing income or expense by the average balance of the corresponding assets or 
liabilities. We derived average balances from the daily balances throughout the periods indicated. During 
the same periods, we had no securities purchased with agreements to resell. All investments were owned 
at an original maturity of over one year. Nonaccrual loans are included in earning assets in the following 
tables.	Loan	yields	have	been	reduced	to	reflect	the	negative	impact	on	our	earnings	of	loans	on	nonac-
crual	status.	The	net	capitalized	loan	costs	and	fees,	which	are	considered	immaterial,	are	amortized	into	
interest income on loans.

59

2015 Form 10-KFor The Years Ended December 31,

2015

Interest
Paid/
Earned

Average
Balance

Average
Yield/
Rate

Average
Balance

2014

Interest
Paid/
Earned

Average
Yield/
Rate

Average
Balance

2013

Interest
Paid/
Earned

Average
Yield/
Rate

(Dollars in thousands)

Interest-earning assets:

Loans held for sale

Loans receivable (1)

Interest-bearing cash

  $

38,536 

    1,472     

3.82%    31,563 

    1,253     

3.92%     72,975 

    2,696     

3.69%

827,787 

    39,548     

4.78%    613,144 

    30,064     

4.90%     509,455 

    25,035     

4.91%

14,362 

36     

0.25%    22,988 

55     

0.24%     43,151 

107     

0.25%

Securities available for sale

286,812 

    7,621     

2.62%    206,977 

    5,199     

2.51%     170,061 

    4,662     

2.74%

Securities held to maturity

Federal Home Loan Bank stock   

Other investments

19,513 

7,684 

3,448 

555     

2.84%    24,314 

884     

3.64%     11,428 

292     

2.56%

328     

4.27%   

4,939 

158     

3.20%    

4,221 

111     

2.63%

44     

1.28%   

1,938 

43     

2.22%    

1,872 

45     

2.40%

Total interest-earning assets

    1,198,142 

    49,604     

4.14%    905,863 

    37,656     

4.16%     813,163 

    32,948     

4.05%

Non-earning assets

105,260 

Total assets

  $1,303,402 

    84,910 

    990,773 

    76,688 

    889,851 

Interest-bearing liabilities:

Demand accounts

Money market accounts

Savings accounts

163,982 

235,283 

38,303 

199     

0.12%    114,867 

179     

0.16%     56,405 

115     

0.20%

457     

0.19%    213,149 

473     

0.22%     213,924 

857     

0.40%

50     

0.13%    24,617 

38     

0.15%     14,387 

46     

0.32%

Certificates of deposit

395,131 

    3,661     

0.93%    311,246 

    2,793     

0.90%     302,999 

    2,321     

0.77%

Short-term borrowed funds

113,968 

331     

0.29%    41,324 

106     

0.26%     22,335 

239     

1.07%

Long-term debt

57,380 

    1,906     

3.32%    68,620 

    2,013     

2.93%     75,595 

    2,140     

2.83%

Total interest-bearing liabilities    1,004,047 

    6,604     

0.66%    773,823 

    5,602     

0.72%     685,645 

    5,718     

0.83%

Noninterest-bearing deposits    

179,960 

Other liabilities

Stockholders’ equity

17,499 

101,896 

    113,743 

    14,733 

    88,474 

    109,069 

    18,815 

    76,322 

Total liabilities and

Stockholders’ equity

  $1,303,402 

    990,773 

    889,851 

Net interest spread

Net interest margin

Net interest margin (tax 

equivalent) (2)

Net interest income

3.59%    

3.68%    

3.48%   

3.44%    

3.22%

3.54%   

3.35%   

3.62%   

3.41%   

    43,000     

    32,054     

    27,230     

(1) 
(2)	

Average balances of loans include nonaccrual loans.
The	tax	equivalent	net	interest	margin	reflects	tax-exempt	income	on	a	tax-equivalent	basis.

60

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
 
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
 
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
 
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
 
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
 
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
Our net interest margin was 3.59%, and 3.68% on a tax equivalent basis, for the twelve months 
ended December 31, 2015 compared to 3.54%, and 3.62% on a tax equivalent basis, for 2014. The 5 basis 
point increase in net interest margin during 2014 as compared to the prior year was driven primarily by the 
6 basis point decrease in the contract rate paid on in interest bearing liabilities.

Our average interest-earning assets increased by $292.3 million during 2015 and our interest in-
come increased $11.9 million. As previously stated, the increase in interest income is primarily related to 
the increase in loans receivable and securities during 2015.

Our  interest  expense  increased  $1.0  million  during  2015  as  compared  to  the  year  ended  2014 
while our average interest-bearing liabilities increased $230.2 million. The increase in interest expense is 
primarily related to the growth in average balance of deposits from the branch acquisition completed in 
the fourth quarter of 2014 and being outstanding for all of 2015.

Our net interest spread was 3.48% for the year ended December 31, 2015 as compared to 3.44% 
for the same period in 2014. The net interest spread is the difference between the yield we earn on our 
interest-earning assets and the rate we pay on our interest-bearing liabilities. The 6 basis point reduction in 
rate on our interest-bearing liabilities offset by the 2 basis point decline on yield of interest-earning assets, 
resulted in a 4 basis point increase in our net interest spread for the 2014 period.

Rate/Volume Analysis

Net	interest	income	can	be	analyzed	in	terms	of	the	impact	of	changing	interest	rates	and	chang-
ing  volume.  The  following  tables  set  forth  the  effect  which  the  varying  levels  of  interest-earning  assets 
and interest-bearing liabilities and the applicable rates have had on changes in net interest income for the 
periods presented.

For The Years Ended December 31,

2015 vs. 2014

2014 vs. 2013

Increase (decrease) 
due to

Volume  

Rate

Net 
Dollar
    Volume     Change     Volume    

Increase (decrease) 
due to

Rate/

    Rate/

Net 
Dollar

Rate

    Volume     Change  

87     
(66)   
(2)   
(475)   
263     
28     
(4)   
(169)   

(55)   
(381)   
(41)   
409     
(336)   
70     
(334)   

114     
11     
(2)   
85     
(139)   
(4)   
—     
65     

28     
(1)   
17     
(11)   
154     
8     
195     

(1,443)
5,029 
(52)
537 
593 
47 
(3)
4,708 

64 
(384)
(8)
472 
(133)
(127)
(116)
4,824 

Loans held for sale
Loans receivable, net
Interest-bearing cash
Securities available for sale
Securities held to maturity
FHLB stock
Other investments
  Interest income

Demand accounts
Money market accounts
Savings accounts
Certificates of deposit
Short-term borrowed funds
Long-term debt
  Interest expense
Net interest income

  $

  $

266 
10,255 

(22)  

2,121 
(137)  
117 
19 
12,619 

60 
43 
18 
777 
211 
(373)  
736 

(58)   
(1,040)   
2     
417     
(154)   
82     
(33)   
(784)   

(57)   
(65)   
(9)   
115     
39     
223     
246     

11     
269     
1     
(116)   
(38)   
(29)   
15     
113     

17     
6     
3     
(24)   
(25)   
43     
20     

(In thousands)
219     
9,484     
(19)   
2,422     
(329)   
170     
1     
11,948     

(1,644)  
5,084   
(48)  
927   
469   
23   
1   
4,812   

20     
(16)   
12     
868     
225     
(107)   
1,002     
10,946     

91   
(2)  
16   
74   
49   
(205)  
23   

61

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
       
       
       
     
 
       
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
       
       
     
 
       
       
Provision for Loan Loss

We have established an allowance for loan losses through a provision for loan losses charged as 
an expense on our statements of operations. We review our loan portfolio periodically to evaluate our out-
standing loans and to measure both the performance of the portfolio and the adequacy of the allowance 
for loan losses. Please see the discussion below under “Allowance for Loan Losses” for a description of 
the factors we consider in determining the amount of the provision we expense each period to maintain 
this allowance.

Following  is  a  summary  of  the  activity  in  the  allowance  for  loan  losses  during  the  years  ended 

December 31, 2015 and 2014.

For the Years 
Ended December 31,

2015
2014
(Dollars in thousands)

Balance, beginning of period
  Provision for loan losses
  Loan charge-offs
  Loan recoveries
Balance, end of period

$

$

9,035   
—   
(1,230)  
2,336   
10,141   

8,091 
— 
(363)
1,307 
9,035 

For the year ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, there was no provision for loan loss recorded 
primarily due to the net recoveries experienced. The Company experienced net recoveries of $1.1 million 
during 2015 compared to net recoveries of $944,000 during 2014. The allowance for loan losses was $10.1 
million, or 1.10% of total loans (1.18% of total non-acquired loans), at December 31, 2015, compared to 
$9.0 million, or 1.16% of total loans (1.28% of total non-acquired loans) at December 31, 2014.

Provision expense is recorded based on our assessment of general loan loss risk as well as asset 
quality. The allowance for loan losses is management’s estimate of probable credit losses inherent in the 
loan portfolio at the balance sheet date. Management determines the allowance based on an ongoing eval-
uation. Estimating the amount of the allowance for loan losses requires significant judgment and the use 
of	estimates	related	to	the	amount	and	timing	of	expected	future	cash	flows	on	impaired	loans,	estimated	
losses on non-impaired loans based on historical loss experience, and consideration of current economic 
trends and conditions, all of which may be susceptible to significant change. For further discussion regard-
ing the calculation of the allowance, see the “Allowance for Loan Losses” discussion below.

Noninterest Income and Expense

Noninterest income provides us with additional revenues that are significant sources of income. In 
2015 and 2014, noninterest income comprised 35.8% and 36.0%, respectively, of total interest and nonin-
terest income. The major components of noninterest income for the Company are listed below:

62

 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Noninterest income:

Mortgage banking income
Deposit service charges
Net loss on extinguishment of debt
Net gain on sale of securities
Fair value adjustments on interest rate swaps
Net gain on sale of servicing assets
Net increase in cash value life insurance
Mortgage loan servicing income
Other

Total noninterest income

For the Years
Ended December 31,

2015

2014

(In thousands)

$

$

17,417
3,496
(1,251)
1,493
(1,111)
—
726
5,313
1,596
27,679

11,908
2,065
(58)
1,084
(1,170)
775
731
5,077
736
21,148

Noninterest income increased $6.5 million to $ 27.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2015 
compared to $21.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2014. The increase in noninterest income 
primarily relates to the increase in mortgage banking income from our retail mortgage team as well as 
our wholesale mortgage banking subsidiary and an increase in deposit service charges during the period.

The increase in mortgage banking income is attributable to an increase in originations as well as 
overall margin expansion experienced during 2015. The following table provides a break out of mortgage 
banking income from our retail mortgage team “Community banking” and Crescent Mortgage Company 
“Wholesale mortgage banking”. Mortgage banking income consists primarily of gain on sale of loans and 
related fees as well as fair value changes in derivatives related to the mortgage company.

Additional segment information:
Community banking
Wholesale mortgage banking
Total mortgage banking income

For the Year Ended December, 31
Loan Originations    Mortgage Banking Income  

Margin

2015

2014   

2015

2014

   2015  

  2014  

  $

73,591     33,654  
986,650     948,550  
  $1,060,241     982,204  

1,656   
15,761   
17,417   

$

$

761  
11,147  
11,908  

  2.25%    2.26%
  1.60%    1.18%
  1.64%    1.21%

Originations for 2015 were comprised of approximately 65% in purchase transactions and 35% 
in refinance transactions. This compares to 70% originations from purchase transactions and 30% from 
refinance transactions for 2014.

Deposit service charge income increased $1.4 million to $3.5 million for the year ended December 
31, 2015 from $2.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2014. The increase in deposit service charge 
income is a result of the increase in deposits assumed as part of the two branch acquisitions completed 
during 2014 as well as the Company’s sustained efforts to grow checking accounts. The number of check-
ing accounts, excluding acquired accounts, have grown 11.1% since December 31, 2014.

For the year ended December 31, 2015, the Company incurred a $1.3 million loss on extinguish-
ment of debt as a result of the prepayment of a Federal Home Loan Bank borrowing. This compares to a 
loss on extinguishment of debt of $58,000 for the year ended December 31, 2014.

63

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
   
 
 
      
    
 
     
 
    
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Partially offsetting the overall increase in noninterest income for the year ended December 31, 
2015 was a decrease in the net gain on sale of servicing assets. During the first quarter of 2014, the Compa-
ny sold $147.7 million in unpaid principal balance of mortgage servicing rights for a net gain of $775,000. 
There were no servicing rights sold during 2015.

During	the	year	ended	December	31,	2015,	the	Company	recognized	net	gains	on	sale	of	avail-
able-for-sale securities of $1.5 million compared to gains on sale of securities during year ended December 
31, 2014 of $1.1 million.

The fair value adjustment on interest rate swaps reduced noninterest income by $1.1 million for 
the year ended December 31, 2015 compared to a reduction of non-interest income of $1.2 million for the 
year ended December 31, 2014. The change in fair value adjustment on interest rate swaps relates to the 
change in interest rates from period to period. The Company uses standalone interest rate swaps to more 
closely match the interest rate characteristics of assets and liabilities and to mitigate the risks arising from 
timing mismatches between assets and liabilities including duration mismatches.

Other noninterest income increased $860,000 to $1.6 million for the year ended December 31, 
2015 compared to $736,000 for the year ended December 31, 2014. The increase in other non-interest 
income is primarily related to in an increase in debit card and ATM surcharge income.

The following table sets forth for the periods indicated the primary components of noninterest 

expense:

Noninterest expense:

Salaries and employee benefits
Occupancy and equipment
Marketing and public relations
FDIC insurance
Recovery of mortgage loan repurchase losses
Legal expense
Other real estate expense, net
Mortgage subservicing expense
Amortization	of	mortgage	servicing	rights
Other

Total noninterest expense

For the Years
Ended December 31,

2015

2014

(In thousands)

$

$

28,629
7,228
1,434
698
(1,000)
407
138
1,634
1,986
8,045
49,199

23,308
4,858
1,251
581
(750)
438
638
1,392
1,795
7,932
41,443

Noninterest expense represents the largest expense category for the Company. Noninterest ex-
pense increased $7.8 million to $49.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2015 compared to $41.4 
million for the year ended December 31, 2014. The increase in noninterest expense for 2015 compared to 
the prior periods is primarily a result of the increase in salaries and employee benefits paid as well as the 
increase in expenses related to occupancy and equipment.

Included in non-interest expense for the period ended December 31, 2014 was approximately $1.4 
million  in  acquisition  related  expenses  of  which  $880,000  was  included  in  Other,  $90,000  was  included 

64

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Marketing and Public Relations, $242,000 was included in Occupancy and Equipment and $149,000 was 
included in Salaries and Employee Benefits.

Salaries and employee benefits increased $5.3 million to $28.6 million for the year ended Decem-
ber 31, 2015 compared to $23.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2014. Occupancy and equipment 
increased $2.4 million to $7.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2015 compared to $4.9 million for 
the year ended December 31, 2014.

The increase in salaries and employee benefits as well as occupancy and equipment from year to 
year are primarily a result of the personnel and occupancy costs associated with the acquisition of branch-
es completed during the fourth quarter of 2014. The company added approximately 72 employees and 
13 branches during 2014 as a result of this acquisitions. The expense associated with the acquisition of 
branches	were	reflective	all	of	2015.	In	addition,	the	Company	opened	three	branches	and	two	loan	pro-
duction offices during 2014 and a full service branch in the upstate of South Carolina during 2015.

Offsetting  the  increase  in  noninterest  expense  was  a  decline  in  expenses  associated  with  other 
real estate as well as a negative provision for mortgage loan repurchase losses. Other real estate expenses, 
net declined as a result of the reduction in other real estate balances and write-downs in 2015 compared 
to 2014. Other real estate balances were $2.4 million and $3.2 million as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, 
respectively. The Company was not required to write down other real estate owned during 2015 compared 
to write downs of $526,000 during 2014. The negative provision for mortgage loan repurchase losses is the 
result of continued low repurchase request as well as a change a change in the regulatory framework con-
cerning repurchase requests. For further discussion regarding the provision for mortgage loan repurchase 
losses, see the “Reserve For Mortgage Repurchase Losses” discussion below.

The increase in other noninterest expense primarily relates to general costs associated with the 
branches	acquired	during	2014	as	well	as	the	amortization	of	the	core	deposit	intangible	which	was	reflec-
tive for all of 2015.

Income Tax Expense

Our  effective  tax  rate  increased  to  32.9%  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2015  compared  to 
29.3% for the year ended December 31, 2014. The lower effective tax rate in 2014 is primarily attributable 
to higher proportion of tax-exempt municipal securities, bank-owned life insurance, and certain tax credits 
recognized	during	the	year	ended	2014	compared	to	the	year	ended	2015.

Balance Sheet Review

Investment Securities

Our  primary  objective  in  managing  the  investment  portfolio  is  to  maintain  a  portfolio  of  high 
quality, highly liquid investments yielding competitive returns. We are required under federal regulations 
to  maintain  adequate  liquidity  to  ensure  safe  and  sound  operations.  We  maintain  investment  balances 
based	on	a	continuing	assessment	of	cash	flows,	the	level	of	current	and	expected	loan	production,	current	
interest rate risk strategies and the assessment of the potential future direction of market interest rate 
changes. Investment securities differ in terms of default, interest rate, liquidity and expected rate of return 
risk.

65

2015 Form 10-KAt December 31, 2015, the $323.5 million in our investment securities portfolio, excluding FHLB 
stock and other investments, represented approximately 23.0% of our assets. Our available-for-sale invest-
ment portfolio included US agency securities, municipal securities, mortgage-backed securities (agency 
and	non-agency),	collateralized	loan	obligations	and	trust	preferred	securities	with	a	fair	value	of	$306.5	
million	and	an	amortized	cost	of	$306.0	million	for	an	unrealized	gain	of	$502,000.	Our	held-to-maturity	
portfolio included municipal securities with a fair value of $18.0 million and a cost of $17.1 million for an 
unrealized	gain	of	$912,000.

For additional information regarding the trust preferred securities see Note 4 “Securities” within 

Item 8. “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.”

As securities are purchased, they are designated as held-to-maturity or available-for-sale based 
upon our intent, which incorporates liquidity needs, interest rate expectations, asset/liability management 
strategies, and capital requirements. We do not currently hold, nor have we ever held, any securities that 
are designated as trading securities.

During 2015, the Company transferred trust preferred securities totaling $11.4 million to avail-
able-for-sale  from  held-to-maturity  as  a  result  of  the  implementation  of  the  regulatory  changes  in  risk 
weightings and capital deductions dictated by Basel III. The transfer was in accordance with ASC 320-10-
25-6; therefore, management has determined the transfer out of held-to-maturity is consistent with the 
original designation and does not taint the remaining portfolio.

The	amortized	costs	and	the	fair	value	of	our	investments	are	as	follows:

Securities available-for-sale:
Municipal securities
US government agencies
Collateralized	loan	obligations
Mortgage-backed securities:
  Agency
  Non-agency
  Total mortgage-backed securities
Trust preferred securities
  Total securities available-for-sale
Securities held-to-maturity:
Municipal securities
Trust preferred securities
  Total securities held-to-maturity

2015

At December 31,
2014

2013

  Amortized    
Cost

Fair
Value

    Amortized    
Cost

Fair
Value    

    Amortized    
Cost

Fair
Value  

(In thousands)

  $

60,603   
7,015   
38,957   

62,475   
7,096   
38,758   

43,119   
4,770   
25,883   

44,717   
4,748   
25,872   

39,790   
5,199   
—   

38,499 
5,175 
— 

112,608   
75,415   
188,023   
11,374   
305,972   

  113,855   
75,536   
  189,391   
8,754   
  306,474   

122,727   
49,936   
172,663   
—   
246,435   

  125,542   
50,838   
  176,380   
—   
  251,717   

68,813   
53,195   
122,008   

69,929 
53,932 
  123,861 

166,997   

  167,535 

17,053   
—   
17,053   

17,965   
—   
17,965   

16,787   
8,757   
25,544   

17,652   
9,733   
27,385   

15,488   
9,066   
24,554   

15,177 
8,370 
23,547 

  $

  $

  $

The Company uses prices from third party pricing services and, to a lesser extent, indicative (non-
binding) quotes from third party brokers, to estimate the fair value of our investment securities. While 
we obtain fair value information from multiple sources, we generally obtain one price / quote for each 
individual security. For securities priced by third party pricing services, we determine the most appropriate 
and relevant pricing service for each security class and have that vendor provide the price for each security 
in the class. We record the value provided by the third party pricing service / broker in our Consolidated 
Financial Statements, subject to our internal price verification procedures, which include periodic compar-
isons to other brokers and Bloomberg pricing screens.

66

 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
 
   
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
   
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Contractual maturities and yields on our investments are shown in the following table. Municipal 
yields were not tax effected in the table below. Expected maturities may differ from contractual maturities 
because issuers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penal-
ties. Securities available-for-sale are presented at fair value and held-to-maturity securities are presented 
at	amortized	cost.

  Less than 12 Months    One to Five Years 
  Amount     Yield     Amount     Yield  

At December 31, 2015
  Five to Ten Years 
  Amount    Yield  
(Dollars in thousands)

  Over Ten Years  
  Amount     Yield  

Total
  Amount   Yield 

  $

—     
—     

—     
—     

—      — 
—      — 

    9,420      2.31%    53,055      3.06%    62,475    2.95%
7,096    2.74%
    7,096      2.74%   

—      — 

—     

—     

—      — 

    13,153      2.08%    25,605      2.24%    38,758    2.18%

—     
—     

—     
—     

—     
—     

—     
—     

—      — 
269      3.76%   

    1,067      3.08%    112,788      2.49%   113,855    2.50%
   75,267      3.50%    75,536    3.50%

—      — 

269      3.76%    1,067      3.08%    188,055      2.90%   189,391    2.90%
8,754    2.49%
—      — 

8,754      2.49%   

—      — 

  $

  $

  $

—     

—     

269      3.76%    30,736      2.34%    275,469      2.84%   306,474    2.79%

—     

—     

430      2.14%    4,397      1.86%    12,226      3.51%    17,053    3.05%

—     

—     

430      2.14%    4,397      1.86%    12,226      3.51%    17,053    3.05%

Securities available-for-sale:
Municipal securities
US government agencies
Collateralized	loan	 

  obligations

Mortgage-backed securities:
  Agency
  Non-agency
  Total mortgage- 

  backed securities
Trust preferred securities
  Total securities  

  available-for-sale

Securities held-to-maturity:
Municipal securities
  Total securities  

  held-to- maturity

For disclosures related to the Company’s evaluation of securities for OTTI, see Note 4 “Securi-

ties” within Item 8. “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.”

Non-marketable investments are comprised of the following and are recorded at cost which ap-

proximates fair value since no readily available market exists for these securities.

At December 31,

2015

2014

Community Reinvestment Act fund
SBIC Investments
Investment in Statutory Business Trusts  

  $

Total other investments

(In thousands)
1,295   
1,513   
465   
3,273   

Federal Home Loan Bank stock
Non-marketable investments

  $

9,919   
13,192   

1,277 
567 
465 
2,309 

5,405 
7,714 

Loans by Type

Since loans typically provide higher interest yields than other types of interest-earning assets, a 
substantial percentage of our earning assets are invested in our loan portfolio. Before allowance for loan 
losses, loans outstanding at December 31, 2015 and 2014 were $922.7 million and $777.2 million, respec-
tively.

67

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
       
       
       
   
   
       
   
  
       
   
  
     
   
   
  
 
   
   
       
       
       
   
   
       
   
  
       
   
  
     
   
   
   
 
   
   
   
  
 
 
   
       
       
       
   
   
       
   
  
       
   
  
     
   
   
       
       
       
   
   
       
   
  
       
   
  
     
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
Our loan portfolio consists primarily of loans secured by real estate mortgages. As of December 
31, 2015, our loan portfolio included $801.1 million, or 86.8%, of total loans secured by real estate. As of 
December 31, 2014, our loan portfolio included $690.3 million, or 88.7%, of total loans secured by real es-
tate. Most of our real estate loans are secured by residential or commercial property. We obtain a security 
interest in real estate, in addition to any other available collateral. This collateral is taken to increase the 
likelihood of the ultimate repayment of the loan. Generally, we limit the loan-to-value ratio on loans to 
coincide with the appropriate regulatory guidelines. We attempt to maintain a relatively diversified loan 
portfolio to help reduce the risk inherent in concentration in certain types of collateral and business types. 
The Bank’s primary markets are generally concentrated in real estate lending. In order to diversify our 
lending portfolio, the Bank began a syndicated loan program during 2014. Syndicated loan balances were 
$83.1 and $50.2 million as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively, and are grouped within commer-
cial business loans in the table below

As shown in the table below, loans excluding the allowance for loan losses, increased $145.6 mil-
lion to $922.7 million at December 31, 2015 from $777.2 million at December 31, 2014. The increase in 
loans receivable primarily relates to the Bank’s focus on growing residential mortgage, commercial lend-
ing, and syndicated loans. See additional discussion regarding the increase in loans during 2014 in “Results 
of Operations – Net Interest Income and Margin”.

The	following	table	summarizes	loans	by	type	and	percent	of	total	at	the	end	of	the	periods	indi-

cated:

2015
   % of Total  
Loans

  Amount   

At December 31,
2014
    % of Total 

  Amount     Loans
  (Dollars in thousands) 

2013
    % of Total  
Loans

  Amount    

Loans secured by real estate:
  One-to-four family
  Home equity
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and development
Consumer loans
Commercial business loans
  Total gross loans receivable
Less:
  Allowance for loan losses
  Deferred fees, net
  Total loans receivable, net

 $ 343,686    
23,303    
   342,395    
91,713    
5,181    
   116,737    
   923,015    

10,141    
292    
 $ 912,582    

37.23%     252,819     
2.52%    
27,547     
37.10%     317,912     
9.94%    
92,008     
0.56%    
5,675     
12.65%    
82,305     
100.00%     778,266     

32.48%     183,736     
3.54%    
23,342     
40.85%     247,867     
60,104     
11.82%    
2,815     
0.73%    
10.58%    
25,546     
100.00%     543,410     

33.81%
4.30%
45.61%
11.06%
0.52%
4.70%
100.00%

9,035     
1,109     
    768,122     

8,091     
98     
    535,221     

68

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
  
      
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
  
  
  
  
      
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
  
   
   
   
   
   
  
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
2012

Amount

At December 31,

% of Total 
Loans
(Dollars in thousands)

Amount

2011

% of Total 
Loans

Loans secured by real estate:
  One-to-four family
  Home equity
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and development
Consumer loans
Commercial business loans
  Total gross loans receivable
Less:
  Allowance for loan losses
  Deferred fees, net
  Total loans receivable, net

  $

  $

146,329   
30,710   
236,230   
63,475   
3,501   
31,029   
511,274   

9,520   
63   
501,691   

28.62% 
6.01% 
46.20% 
12.42% 
0.68% 
6.07% 
100.00% 

124,595   
34,113   
245,949   
74,593   
4,845   
41,347   
525,442   

12,039   
68   
513,335   

Maturities and Sensitivity of Loans to Changes in Interest Rates

23.71%
6.49%
46.81%
14.20%
0.92%
7.87%
100.00%

The information in the following table is based on the contractual maturities of individual loans, 
including loans which may be subject to renewal at their contractual maturity. Renewal of such loans is 
subject to review and credit approval, as well as modification of terms upon maturity. Actual repayments 
of	loans	may	differ	from	the	maturities	reflected	below	because	borrowers	have	the	right	to	prepay	obliga-
tions with or without prepayment penalties.

The	following	table	summarizes	the	loan	maturity	distribution	by	type	and	related	interest	rate	

characteristics.

Loans secured by real estate:
  One-to-four family
  Home equity
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and development
Consumer loans
Commercial business loans
  Total gross loans receivable
Less:
  Deferred fees, net

  Total loans receivable

Loans maturing - after one year:
  Variable rate loans
  Fixed rate loans

One Year    
or Less

At December 31, 2015
After one
but within     After five    
five years

years

(In thousands)

Total

$

9,387     
4,156     
31,513     
17,620     
1,140     
11,967     
75,783     

45,788     
6,744     
249,177     
56,189     
3,265     
39,494     
400,657     

288,511     
12,403     
61,705     
17,904     
776     
65,276     
446,575     

343,686 
23,303 
342,395 
91,713 
5,181 
116,737 
923,015 

40     
75,743     

$

1,048     
399,609     

(796)    
447,371     

292 
922,723 

      $

      $

347,741 
499,239 
846,980 

69

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
       
       
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
       
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
       
       
   
 
 
       
       
       
   
 
 
       
       
 
 
       
       
       
 
 
 
       
       
Nonperforming and Problem Assets

Nonperforming assets include loans on which interest is not being accrued, accruing loans that 
are 90 days or more delinquent and foreclosed property. Foreclosed property consists of real estate and 
other assets acquired as a result of a borrower’s loan default. Generally, a loan is placed on nonaccrual 
status when it becomes 90 days past due as to principal or interest, or when we believe, after considering 
economic and business conditions and collection efforts, that the borrower’s financial condition is such 
that collection of the loan is doubtful. A payment of interest on a loan that is classified as nonaccrual is 
recognized	as	a	reduction	of	principal	when	received.	In	general,	a	nonaccrual	loan	may	be	placed	back	
onto accruing status once the borrower has made a minimum of six consecutive payments in accordance 
with the loan terms. Further, the borrower must show capacity to continue performing into the future prior 
to restoration of accrual status. As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, we had no loans 90 days past due and 
still accruing.

Troubled Debt Restructurings (“TDRs”)

The Company designates loan modifications as TDRs when, for economic or legal reasons relat-
ed to the borrower’s financial difficulties, it grants a concession to the borrower that it would not other-
wise consider. Loans on nonaccrual status at the date of modification are initially classified as nonaccrual 
TDRs. Loans on accruing status at the date of modification are initially classified as accruing TDRs at the 
date of modification, if the note is reasonably assured of repayment and performance is in accordance with 
its modified terms. Such loans may be designated as nonaccrual loans subsequent to the modification date 
if reasonable doubt exists as to the collection of interest or principal under the restructuring agreement. 
Nonaccrual TDRs are returned to accrual status when there is economic substance to the restructuring, 
there is well documented credit evaluation of the borrower’s financial condition, the remaining balance 
is reasonably assured of repayment in accordance with its modified terms, and the borrower has demon-
strated repayment performance in accordance with the modified terms for a reasonable period of time, 
generally a minimum of six months.

The	 following	 table	 summarizes	 nonperforming	 and	 problem	 assets	 at	 the	 end	 of	 the	 periods	

indicated.

At December 31,

2015    

2014    

2013    

2012    

2011  

(In thousands)

Loans receivable:
  Nonaccrual loans-renegotiated loans
  Nonaccrual loans-other
  Accruing loans 90 days or more delinquent
  Real estate acquired through foreclosure, net

  Total Non-Performing Assets

Problem Assets not included in Non-Performing 

  $

59     

58   
  4,243      2,376   
—   
  2,374      3,239   
  $ 6,676      5,673   

—     

  7,641      10,733      18,704 
  3,438      4,515      11,227 
—      4,231 
  6,273      6,284      6,097 
  17,352      21,532      40,259 

—     

Assets- Accruing renegotiated loans outstanding   $ 13,212      14,251   

  16,367      17,195      23,421 

At  December  31,  2015,  nonperforming  assets  were  $6.7  million,  or  0.47%  of  total  assets,  and 
nonperforming loans were $4.3 million, or 0.47 % of gross loans. Comparatively, at December 31, 2014, 
nonperforming  assets  were  $5.7  million,  or  0.47%  of  total  assets,  and  nonperforming  loans  were  $2.4 
million, or 0.31% of gross loans. Nonaccrual loans increased slightly to $4.3 million at December 31, 2015 

70

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
     
 
       
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
     
 
       
       
   
from $2.4 million at December 31, 2014 while real estate acquired through foreclosure decreased slightly 
to $2.4 million at December 31, 2015 from $3.2 million at December 31, 2014.

Potential problem loans, which are not included in nonperforming loans, amounted to approxi-
mately $13.2 million, or 1.43% of total gross loans at December 31, 2015, compared to $14.3 million, or 
1.83% of gross loans at December 31, 2014. Potential problem loans represent those loans with a well-de-
fined weakness and where information about possible credit problems of borrowers has caused manage-
ment to have serious doubts about the borrower’s ability to comply with present repayment terms.

Substantially all of the nonaccrual loans, accruing loans 90 days or more delinquent and accru-
ing	renegotiated	loans	for	fiscal	2015	and	2014	are	collateralized	by	real	estate.	The	Bank	utilizes	third	
party appraisers to determine the fair value of collateral dependent loans. Our current loan and appraisal 
policies require the Bank to obtain updated appraisals on an annual basis, either through a new external 
appraisal or an internal appraisal evaluation. Impaired loans are individually reviewed on a quarterly basis 
to determine the level of impairment. We typically charge-off a portion or create a specific reserve for 
impaired loans when we do not expect repayment to occur as agreed upon under the original terms of the 
loan agreement. Management believes based on information known and available currently, the probable 
losses related to problem assets are adequately reserved in the allowance for loan losses.

Credit quality indicators generally showed improvement during 2014 and continuing into 2015 as 
the Company experienced reduced loan migrations to nonaccrual status, and lower loss severity on indi-
vidual problem asset. The Company believes this general trend in reduced loans migrating into nonaccrual 
status is an indication of improving credit quality in the Company’s overall loan portfolio and a leading 
indicator of reduced credit losses going forward. Nevertheless, the Company can make no assurances that 
nonperforming assets will continue to improve in future periods. The Company continues to monitor the 
loan portfolio and foreclosed assets very carefully and is continually working to reduce its problem assets.

Allowance for Loan Losses

The allowance for loan losses is management’s estimate of probable credit losses inherent in the 
loan portfolio at the balance sheet date. Management determines the allowance based on an ongoing eval-
uation. Estimating the amount of the allowance for loan losses requires significant judgment and the use 
of	estimates	related	to	the	amount	and	timing	of	expected	future	cash	flows	on	impaired	loans,	estimated	
losses on non-impaired loans based on historical loss experience, and consideration of current economic 
trends  and  conditions,  all  of  which  may  be  susceptible  to  significant  change.  The  allowance  consists  of 
specific and general components.

The general component covers nonimpaired loans and is based on historical loss experience ad-
justed for current factors. The historical loss experience is determined by major loan category and is based 
on the actual loss history trends for the previous 20 quarters. The actual loss experience is supplemented 
with internal and external qualitative factors as considered necessary at each period and given the facts 
at	the	time.	These	qualitative	factors	adjust	the	20	quarter	historical	loss	rate	to	recognize	the	most	re-
cent loss results and changes in the economic conditions to ensure the estimated losses in the portfolio 
are	recognized	in	the	period	incurred	and	that	the	allowance	at	each	balance	sheet	date	is	adequate	and	
appropriate in accordance with GAAP. Qualitative factors include consideration of the following: levels 
of and trends in delinquencies and impaired loans; levels of and trends in charge-offs and recoveries for 
the most recent twelve quarters; trends in volume and terms of loans; effects of any changes in risk selec-
tion and underwriting standards; other changes in lending policies, procedures, and practices; experience, 

71

2015 Form 10-Kability, and depth of lending management and other relevant staff; national and local economic trends and 
conditions; industry conditions; and effects of changes in credit concentrations.

The specific component relates to loans that are individually classified as impaired when, based 
on current information and events, it is probable that the Company will be unable to collect all amounts 
due according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement. These analyses involve a high degree of 
judgment in estimating the amount of loss associated with specific loans, including estimating the amount 
and	timing	of	future	cash	flows	and	collateral	values.	Impaired	loans	are	evaluated	for	impairment	using	
the	discounted	cash	flow	methodology	or	based	on	the	net	realizable	value	of	the	underlying	collateral.	
Impaired loans are individually reviewed on a quarterly basis to determine the level of impairment. See 
additional discussion in section “Nonperforming and Problem Assets” above.

While management uses the best information available to establish the allowance for loan losses, 
future adjustments to the allowance may be necessary if economic conditions differ substantially from the 
assumptions used in making the valuations or, if required by regulators, based upon information available 
to them at the time of their examinations. Such adjustments to original estimates, as necessary, are made 
in the period in which these factors and other relevant considerations indicate that loss levels may vary 
from previous estimates. To the extent actual outcomes differ from management’s estimates, additional 
provisions for loan losses could be required that could adversely affect the Bank’s earnings or financial 
position in future periods.

The allowance for loan losses was $10.1 million, or 1.10% of total loans (1.18% of total non-ac-
quired loans), at December 31, 2015, compared to $9.0 million, or 1.16% of total loans (1.28% of total 
non-acquired  loans)  at  December  31,  2014.  Loans  remaining  in  the  portfolio  from  branch  acquisitions 
were $64.1 and $80.2 million at December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. No allowance for loan losses re-
lated to the acquired loans is recorded on the acquisition date because the fair value of the loans acquired 
incorporates assumptions regarding credit risk.

The Company experienced net recoveries of $1.1 million and $944,000 for the year ended Decem-
ber 31, 2015 and 2014. Asset quality has remained relatively consistent with nonperforming assets to total 
assets of 0.47% as of December 31, 2015 and 2014. No provision expense was recorded during 2015 or 
2014 primarily due to the net recoveries experienced. See Note 6 to the Consolidated Financial Statements 
for more information on our allowance for loan losses.

72

The	following	table	summarizes	the	activity	related	to	our	allowance	for	loan	losses	for	the	five	

years ended December 31, 2015.

Balance, beginning of period
Provision for loan losses
Loan charge-offs:
  Loans secured by real  

  estate:
  One-to-four family
  Home equity
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and  
  development

  Consumer loans
  Commercial business loans
  Total loan charge-offs

Loan recoveries:
  Loans secured by real estate:

  One-to-four family
  Home equity
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and  
  development

  Consumer loans
  Commercial business loans
  Total loan recoveries

  Net loan recoveries  

  (charge-offs)
Balance, end of period

Allowance for loan losses as a  

 percentage of loans receivable 
(end of period)

Net (recoveries) charge-offs to  
  average loans receivable

For the Years Ended December 31,

2015

2014  

2013  

2012  

2011  

(Dollars in thousands)

  $

9,035 
— 

8,091 
— 

9,520 
(860)

    12,039 
2,707 

    14,263 
    10,735 

(1,050)
— 
— 

(90)
(20)
(70)
(1,230)

576 
150 
350 

479 
38 
743 
2,336 

1,106 
  $ 10,141 

(80)
— 
(28)

(172)
(24)
(59)
(363)

158 
— 
100 

457 
71 
521 
1,307 

944 
9,035 

(168)
(28)
(269)

(765)
(35)
(410)
(1,675)

438 
1 
126 

110 
53 
378 
1,106 

(569)
8,091 

(2,680)
(319)
(1,432)

(1,506)
(84)
(1,169)
(7,190)

(3,837)
(211)
(3,548)

(6,043)
(221)
(929)
    (14,789)

375 
— 
231 

740 
172 
446 
1,964 

764 
— 
182 

203 
41 
640 
1,830 

(5,226)
9,520 

    (12,959)
    12,039 

1.10%    

1.16%    

1.49%    

1.86%    

2.29%

(0.13)%    

(0.15)%    

0.11%    

1.05%    

2.38%

73

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
The	 following	 table	 summarizes	 an	 allocation	 of	 the	 allowance	 for	 loan	 losses	 and	 the	 related	

percentage of loans outstanding in each category for the five years ended December 31, 2015.

At December 31,

2015

2014

2013

2012

2011

  Amount    %     Amount    %  

  Amount    %  

  Amount    %  

  Amount    %  

(Dollars in thousands)

Loans receivable:

  One-to-four family

  $ 2,903      37.23%    2,888      32.48%    2,472      33.81%    3,193      28.62%     3,978      23.71%

  Home equity

151     

2.52%   

221     

3.54%   

231     

4.30%   

276     

6.01%    

550     

6.49%

  Commercial real estate

3,402      37.10%    3,283      40.85%    2,855      45.61%    3,315      46.20%     3,283      46.81%

  Construction and  
  development

Consumer loans

1,138     

9.94%    1,069      11.82%    1,418      11.06%    1,792      12.42%     2,695      14.20%

27     

0.56%   

30     

0.73%   

42     

0.52%   

82     

0.68%    

210     

0.92%

Commercial business loans

2,100      12.65%    1,430      10.58%   

339     

4.70%   

862     

6.07%     1,323     

7.87%

Unallocated

Total

420      — 

114      — 

734      — 

—      — 

—      — 

  $ 10,141      100.00%    9,035      100.00%    8,091      100.00%    9,520      100.00%     12,039      100.00%

Mortgage Operations

Mortgage Activities and Servicing

Our mortgage banking operations are conducted through our wholesale mortgage subsidiary, 
Crescent Mortgage Company. Mortgage activities involve the purchase of mortgage loans and table 
funded originations for the purpose of generating gains on sales of loans and fee income on the origi-
nation of loans. While the Company originates residential one-to-four family loans that are held in its 
loan portfolio, the majority of new loans are generally sold pursuant to secondary market guidelines 
through our wholesale mortgage origination subsidiary, Crescent Mortgage Company. Generally, resi-
dential mortgage loans are sold and, depending on the pricing in the marketplace, servicing rights are 
either sold or retained. The level of loan sale activity and its contribution to the Company’s profitability 
depends on maintaining a sufficient volume of loan originations. Changes in the level of interest rates 
and the local economy affect the volume of loans originated by the Company and the amount of loan 
sales and loan fees earned. Discussion related to the impact and changes within the mortgage opera-
tions are provided in “Results of Operations” above. Additional segment information is provided in 
Note 21 “Supplemental Segment Information” to the consolidated financial statements included under 
Item 8.

Loan Servicing

We retain the rights to service loans we sell on the secondary market, as part of our mortgage 
banking activities, for which we receive service fee income. These rights are known as mortgage servicing 
rights, or MSRs, where the owner of the MSR acts on behalf of the mortgage loan owner and has the 
contractual	 right	 to	 receive	 a	 stream	 of	 cash	 flows	 in	 exchange	 for	 performing	 specified	 mortgage	 ser-
vicing functions. These duties typically include, but are not limited, to performing loan administration, 
collection, and default activities, including the collection and remittance of loan payments, responding to 
customer inquiries, accounting for principal and interest, holding custodial (impound) funds for the pay-
ment of property taxes and insurance premiums, counseling delinquent mortgagors, modifying loans and 

74

 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
       
 
     
       
   
   
       
 
     
       
 
     
       
 
 
   
   
 
   
   
   
 
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
   
   
   
   
   
supervising foreclosures and property dispositions. We subservice the duties and responsibilities obligated 
to the owner of the MSR to a third party provider for which we pay a fee.

At December 31, 2015, the Company was servicing $2.0 billion of loans for others, a slight increase 

from $1.9 billion at December 31, 2014.

We	recognize	the	rights	to	service	mortgage	loans	for	others	as	an	asset.	We	initially	record	the	
MSR	at	fair	value	and	subsequently	account	for	the	asset	at	lower	of	cost	or	market	using	the	amortization	
method.	Servicing	assets	are	amortized	in	proportion	to,	and	over	the	period	of,	the	estimated	net	ser-
vicing	income	and	are	carried	at	amortized	cost.	A	valuation	is	performed	by	an	independent	third	party	
on a quarterly basis to assess the servicing assets for impairment based on the fair value at each reporting 
date. The fair value of servicing assets is determined by calculating the present value of the estimated net 
future	cash	flows	consistent	with	contractually	specified	servicing	fees.	This	valuation	is	performed	on	a	
disaggregated basis, based on loan type and year of production. Generally, loan servicing becomes more 
valuable when interest rates rise (as prepayments typically decrease) and less valuable when interest rates 
decline (as prepayments typically increase). As discussed in detail in notes to the consolidated financial 
statements, we use an appropriate weighted average constant prepayment rate, discount rate, and other 
defined	assumptions	to	model	the	respective	cash	flows	and	determine	the	fair	value	of	the	servicing	asset	
at each reporting date. See Note 7 to the consolidated financial statements for further detail regarding 
the assumptions used in determining the economic estimated fair value of the mortgage servicing rights 
retained.

In aggregate, the net servicing asset had a balance of $11.4 million and $10.2 million at December 
31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. The economic estimated fair value of the mortgage servicing rights was 
$17.6 million and $15.7 million at December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

Below is a roll-forward of activity in the balance of the servicing assets for the years ended Decem-

ber 31, 2015 and 2014 respectively:

MSR beginning balance
	 Amount	capitalized
  Amount sold
	 Amount	amortized
MSR ending balance

Losses on Mortgage Loans Previously Sold

December 31,

2015

2014

(In thousands)

$

$

10,181 
3,238 
— 
(1,986)
11,433 

10,908 
1,868 
(800)
(1,795)
10,181 

Loans held for sale have primarily been fixed-rate single-family residential mortgage loans under 
contracts to be sold in the secondary market. In most cases, loans in this category are sold within 30 days 
of closing. Buyers generally have recourse to return a purchased loan to the Company under limited cir-
cumstances. An estimation of mortgage repurchase losses is reviewed on a quarterly basis. The represen-
tations and warranties in our loan sale agreements provide that we repurchase or indemnify the investors 
for  losses  or  costs  on  loans  we  sell  under  certain  limited  conditions.  Some  of  these  conditions  include 
underwriting errors or omissions, fraud or material misstatements by the borrower in the loan application 
or invalid market value on the collateral property due to deficiencies in the appraisal. In addition to these 

75

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
   
representations and warranties, our loan sale contracts define a condition in which the borrower defaults 
during a short period of time, typically 120 days to one year, as an early payment default, or EPD. In the 
event of an EPD, we are required to return the premium paid by the investor for the loan as well as certain 
administrative fees, and in some cases repurchase the loan or indemnify the investor. Because the level 
of mortgage loan repurchase losses depends upon economic factors, investor demand strategies and oth-
er external conditions that may change over the life of the underlying loans, the level of the liability for 
mortgage loan repurchase losses is difficult to estimate and requires considerable management judgment.

The following table demonstrates the activity for the mortgage repurchase reserve for the years 

ended December 31, 2015 and 2014:

Beginning Balance
  Losses paid
  Recoveries
  Provision for mortgage repurchase losses
Ending balance

December 31,

2015

2014

(In thousands)
4,999 
(165 )
42 
(1,000 )
3,876 

6,109 
(389)
29 
(750)
4,999 

$

$

For the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company recorded a negative provision 
for mortgage repurchase losses of $1.0 million and $750,000, respectively. The decline in the provision 
for mortgage loan repurchase losses is related to several factors. The Company sells mortgage loans to 
various  third  parties,  including  government-sponsored  entities  (“GSEs”),  under  contractual  provisions 
that  include  various  representations  and  warranties  as  previously  stated.  The  Company  establishes  the 
reserve for mortgage loan repurchase losses based on a combination of factors, including estimated levels 
of defects on internal quality assurance, default expectations, historical investor repurchase demand and 
appeals success rates, reimbursement by correspondent and other third party originators, and projected 
loss  severity.  Prior  to  2012,  there  was  no  expiration  date  related  to  representations  and  warranties  as 
long as the loan sold to the investor was outstanding. As a result, the Company received loan repurchase  
requests years after the loan was originated and sold to various third parties. In the latter part of 2012, the 
regulatory framework for certain GSEs changed where, under certain circumstances, the loan repurchase 
risk was limited for production beginning in January 2013. In addition, in May 2014, additional regulatory 
changes further limited loan repurchase risk. In addition, net losses paid have continued to decline from 
period to period. 

As a result of these factors, the Company performed an analysis of its reserve for mortgage loan 
repurchase losses and, based on management’s judgment and interpretation of such regulatory changes, 
reduced  the  reserve  accordingly.  Management  will  continue  to  monitor  how  the  GSEs  implement  the 
regulatory changes and trends. If such trends continue to be favorable, there is a possibility that additional 
reductions in this reserve could occur in future periods.

Deposits and Other Interest-Bearing Liabilities

We  provide  a  range  of  deposit  services,  including  noninterest-bearing  demand  accounts, 
 interest-bearing demand and savings accounts, money market accounts and time deposits. These accounts 
 generally pay interest at rates established by management based on competitive market factors and man-
agement’s desire to increase or decrease certain types or maturities of deposits. Deposits continue to be 

76

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
   
our primary funding source. At December 31, 2015 deposits totaled $1.0 billion, an increase of $67.3 mil-
lion from deposits of $964.2 million at December 31, 2014.

The Company established a deposit relationship with its mortgage subservicing provider whereby 
the subservicer deposited impound funds. As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, impound funds were $22.8 
million and $26.1 million at December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. These funds are included in inter-
est-bearing demand accounts within deposits.

Our retail deposits represented $882.9 million, or 85.6% of total deposits at December 31, 2015, 
while our out-of-market, or brokered deposits and institutional certificate of deposits, represented $148.6 
million, or 14.4% of our total deposits. At December 31, 2014, retail deposits represented $842.1 million, 
or 87.3% of total deposits at December 31, 2015, while our out-of-market, or brokered deposits and insti-
tutional certificate of deposits, represented $122.1 million, or 12.7% of our total deposits.

The following table shows the average balance amounts and the average rates paid on deposits 

held by us.

2015

   Average 
  Average    Yield/  
  Balance    Rate  

For the Years Ended December 31,
2014
    Average 
  Average     Yield/  
  Balance     Rate  
(Dollars in thousands)

2013

    Average 
  Average     Yield/  
  Balance     Rate  

Interest-bearing demand accounts
Money market accounts
Savings accounts
Certificates of deposit less than $100,000
Certificates of deposit of $100,000 or more
  Total interest-bearing average deposits

 $

163,982    
235,283    
38,303    
236,461    
158,670    

0.12%    114,867 
0.19%    213,149 
0.13%   24,617 
0.89%    211,128 
0.98%    100,118 

0.16%   56,405     
0.22%   213,924     
0.15%   14,387     
0.91%   210,029     
0.87%   92,970     

832,699    

0.52%    663,879 

0.52%   587,715     

0.20%
0.40%
0.32%
0.79%
0.71%

0.57%

Noninterest-bearing deposits
  Total average deposits

179,960    

 $ 1,012,659    

   113,743 

   777,622 

   109,069     

   696,784     

The maturity distribution of our time deposits of $100,000 or more is as follows:

At December 31,

2015

2014

(In thousands)

Three months or less
Over three through six months
Over six through twelve months
Over twelve months
  Total certificates of deposits

$

$

33,787  
31,895  
37,609  
88,028  
191,319  

24,245 
17,032 
18,655 
72,367 
132,299 

77

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
      
   
  
   
   
   
  
       
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
   
Borrowings and Other Interest-Bearing Liabilities

The following table outlines our various sources of borrowed funds during the years ended De-
cember 31, 2015, 2014, and 2013, and the amounts outstanding at the end of each period, the maximum 
amount for each component during the periods, the average amounts for each period, and the average 
interest rate that we paid for each borrowing source. The maximum month-end balance represents the 
high indebtedness for each component of borrowed funds at any time during each of the periods shown.

At or for the year ended December 31, 2015

Short-term borrowed funds
  Short-term FHLB advances
  Subordinated debenture, due 2016
  Other short-term borrowings

Long-term borrowed funds
  Long-term FHLB advances, due 2017 through 

  2021

  Subordinated debentures, due 2017 through 2020
  Subordinated debentures issued to Carolina 

  Ending   
  Balance   

Period
End
Rate

  Maximum   
  Month    Average for the  

End

Period

  Balance    Balance     Rate  

(Dollars in thousands)

   120,000     0.28%-0.64%   

—    
—    

— 
— 

147,500    113,840    
125    
3    

300   
—   

0.29%
2.71%
0.73%

   88,000     0.35%-4.00%   

—    

— 

88,000   
1,275   

41,276    
639    

3.26%
2.54%

  Financial Capital Trust I, due 2032

5,155    

3.75%   

5,155   

5,155    

3.75%

  Subordinated debentures issued to Carolina  

  Financial Capital Trust II, due 2034

   10,310    

3.38%   

10,310   

10,310    

3.38%

At or for the year ended December 31, 2014

Short-term borrowed funds
  Short-term FHLB advances
  Subordinated debenture, due 2015
  Other short-term borrowings

  Ending   
  Balance   

Period
End
Rate

  Maximum   
  Month   
End

Average for the  

Period

  Balance    Balance     Rate  

(Dollars in thousands)

   57,500    0.19%-0.56%  
2.68%  
— 

300   
—   

110,500  
300  
10,000  

  40,886   
300   
137   

0.24%
2.02%
0.75%

Long-term borrowed funds
  Long-term FHLB advances, due 2015 through 2021    45,000    1.20%-4.00%  
  Subordinated debentures, due 2016 through 2020
2.68%  
  Subordinated debentures issued to Carolina  

1,275   

57,500  
1,575  

  51,694   
1,461   

2.83%
2.87%

  Financial Capital Trust I, due 2032

5,155   

3.75%  

5,155  

5,155   

3.75%

  Subordinated debentures issued to Carolina  

  Financial Capital Trust II, due 2034

   10,310   

3.28%  

10,310  

  10,310   

3.33%

78

 
 
 
  
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
      
   
  
     
      
   
  
  
  
  
 
  
      
   
  
     
      
   
  
      
   
  
     
      
   
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
     
   
  
    
 
     
 
   
 
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
     
   
  
    
 
     
 
   
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
At or for the year ended December 31, 2013

Short-term borrowed funds
  Unsecured line of credit
  Short-term FHLB advances
  Mortgage loan warehouse line of credit
  Subordinated debenture, due 2020

Long-term borrowed funds
  Long-term FHLB advances, due 2014 through 2021
  Subordinated debentures, due 2016 through 2020
  Subordinated debentures issued to Carolina  

  Ending   
  Balance  

Period
End
Rate

  Maximum  
  Month    Average for the  

End

Period

  Balance    Balance    Rate 

(Dollars in thousands)

  $ —  
  10,000  
—  
300  

— 
0.36% 
— 
2.70% 

2,700  
73,000  
3,748  
300  

1,987   
  18,428   
1,620   
300   

  5.00%
  0.27%
  5.20%
  2.73%

  57,500  
  1,575  

  0.42% - 4.00% 
2.70% 

57,500  
11,875  

  50,726   
9,404   

  2.67%
  1.99%

  Financial Capital Trust I, due 2032

  5,155  

3.75% 

5,155  

5,155   

  3.75%

  Subordinated debentures issued to Carolina  

  Financial Capital Trust II, due 2034

  10,310  

3.29% 

10,310  

  10,310   

  3.57%

Liquidity

Liquidity represents the ability of a company to convert assets into cash or cash equivalents with-
out significant loss, and the ability to raise additional funds by increasing liabilities. Liquidity management 
involves	monitoring	our	sources	and	uses	of	funds	in	order	to	meet	our	day-to-day	cash	flow	requirements	
while	 maximizing	 profits.	 Liquidity	 management	 is	 made	 more	 complicated	 because	 different	 balance	
sheet components are subject to varying degrees of management control. For example, the timing of ma-
turities of our investment portfolio is fairly predictable and subject to a high degree of control at the time 
investment	decisions	are	made.	However,	net	deposit	inflows	and	outflows	are	far	less	predictable	and	are	
not subject to the same degree of control.

The	Company	utilizes	borrowing	facilities	in	order	to	maintain	adequate	liquidity	including:	the	
FHLB advance window, the Federal Reserve, and federal funds purchased. The Company also uses whole-
sale deposit products, including brokered deposits as well as national certificate of deposit services. Addi-
tionally, the Company has certain investment securities classified as available-for-sale that are carried at 
market value with changes in market value, net of tax, recorded through stockholders’ equity.

Lines of credit with the FHLB are based upon FHLB-approved percentages of Bank assets, but 
must be supported by appropriate collateral to be available. The Company has pledged first lien residen-
tial mortgage, second lien residential mortgage, residential home equity line of credit, commercial mort-
gage and multifamily mortgage portfolios under blanket lien agreements resulting in approximately $273.6 
million of collateral for these advances. In addition, at December 31, 2015, the Company has pledged secu-
rities with a fair value of $76.4 million for these advances. At December 31, 2015 the Company had FHLB 
advances of $208 million outstanding with excess collateral pledged to the FHLB during those periods that 
would support additional borrowings of approximately $77.4 million.

Lines  of  credit  with  the  Federal  Reserve  Bank  (“FRB”)  are  based  on  collateral  pledged.  The 
Company has pledged approximately $168.5 million of certain non-mortgage commercial, acquisition and 
development, and lot loan portfolios under blanket lien agreements to the FRB. At December 31, 2015 
the Company had lines available with the FRB for $84.3 million. At December 31, 2015 the Company had 
no FRB advances outstanding. 

79

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
  
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    
 
   
 
 
    
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    
 
   
 
 
    
 
     
 
   
 
 
    
 
   
 
 
    
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capital Resources

The  Company  and  the  Bank  are  subject  to  various  federal  and  state  regulatory  requirements, 
including regulatory capital requirements. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate cer-
tain mandatory and possible additional discretionary actions that if undertaken could have a direct mate-
rial effect on the Company’s and the Bank’s financial statements.

In 2013, federal bank regulatory agencies issued a final rule that revises their risk-based capital re-
quirements and the method for calculating risk-weighted assets to make them consistent with agreements 
that were reached by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (“Basel III”) and certain provisions of 
the Dodd-Frank Act.

The rule imposes higher risk-based capital and leverage requirements than those in place at the 

time the rule was issued. Specifically, the rule imposes the following minimum capital requirements:

•  A new Common Equity Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 4.5%

•  A Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6% (increased from the previous 4% requirement),

•  A total risk-based capital ratio of 8% (unchanged from previous requirement),

•  A leverage ratio of 4% and

• 

 A new supplementary leverage ratio of 3% applicable to advanced approaches banking orga-
nizations	resulting	in	a	leverage	ratio	requirement	of	7%	for	such	institutions

The rule also includes changes in what constitutes regulatory capital, some of which are subject 
to a transition period. These changes include the phasing-out of certain instruments as qualifying capital. 
In addition, Tier 2 capital is no longer limited to the amount of Tier 1 capital included in total capital. 
Mortgage servicing rights, certain deferred tax assets and investments in unconsolidated subsidiaries over 
designated percentages of common stock are required to be deducted from capital, subject to a transi-
tion period. Finally, Common Equity Tier 1 capital includes accumulated other comprehensive income 
(which	includes	all	unrealized	gains	and	losses	on	available	for	sale	debt	and	equity	securities),	subject	to	a	
transition period and a one-time opt-out election. The Bank elected to opt-out of this provision. As such, 
accumulated comprehensive income is not included in the Bank’s Tier 1 capital.

The	rule	also	includes	changes	in	the	risk-weights	of	assets	to	better	reflect	credit	risk	and	other	
risk exposures. These include a 150% risk weight (up from 100%) for certain high volatility commercial 
real estate acquisition, development and construction loans and non-residential mortgage loans that are 
90 days past due or otherwise on nonaccrual status, a 20% (up from 0%) credit conversion factor for the 
unused portion of a commitment with an original maturity of one year or less that is not unconditionally 
cancellable, a 250% risk weight (up from 100%) for mortgage servicing rights and deferred tax assets that 
are not deducted from capital and increased risk-weights (from 0% to up to 600%) for equity exposures.

Finally, the rule limits capital distributions and certain discretionary bonus payments if the bank-
ing	 organization	 does	 not	 hold	 a	 “capital	 conservation	 buffer”	 consisting	 of	 2.5%	 of	 Common	 Equity	
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets in addition to the amount necessary to meet its minimum risk-based 
capital requirements.

80

The final rule became effective on January 1, 2015, and the requirements in the rule will be fully 
phased-in by January 1, 2019. While the ultimate impact of the fully phased-in capital standards on the 
Company and the Bank is being reviewed, we currently do not believe Basel III will have a material impact 
once fully implemented.

The actual capital amounts and ratios as well as minimum amounts for each regulatory defined 

category for the Company and the Bank at December 31, 2015 and 2014 are as follows:

  Minimum 

Actual
  Amount    Ratio  

Required For 
Capital Adequacy 
Purposes
 Amount    Ratio  
(Dollars in thousands)

To Be Well 
Capitalized 
Under Prompt 
Corrective Action 
Regulations
  Amount    Ratio  

December 31, 2015
  Carolina Financial Corporation

  CET1 capital (to risk weighted  

  assets)

 $ 138,213    13.97%    44,527    

4.50%    

N/A     N/A 

  Tier 1 capital (to risk weighted  

  assets)

  Total capital (to risk weighted  

   153,213    15.48%    59,370    

6.00%    

N/A     N/A 

  assets)

   163,353    16.51%    79,160    

8.00%    

N/A     N/A 

  Tier 1 capital (to total average  

  assets)

   153,213    11.23%    54,557    

4.00%    

N/A     N/A 

  CresCom Bank

  CET1 capital (to risk weighted  

  assets)

   139,025    14.08%    44,442    

4.50%     64,194    

6.50%

  Tier 1 capital (to risk weighted  

  assets)

  Total capital (to risk weighted  

   139,025    14.08%    59,256    

6.00%     79,008    

8.00%

  assets)

   149,165    15.10%    79,008    

8.00%     98,760     10.00%

  Tier 1 capital (to total average  

  assets)

   139,025    10.21%    54,466    

4.00%     68,082    

5.00%

December 31, 2014
  Carolina Financial Corporation

  Tier 1 capital (to risk weighted  

  assets)

 $ 104,613    12.03%   34,787    

4.00%   

N/A     N/A 

  Total risk based capital (to risk  

  weighted assets)

   114,323    13.15%   69,574    

8.00%   

N/A     N/A 

  Tier 1 capital (to total average  

  assets)

   104,613   

9.49%   44,079    

4.00%   

N/A     N/A 

  CresCom Bank

  Tier 1 capital (to risk weighted  

  assets)

   103,319    11.90%   34,716    

4.00%    52,074    

6.00%

  Total risk based capital (to risk  

  weighted assets)

   113,029    13.02%   69,433    

8.00%    86,791     10.00%

  Tier 1 capital (to total average  

  assets)

   103,319   

9.40%   43,985    

4.00%    54,981    

5.00%

81

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
  
     
   
  
      
   
   
      
   
  
     
   
  
      
   
   
      
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
     
   
  
      
   
   
      
   
  
     
   
  
      
   
   
      
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
     
   
  
      
   
   
      
   
  
     
   
  
      
   
   
      
   
  
     
   
  
      
   
   
      
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
     
   
  
      
   
   
      
   
  
     
   
  
      
   
   
      
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
The following table shows the return on average assets (net income divided by average total as-
sets), return on average equity (net income divided by average equity), and equity to assets ratio (average 
equity divided by average total assets) for the three years ended December 31, 2015, 2014, and 2013.

For the Years Ended December 31,
2014

2013

2015

Return on average assets
Return on average equity
Average equity to average assets ratio

1.11%  
14.15%  
7.82%  

0.84% 
9.39% 
8.93% 

1.89%
22.04%
8.58%

The following table provides the amount of dividends and payout ratios (dividends declared divid-

ed by net income) for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014, and 2013.

For the Years Ended December 31,
2014

2013

2015

Shareholder dividends declared
Dividend payout ratios

 $ 1,142,000 

$

855,000 

$

401,000 

7.92%  

10.29% 

2.38%

We retain earnings to have capital sufficient to grow our loan and investment portfolios and to 
support certain acquisitions or other business expansion opportunities as they arise. The dividend payout 
ratio is calculated by dividing dividends paid during the year by net income for the year.

Off Balance Sheet Arrangements

Through the operations of our Bank, we have made contractual commitments to extend credit in 
the ordinary course of our business activities. These commitments are legally binding agreements to lend 
money to our customers at predetermined interest rates for a specified period of time. We evaluate each 
customer’s credit worthiness on a case-by-case basis. The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed neces-
sary by us upon extension of credit, is based on our credit evaluation of the borrower. Collateral varies but 
may include accounts receivable, inventory, property, plant and equipment, commercial and residential 
real estate. We manage the credit risk on these commitments by subjecting them to normal underwriting 
and risk management processes.

At December 31, 2015, we had issued commitments to extend credit of approximately $70.4 mil-
lion through various types of lending arrangements. There were 22 standby letters of credit included in the 
commitments for $1.4 million. Fixed rate commitments were $12.6 million and variable rate commitments 
were $59.2 million.

Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require 
the payment of a fee. A significant portion of the unfunded commitments relate to consumer equity lines 
of credit and commercial lines of credit. Based on historical experience, we anticipate that a portion of 
these lines of credit will not be funded.

Except as disclosed in this report, we are not involved in off-balance sheet contractual relation-
ships, unconsolidated related entities that have off-balance sheet arrangements or transactions that could 
result in liquidity needs or other commitments that significantly impact earnings.

82

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
Market Risk Management and Interest Rate Risk

The effective management of market risk is essential to achieving the Company’s objectives. As a 
financial institution, the Company’s most significant market risk exposure is interest rate risk. The primary ob-
jective	of	managing	interest	rate	risk	is	to	minimize	the	effect	that	changes	in	interest	rates	have	on	net	income.	
This is accomplished through active asset and liability management, which requires the strategic pricing of 
asset and liability accounts and management of appropriate maturity mixes of assets and liabilities. The expect-
ed result of these strategies is the development of appropriate maturity and re-pricing opportunities in those 
accounts to produce consistent net income during periods of changing interest rates. The Bank’s asset/liability 
management committee, or ALCO, monitors loan, investment and liability portfolios to ensure comprehen-
sive	management	of	interest	rate	risk.	These	portfolios	are	analyzed	for	proper	fixed-rate	and	variable-rate	
mixes  under  various  interest  rate  scenarios.  The  asset/liability  management  process  is  designed  to  achieve 
relatively stable net interest margins and assure liquidity by coordinating the volumes, maturities or re-pricing 
opportunities of interest-earning assets, deposits and borrowed funds. It is the responsibility of the ALCO to 
determine and achieve the most appropriate volume and mix of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing 
liabilities, as well as ensure an adequate level of liquidity and capital, within the context of corporate perfor-
mance goals. The ALCO meets regularly to review the Company’s interest rate risk and liquidity positions in 
relation to present and prospective market and business conditions, and adopts funding and balance sheet 
management strategies that are intended to ensure that the potential impact on earnings and liquidity as a 
result	of	fluctuations	in	interest	rates	is	within	acceptable	standards.	The	Board	of	Directors	also	sets	policy	
guidelines and establishes long-term strategies with respect to interest rate risk exposure and liquidity.

The  Company  uses  interest  rate  sensitivity  analysis  to  measure  the  sensitivity  of  projected  net 
interest  income  to  changes  in  interest  rates.  Management  monitors  the  Company’s  interest  sensitivity 
by means of a computer model that incorporates current volumes, average rates earned and paid, and 
scheduled maturities, payments of asset and liability portfolios, together with multiple scenarios of pre-
payments, repricing opportunities and anticipated volume growth. Interest rate sensitivity analysis shows 
the effect that the indicated changes in interest rates would have on net interest income as projected for 
the next twelve months under the current interest rate environment. The resulting change in net interest 
income	reflects	the	level	of	sensitivity	that	net	interest	income	has	in	relation	to	changing	interest	rates.

As	of	December	31,	2015,	the	following	table	summarizes	the	forecasted	impact	on	net	interest	in-
come using a base case scenario given upward movements in interest rates of 100, 200, and 300 basis points 
based on forecasted assumptions of prepayment speeds, nominal interest rates and loan and deposit repricing 
rates. Downward movements do not appear to be applicable due to the low interest rate environment expe-
rienced during 2014 and 2015. Estimates are based on current economic conditions, historical interest rate 
cycles and other factors deemed to be relevant. However, underlying assumptions may be impacted in future 
periods which were not known to management at the time of the issuance of the Consolidated Financial State-
ments. Therefore, management’s assumptions may or may not prove valid. No assurance can be given that 
changing economic conditions and other relevant factors impacting our net interest income will not cause ac-
tual occurrences to differ from underlying assumptions. In addition, this analysis does not consider any strate-
gic changes to our balance sheet which management may consider as a result of changes in market conditions.

Interest Rate Scenario  
Change   Prime Rate  
3.50%  
0.00%  
4.50%  
1.00%  
5.50%  
2.00%  
6.50%  
3.00%  

Annualized	Hypothertical	 
Percentage Change in
Net Interest Income
0.00%
–1.10%
–1.80%
–2.90%

83

2015 Form 10-KThe primary uses of derivative instruments are related to the mortgage banking activities of the 
Company. As such, the Company holds derivative instruments, which consist of rate lock agreements re-
lated to expected funding of fixed-rate mortgage loans to customers (interest rate lock commitments) and 
forward commitments to sell mortgage-backed securities and individual fixed-rate mortgage loans. The 
Company’s objective in obtaining the forward commitments is to mitigate the interest rate risk associated 
with the interest rate lock commitments and the mortgage loans that are held for sale. Derivatives related 
to these commitments are recorded as either a derivative asset or a derivative liability in the balance sheet 
and are measured at fair value. Both the interest rate lock commitments and the forward commitments are 
reported at fair value, with adjustments recorded in current period earnings in mortgage banking income 
within the noninterest income of the consolidated statements of operations. Derivative instruments not 
related to mortgage banking activities primarily relate to interest rate swap agreements.

When	 using	 derivatives	 to	 hedge	 fair	 value	 and	 cash	 flow	 risks,	 the	 Company	 exposes	 itself	 to	
potential credit risk from the counterparty to the hedging instrument. This credit risk is normally a small 
percentage	of	the	notional	amount	and	fluctuates	as	interest	rates	change.	The	Company	analyzes	and	
approves credit risk for all potential derivative counterparties prior to execution of any derivative trans-
action.	 The	 Company	 seeks	 to	 minimize	 credit	 risk	 by	 dealing	 with	 highly	 rated	 counterparties	 and	 by	
obtaining	collateralization	for	exposures	above	certain	predetermined	limits.	If	significant	counterparty	
risk is determined, the Company would adjust the fair value of the derivative recorded asset balance to 
consider such risk.

The derivative positions of the Company at December 31, 2015 and 2014 are as follows:

At December 31,

2015

2014

Fair
  Value  

Notional  
Value

Fair
  Value    

Notional
Value

(In thousands)

  $

180 

30,000 

—   

— 

Derivative assets:
	 Cash	flow	hedges:

  Interest rate swaps
  Non-hedging derivatives:

  Mortgage loan interest rate lock commitments
  Mortgage loan forward sales commitments
  Mortgage-backed securities forward sales commitments   
  $

Total derivative assets

1,246 
340 
179 
1,945 

143,318 
31,513 
105,014 
309,845 

1,122   
567   
—   
1,689   

106,440 
27,292 
— 
133,732 

Derivative liabilities:
  Non-hedging derivatives:
  $
  Interest rate swaps
  Mortgage-backed securities forward sales commitments   
  $

Total derivative liabilities

306 
— 
306 

10,000 
— 
10,000 

530   
506   
1,036   

20,000 
93,000 
113,000 

The Company has entered into forward starting interest rate swaps to reduce the exposure to vari-
ability	in	interest-related	cash	outflows	attributable	to	changes	in	forecasted	LIBOR	based	FHLB	borrow-
ings.	These	derivative	instruments	are	designated	as	cash	flow	hedges.	The	hedged	item	is	the	LIBOR	portion	
of the series of future short-term fixed rate borrowings over the term of the interest rate swap. Accordingly, 

84

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
   
     
 
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
     
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
   
   
 
 
   
   
     
 
   
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
   
     
 
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
     
 
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
     
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
changes	to	the	amount	of	interest	payment	cash	flows	for	the	hedged	transactions	attributable	to	a	change	
in  credit  risk  are  excluded  from  our  assessment  of  hedge  effectiveness.  The  effective  portion  of  changes 
in	the	fair	value	of	derivatives	designated	and	that	qualify	as	cash	flow	hedges	is	recorded	in	accumulated	
other comprehensive income and is subsequently reclassified into earnings in the period that the hedged 
forecasted transaction affects earnings. The ineffective portion of the change in fair value of the derivatives 
is	recognized	directly	in	earnings.	The	Company	has	not	recorded	any	hedge	ineffectiveness	since	inception.

As of December 31, 2015, the Company had two outstanding interest rate derivatives with a no-
tional	value	of	$30.0	million	that	were	designated	as	cash	flow	hedges	of	interest	rate	risk	with	a	weighted	
average remaining term of 9.84 years.

In the event that the forecasted transaction was no longer be probable, the Company would recog-

nize	a	gain	of	$180,000	directly	into	earnings,	the	current	fair	value,	as	of	December	31,	2015.

Contractual Obligations

The following table presents payment schedules for certain of our contractual obligations as of 
December 31, 2015. Operating lease obligations of $3.8 million pertain to banking facilities and equip-
ment.  Certain  lease  agreements  include  payment  of  property  taxes  and  insurance  and  contain  various 
renewal options. Additional information regarding leases is contained in Note 14 of the audited consoli-
dated financial statements.

  Total

   Less than   1 to 3    3 to 5   More than 
   1 Year    Years    Years    5 Years  

(Dollars in thousands)

Advances from FHLB
Interest	rate	swap	-	cash	flow	hedge	derivative
Interest rate swap - non-hedging derivative
Subordinated debentures issued to Carolina Financial Capital 

 $ 208,000    120,000   
—   
—   

30,000   
10,000   

68,000    20,000   
—    —   
—    —   

— 
30,000 
10,000 

Trust I, due 2032

5,155   

—   

—    —   

5,155 

Subordinated debentures issued to Carolina Financial Capital 

Trust II, due 2034

Operating lease obligations

10,310   
3,809   

—   
1,013   

—    —   
1,701    1,026   

10,310 
69 

Accounting, Reporting, and Regulatory Matters

Information  regarding  recent  authoritative  pronouncements  that  could  impact  the  accounting, 
reporting, and/or disclosure of the financial information by the Company are included in Note 1 of the 
audited consolidated financial statements.

Effect of Inflation and Changing Prices

The	effect	of	relative	purchasing	power	over	time	due	to	inflation	has	not	been	taken	into	account	
in our consolidated financial statements. Rather, our financial statements have been prepared on an his-
torical cost basis in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

85

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
Unlike  most  industrial  companies,  our  assets  and  liabilities  are  primarily  monetary  in  nature. 
Therefore, the effect of changes in interest rates will have a more significant impact on our performance 
than	will	the	effect	of	changing	prices	and	inflation	in	general.	In	addition,	interest	rates	may	generally	
increase	as	the	rate	of	inflation	increases,	although	not	necessarily	in	the	same	magnitude.	As	discussed	
previously, we seek to manage the relationships between interest sensitive assets and liabilities in order to 
protect	against	wide	rate	fluctuations,	including	those	resulting	from	inflation.

ITEM 7A.  QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

See  Item  7.  Management’s  Discussion  and  Analysis  of  Financial  Condition  and  Results  of 

 Operations – Market Risk and Interest Rate Sensitivity and – Liquidity and Capital Resources.

86

ITEM 8.  FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Board of Directors and Stockholders
Carolina Financial Corporation
Charleston, South Carolina

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Carolina Financial Corporation and 
subsidiaries as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, and the related consolidated statements of operations, 
comprehensive	income,	stockholders’	equity,	and	cash	flows	for	the	years	then	ended.	These	consolidated	
financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express 
an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight 
Board  (United  States).  Those  standards  require  that  we  plan  and  perform  the  audit  to  obtain  reason-
able assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. The Company 
is not required to have, nor were we engaged to perform, an audit of its internal control over financial 
reporting under Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (PCAOB) standards. Our audits included 
consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are 
appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of 
the Company’s internal control over financial reporting under PCAOB standards. Accordingly, we express 
no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and 
disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates 
made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that 
our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material re-
spects, the financial position of Carolina Financial Corporation and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2015 
and	2014,	and	the	results	of	their	operations	and	their	cash	flows	for	the	years	then	ended,	in	conformity	
with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

/s/ Elliott Davis Decosimo, LLC

Greenville, South Carolina
March 14, 2016

87

2015 Form 10-KCAROLINA FINANCIAL CORPORATION  
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

ASSETS
  Cash and due from banks
  Interest-bearing cash

  Cash and cash equivalents

  Securities available-for-sale (cost of $305,972 at December 31, 2015  

  and $246,435 at December 31, 2014)

  Securities held-to-maturity (fair value of $17,965 at December 31, 2015  

  and $27,385 at December 31, 2014)
  Federal Home Loan Bank stock, at cost
  Other investments
  Derivative assets
  Loans held for sale
  Loans receivable, net of allowance for loan losses of $10,141 at December 31,  

  2015 and $9,035 at December 31, 2014

  Premises and equipment, net
  Accrued interest receivable
  Real estate acquired through foreclosure, net
  Deferred tax assets, net
  Mortgage servicing rights
  Cash value life insurance
  Core deposit intangible
  Other assets

  Total assets

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
Liabilities:
  Noninterest-bearing deposits
  Interest-bearing deposits

  Total deposits

  Short-term borrowed funds
  Long-term debt
  Derivative liabilities
  Drafts outstanding
  Advances from borrowers for insurance and taxes
  Accrued interest payable
  Reserve for mortgage repurchase losses
  Dividends payable to stockholders
  Accrued expenses and other liabilities

  Total liabilities

Commitments and contingencies
Stockholders’ equity:
	 Preferred	stock,	par	value	$.01;	1,000,000	authorized	at	December	31,	 

  2015 and December 31, 2014; no shares issued or outstanding

	 Common	stock,	par	value	$.01;	15,000,000	and	10,000,000	shares	authorized	 

  at December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively; 12,023,557 and 9,717,043  
issued and outstanding at December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively

  Additional paid-in capital
  Retained earnings
  Accumulated other comprehensive income

  Total stockholders’ equity

  Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

88

At December 31,

2015

2014

(In thousands)

10,206     
16,421     
26,627     

10,453 
10,694 
21,147 

306,474     

251,717 

17,053     
9,919     
3,273     
1,945     
41,774     

912,582     
32,562     
4,333     
2,374     
5,273     
11,433     
28,082     
2,961     
3,004     
1,409,669     

163,054     
868,474     
1,031,528     
120,000     
103,465     
306     
2,154     
641     
333     
3,876     
361     
7,146     
1,269,810     

25,544 
5,405 
2,309 
1,689 
40,912 

768,122 
31,075 
3,628 
3,239 
4,715 
10,181 
21,532 
3,303 
4,499 
1,199,017 

142,900 
821,290 
964,190 
57,800 
61,740 
1,036 
3,320 
613 
312 
4,999 
243  
11,064 
1,105,317 

—     

— 

120     
56,418     
82,859     
462     
139,859     
1,409,669     

97 
23,194 
69,625 
784 
93,700 
1,199,017 

$

$

$

$

 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
   
 
 
       
   
 
 
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
   
 
 
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CAROLINA FINANCIAL CORPORATION
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

For the Years
Ended December 31,

2015

2014

(In thousands, except share data)

Interest income
  Loans
  Investment securities
  Dividends from FHLB
  Other interest income

  Total interest income

Interest expense
  Deposits
  Short-term borrowed funds
  Long-term debt

  Total interest expense

Net interest income
Provision for loan losses
  Net interest income after provision for loan losses
Noninterest income
  Mortgage banking income
  Deposit service charges
  Net loss on extinguishment of debt
  Net gain on sale of securities
  Fair value adjustments on interest rate swaps
  Net gain on sale of servicing assets
  Net increase in cash value life insurance
  Mortgage loan servicing income
  Other

  Total noninterest income

Noninterest expense
  Salaries and employee benefits
  Occupancy and equipment
  Marketing and public relations
  FDIC insurance
  Recovery of mortgage loan repurchase losses
  Legal expense
  Other real estate expense, net
  Mortgage subservicing expense
	 Amortization	of	mortgage	servicing	rights
  Other

  Total noninterest expense

Income before income taxes
Income tax expense
  Net income
Earnings per common share:
  Basic
  Diluted
Average common shares outstanding:
  Basic
  Diluted

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

89

$

$

$
$

41,020   
8,176   
328   
80   
49,604   

4,367   
331   
1,906   
6,604   
43,000   
—   
43,000   

17,417   
3,496   
(1,251)  
1,493   
(1,111)  
—   
726   
5,313   
1,596   
27,679   

28,629   
7,228   
1,434   
698   
(1,000)  
407   
138   
1,634   
1,986   
8,045   
49,199   
21,480   
7,060   
14,420   

1.51   
1.48   

31,317 
6,083 
158 
98 
37,656 

3,483 
106 
2,013 
5,602 
32,054 
— 
32,054 

11,908 
2,065 
(58)
1,084 
(1,170)
775 
731 
5,077 
736 
21,148 

23,308 
4,858 
1,251 
581 
(750)
438 
638 
1,392 
1,795 
7,932 
41,443 
11,759 
3,448 
8,311 

0.89 
0.87 

9,537,358   
9,718,356   

9,314,048 
9,507,425 

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
CAROLINA FINANCIAL CORPORATION
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME

Net income
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:
	 Unrealized	(losses)	gain	on	securities
  Tax effect
  Reclassification adjustment for (gains) included in earnings
  Tax effect
	 Unrealized	gains	on	interest	rate	swaps	designated	as	cash	flow	hedges
  Tax effect
  Transfer from held-to-maturity to available for sale securities
  Tax effect
	 Accretion	of	unrealized	losses	on	held-to-maturity	securities	previously	 

	 recognized	in	other	comprehensive	income

  Tax effect
Other comprehensive (loss) income, net of tax
Comprehensive income

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

For the Years
Ended December 31,
2015
2014

(In thousands)

$

14,420 

(939)  
338 
(1,493)  
537 
180 
(65)  

1,604 
(580)  

151 
(55)  
(322)  

$

14,098 

8,311 

5,828 
(2,101)
(1,084)
390 
— 
— 
— 
— 

198 
(72)
3,159 
11,470 

90

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CAROLINA FINANCIAL CORPORATION
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

Common Stock

   Additional   
   Paid-in     Retained   Comprehensive   

    Accumulated    
Other

  Shares

    Amount   Capital

    Earnings    Income (Loss)     Total

Balance, December 31, 2013
  Stock awards
  Stock options exercised
  Excess tax benefit in connection with  

  equity awards

  Stock-based compensation expense, net    
  Net income
  Dividends declared to stockholders
  Other comprehensive income, net  

  of tax

Balance, December 31, 2014
  Issuance of common stock, net of  

  offering expenses

  Stock awards
  Vested stock awards surrendered in  

  cashless exercise
  Stock options exercised
  Excess tax benefit in connection with  

  equity awards

  Stock-based compensation expense, net    
  Net income
  Dividends declared to stockholders
  Other comprehensive loss, net of tax
Balance, December 31, 2015

(In thousands, except share data)
96    
    9,636,490    $
69,225     
1    
11,328      —    

22,337      62,169     
—     
—     

64     
50     

—      —    
—      —    
—      —    
—      —    

126     
617     
—     
—     

—     
—     
8,311     
(855)   

    9,717,043     

—      —    
97    

—     

—     
23,194      69,625     

3,159    

3,159 
784     93,700 

    2,262,296     

23    
37,491      —    

32,133     
—     

(7,289)     —    
14,016      —    

(42)    
70     

—     
—     

(44)   
—     

—      —    
—      —    
—      —    
—      —    
—      —    
120    

—     
189     
874     
—     
—      14,420     
(1,142)   
—     
—     
—     
56,418      82,859     

    12,023,557    $

(2,375)    82,227 
65 
50 

—    
—    

—    
—    
—    
—    

126 
617 
8,311 
(855)

—     32,156 
— 
—    

—    
—    

(86)
70 

189 
—    
—    
874 
—     14,420 
(1,142)
—    
(322)   
(322)
462     139,859 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

91

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
   
 
  
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
   
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
   
 
   
   
   
   
CAROLINA FINANCIAL CORPORATION
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

Cash	flows	from	operating	activities:
  Net income
  Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:

  Deferred tax (benefit) expense
	 Amortization	of	unearned	discount/premiums	on	investments,	net
	 Amortization	of	deferred	loan	fees
	 Amortization	of	core	deposit	intangibles
  Gain on sale of available-for-sale securities, net
  Mortgage banking income
  Originations of loans held for sale
  Proceeds from sale of loans held for sale
  Loss on extinquishment of debt
  Provision for mortgage loan repurchase losses
  Mortgage loan losses paid, net of recoveries
  Fair value adjustments on interest rate swaps
  Stock-based compensation
  Increase in cash surrender value of bank owned life insurance
  Depreciation
  Loss on disposals of premises and equipment
  Gain on sale of real estate acquired through foreclosure
  Write-down of real estate acquired through foreclosure
  Gain on sale of servicing assets
  Originations of mortgage servicing assets
	 Amortization	of	mortgage	servicing	rights
  (Increase) decrease in:

  Accrued interest receivable
  Other assets

  Increase (decrease) in:

  Accrued interest payable
  Dividends payable to stockholders
  Accrued expenses and other liabilities

Cash	flows	provided	by	operating	activities

For the Years 
Ended December 31,
2014
2015

(In thousands)

$

14,420 

8,311 

(307)
3,416 
(955)
343 
(1,493)
(17,417)
  (1,060,241)
  1,076,796 
1,251 
(1,000)
(123)
1,111 
874 
(726)
1,778 
11 
(10)
— 
— 
(3,238)
1,986 

(705)
109 

21 
118 
(4,917)
11,102 

888 
2,802 
(550)
47 
(1,084)
(11,908)
    (982,204)
    990,097 
58 
(750)
(360)
1,170 
617 
(731)
1,229 
8 
(91)
526 
(775)
(1,868)
1,795 

(668)
464 

1 
243 
3,228 
10,495 

Continued

92

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
   
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
	
 
 
   
	
 
 
   
	
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
	
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
CAROLINA FINANCIAL CORPORATION
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS, CONTINUED

For the Years
Ended December 31,

2015

2014

(In thousands)

$

$

$

(207,316)
52,906 
105,840 

(497)
199 
(973)
(4,514)
(144,812)
— 
(3,329)
34 
2,182 
(6,025)
175 
— 
(206,130)

67,338 
104,249 
(1,575)
(1,166)
28 
(781)
32,156 
189 
70 
200,508 
5,480 
21,147 
26,627 

6,583 
7,160 

1,307 
12,652 

(193,577)
37,782 
74,901 

(1,487)
536 
(419)
(1,302)
(163,846)
1,575 
(4,017)
— 
4,060 
— 
— 
131,135 
(114,659)

51,488 
34,942 
(300)
617 
329 
(606)
— 
126 
50 
86,646 
(17,518)
38,665 
21,147 

5,601 
3,553 

1,461 
— 

Cash	flows	from	investing	activities:
  Activity in available-for-sale securities:

  Purchases
  Maturities, payments and calls
  Proceeds from sales

  Activity in held-to-maturity securities:

  Purchases
  Maturities, payments and calls

  Increase in other investments
  Increase in Federal Home Loan Bank stock
  Increase in loans receivable, net
  Proceeds from the sale of servicing assets
  Purchase of premises and equipment
  Proceeds from disposals of premises and equipment
  Proceeds from sale of real estate acquired through foreclosure
  Purchase of bank owned life insurance
  Distribution of bank owned life insurance
  Net cash received for acquisitions
Cash	flows	used	in	investing	activities

Cash	flows	from	financing	activities:
  Net increase in deposit accounts
  Net increase in Federal Home Loan Bank advances
  Principal repayment of subordinated debt
  Net increase (decrease) in drafts outstanding
  Net increase in advances from borrowers for insurance and taxes
  Cash dividends paid on common stock
  Proceeds from issuance of common stock
  Net increase in excess tax benefit in connection with equity awards
  Proceeds from exercise of stock options
Cash	flows	provided	by	financing	activities
  Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year
Cash and cash equivalents, end of year

Supplemental disclosure
  Cash paid for:

  Interest on deposits and borrowed funds
  Income taxes paid, net of refunds

  Noncash investing and financing activities:

  Transfer of loans receivable to real estate acquired through foreclosure
  Transfer of held-to-maturity securities to available-for-sale securities

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

93

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
NOTE 1 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Organization

Carolina Financial Corporation (“Carolina Financial” or the “Company”), incorporated under the laws 
of the State of Delaware, is a bank holding company with one wholly-owned subsidiaries, CresCom Bank 
(the “Bank”). CresCom Bank operates two wholly-owned subsidiaries, Crescent Mortgage Company and 
Carolina Services Corporation of Charleston (“Carolina Services”). The consolidated financial statements 
include  the  accounts  of  the  Company  and  its  wholly-owned  subsidiary,  the  Bank.  In  consolidation,  all 
material intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated. The results of operations of the 
businesses acquired in transactions accounted for as purchases are included only from the dates of acqui-
sition. All majority-owned subsidiaries are consolidated unless control is temporary or does not rest with 
the Company.

At December 31, 2015 and 2014, statutory business trusts (“Trusts”) created by the Company had out-
standing  trust  preferred  securities  with  an  aggregate  par  value  of  $15,000,000.  The  principal  assets  of 
the Trusts are $15,465,000 of the Company’s subordinated debentures with identical rates of interest and 
maturities as the trust preferred securities. The Trusts have issued $465,000 of common securities to the 
Company and are included in other investments in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. The 
Trusts are not consolidated subsidiaries of the Company.

Management’s Estimates

The financial statements are prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in the 
United States of America which require management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the 
reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities as of the date of 
the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting periods. 
Actual results could differ from those estimates.

Material estimates that are particularly susceptible to significant change in the near term relate to the de-
termination of the allowance for loan losses, including valuation for impaired loans, business combination 
accounting, the valuation of real estate acquired in connection with foreclosure or in satisfaction of loans, 
the  valuation  of  securities,  the  valuation  of  derivative  instruments,  the  valuation  of  mortgage  servicing 
rights, the determination of the reserve for mortgage loan repurchase losses, asserted and unasserted legal 
claims and deferred tax assets or liabilities. In connection with the determination of the allowance for loan 
losses and foreclosed real estate, management obtains independent appraisals for significant properties. 
Management must also make estimates in determining the estimated useful lives and methods for depre-
ciating premises and equipment.

Management	uses	available	information	to	recognize	losses	on	loans	and	foreclosed	real	estate.	However,	
future additions to the allowance may be necessary based on changes in local economic conditions. In ad-
dition, regulatory agencies, as an integral part of their examination process, periodically review the Bank’s 
allowances	for	loan	losses	and	foreclosed	real	estate.	Such	agencies	may	require	the	Bank	to	recognize	
additions to the allowances based on their judgments about information available to them at the time of 
their examination. Because of these factors, it is reasonably possible that the allowances for loan losses and 
foreclosed real estate may change materially in the near term.

94

Subsequent Events

Subsequent events are events or transactions that occur after the balance sheet date but before financial 
statements	are	issued.	Recognized	subsequent	events	are	events	or	transactions	that	provide	additional	
evidence about conditions that existed at the date of the balance sheet, including the estimates inherent in 
the	process	of	preparing	financial	statements.	Non-recognized	subsequent	events	are	events	that	provide	
evidence about conditions that did not exist at the date of the statement of financial condition but arose 
after that date and warrant disclosure. Management has reviewed events occurring through the date the 
financial statements were issued and no subsequent events occurred requiring accrual or disclosure except 
as noted below:

On  January  5,  2016,  Carolina  Financial  Corporation  announced  the  signing  of  a  definitive  agreement 
pursuant to which Carolina Financial Corporation will acquire Congaree Bancshares, Inc. in a cash and 
stock transaction with a total current value of approximately $16.3 million including the assumption of ap-
proximately $1.6 million in preferred stock. The transaction is anticipated to close at the end of the second 
quarter of 2016, subject to customary closing conditions.

Cash and Cash Equivalents

Cash and cash equivalents consists of cash and due from banks and interest-bearing cash with banks. Sub-
stantially all of the interest-bearing cash at December 31, 2015 and 2014 consists of Federal Reserve Bank 
of Richmond (“FRB”) and Federal Home Loan Bank of Atlanta (“FHLB”) overnight deposits. Cash and 
cash equivalents have maturities of three months or less. Accordingly, the carrying amount of such instru-
ments is considered a reasonable estimate of fair value. The Bank is required to maintain average balances 
on hand or with the FRB. At December 31, 2014 these reserve balances amounted to $12.1 million. There 
were no reserve requirements at December 31, 2015.

Securities

Investment securities are classified into three categories: (a) Held-to-Maturity – debt securities that the 
Company	 has	 positive	 intent	 and	 ability	 to	 hold	 to	 maturity,	 which	 are	 reported	 at	 amortized	 cost;	 (b)	
Trading – debt and equity securities that are bought and held principally for the purpose of selling them in 
the	near	term,	which	are	reported	at	fair	value,	with	unrealized	gains	and	losses	included	in	earnings;	and	
(c) Available-for-Sale – debt and equity securities that may be sold under certain conditions, which are re-
ported	at	fair	value,	with	unrealized	gains	and	losses	excluded	from	earnings	and	reported	in	accumulated	
other comprehensive income.

The Company determines the category of the investment at the time of purchase. If a security is transferred 
from available–for-sale to held-to-maturity, the fair value at the time of transfer becomes the held-to-ma-
turity	security’s	new	cost	basis.	Premiums	and	discounts	on	securities	are	accreted	and	amortized	as	an	
adjustment to interest yield over the estimated life of the security using a method which approximates a 
level	yield.	Dividends	and	interest	income	are	recognized	when	earned.	Unrealized	losses	on	securities,	
reflecting	a	decline	in	value	judged	by	the	Company	to	be	other-than-temporary,	are	charged	to	income	in	
the consolidated statements of operations.

The cost basis of securities sold is determined by specific identification. Purchases and sales of securities 
are recorded on a trade date basis.

95

2015 Form 10-KLoans Held for Sale

The  Company’s  residential  mortgage  lending  activities  for  sale  in  the  secondary  market  are  comprised 
of accepting residential mortgage loan applications, qualifying borrowers to standards established by in-
vestors,  funding  residential  mortgage  loans  and  selling  mortgage  loans  to  investors  under  pre-existing 
commitments.	Loans	held	for	sale	are	recorded	at	fair	value.	Origination	fees	and	costs	are	recognized	
in earnings at the time of origination for loans held for sale that are recorded at fair value. Fair value is 
derived from observable current market prices, when available, and includes loan servicing value. When 
observable market prices are not available, the Company uses judgment and estimates fair value using 
internal models, in which the Company uses its best estimates of assumptions it believes would be used by 
market	participants	in	estimating	fair	value.	Adjustments	to	reflect	unrealized	gains	and	losses	resulting	
from	changes	in	fair	value	and	realized	gains	and	losses	upon	ultimate	sale	of	the	loans	are	classified	as	
noninterest income, mortgage banking income in the consolidated statements of operations.

The Company issues rate lock commitments to borrowers on prices quoted by secondary market investors. 
Derivatives related to these commitments are recorded as either assets or liabilities in the balance sheet 
and are measured at fair value. Changes in the fair value of the derivatives are reported in current earnings 
or other comprehensive income depending on the purpose for which the derivative is held and whether the 
derivative qualifies for hedge accounting.

Derivative Financial Instruments

Derivatives	are	recognized	as	either	assets	or	liabilities	and	are	recorded	at	fair	value	on	the	Company’s	
Consolidated Balance Sheet. The accounting for changes in the fair value of derivatives depends on the 
intended use of the derivative and resulting designation. The Company’s hedging policies permit the 
use of various derivative financial instruments to manage interest rate risk or to hedge specified assets 
and liabilities.

To qualify for hedge accounting, derivatives must be highly effective at reducing the risk associated with 
the exposure being hedged and must be designated as a hedge at the inception of the derivative contract. 
If derivative instruments are designated as fair value hedges, and such hedges are highly effective, both the 
change in the fair value of the hedge and the hedged item are included in current earnings. If derivative 
instruments	are	designated	as	cash	flow	hedges,	fair	value	adjustments	related	to	the	effective	portion	are	
recorded in other comprehensive income and are reclassified to earnings when the hedged transaction 
is	reflected	in	earnings.	Ineffective	portions	of	cash	flow	hedges	are	reflected	in	earnings	as	they	occur.	
Actual cash receipts and/or payments and related accruals on derivatives related to hedges are recorded 
as  adjustments to the interest income  or interest expense associated with the  hedged item.  During  the 
life of the hedge, the Company formally assesses whether derivatives designated as hedging instruments 
continue	to	be	highly	effective	in	offsetting	changes	in	the	fair	value	or	cash	flows	of	hedged	items.	If	it	is	
determined that a hedge has ceased to be highly effective, the Company will discontinue hedge accounting 
prospectively. At such time, previous adjustments to the carrying value of the hedged item are reversed 
into current earnings and the derivative instrument is reclassified to a trading position recorded at fair 
value.	For	derivatives	not	designated	as	hedges,	changes	in	fair	value	are	recognized	in	earnings,	in	non- 
interest income.

For additional discussion related to the determination of fair value related to derivative instruments, see 
Note 5.

96

Loans Receivable, Net

Loans that management has the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future are reported at their 
outstanding principal balances net of any unearned income, charge-offs, deferred fees or costs on origi-
nated	loans	and	unamortized	premiums	or	discounts	on	purchased	loans.	The	net	amount	of	nonrefund-
able loan origination fees, commitment fees and certain direct costs associated with the lending process 
are	deferred	and	amortized	to	interest	income	over	the	contractual	lives	of	the	loans	using	methods	that	
approximate a level yield or noninterest income when the loan is sold. Discounts and premiums on pur-
chased	loans	are	amortized	to	interest	income	over	the	estimated	life	of	the	loans	using	methods	that	ap-
proximate a level yield, or noninterest income when the loan is sold. Commercial loans and substantially 
all installment loans accrue interest on the unpaid balance of the loans.

A loan is impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable that the Company will 
be unable to collect all amounts due according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement. Impaired 
loans	are	measured	based	on	the	present	value	of	expected	future	cash	flows	discounted	at	the	loan’s	ef-
fective interest rate, or as a practical expedient, at the loan’s observable market price or the fair value of 
the collateral if the loan is collateral-dependent. When the fair value of the impaired loan is less than the 
recorded investment in the loan, the impairment is recorded through a specific reserve allocation that is 
a component of the allowance for loan losses. A loan is charged-off against the allowance for loan losses 
when all meaningful collection efforts have been exhausted and the loan is viewed as uncollectible in the 
immediate or foreseeable future.

Troubled Debt Restructurings (“TDRs”)

The Company designates loan modifications as TDRs when, for economic or legal reasons related to the 
borrower’s financial difficulties, it grants a concession to the borrower that it would not otherwise con-
sider. Loans on nonaccrual status at the date of modification are initially classified as nonaccrual TDRs. 
Loans on accruing status at the date of modification are initially classified as accruing TDRs at the date 
of modification, if the note is reasonably assured of repayment and performance is in accordance with its 
modified terms. Such loans may be designated as nonaccrual loans subsequent to the modification date 
if reasonable doubt exists as to the collection of interest or principal under the restructuring agreement. 
Nonaccrual TDRs are returned to accrual status when there is economic substance to the restructuring, 
there is well documented credit evaluation of the borrower’s financial condition, the remaining balance 
is reasonably assured of repayment in accordance with its modified terms, and the borrower has demon-
strated repayment performance in accordance with the modified terms for a reasonable period of time 
(generally a minimum of six months).

Nonperforming Assets

Nonperforming assets include loans on which interest is not being accrued, accruing loans that are 90 days 
or more delinquent and foreclosed property. Foreclosed property consists of real estate and other assets 
acquired as a result of a borrower’s loan default. Loans are generally placed on nonaccrual status when 
concern exists that principal or interest is not fully collectible, or when any portion of principal or interest 
becomes 90 days past due, whichever occurs first. Loans past due 90 days or more may remain on accrual 
status if management determines that concern over the collectability of principal and interest is not signif-
icant. When loans are placed on nonaccrual status, interest receivable is reversed against interest income 
in the current period. Interest payments received thereafter are applied as a reduction to the remaining 

97

2015 Form 10-Kprincipal balance as long as concern exists as to the ultimate collection of the principal. Loans are removed 
from nonaccrual status when they become current as to both principal and interest and when concern no 
longer exists as to the collectability of principal or interest.

Assets acquired as a result of foreclosure are initially recorded at fair value less estimated selling costs at 
the date of foreclosure, establishing a new cost basis. Subsequent to foreclosure, valuations are periodical-
ly performed by management and the assets are carried at the lower of carrying amount or fair value less 
cost to sell. Gains and losses on the sale of assets acquired through foreclosure and related revenue and 
expenses of these assets are included in noninterest expense in other real estate expenses, net.

Allowance for Loan Losses

The allowance for loan losses is a valuation allowance for probable incurred credit losses. Loan losses are 
charged against the allowance when management believes the uncollectibility of a loan balance is con-
firmed. Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance. Management estimates the allowance 
balance  required  using  past  loan  loss  experience,  the  nature  and  volume  of  the  portfolio,  information 
about specific borrower situations and estimated collateral values, economic conditions, and other factors. 
Allocations of the allowance may be made for specific loans, but the entire allowance is available for any 
loan that, in management’s judgment, should be charged off.

The allowance consists of specific and general components. The specific component relates to loans that 
are individually classified as impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable that 
the  Company  will  be  unable  to  collect  all  amounts  due  according  to  the  contractual  terms  of  the  loan 
agreement. Loans for which the terms have been modified resulting in a concession, and for which the 
borrower is experiencing financial difficulties, are considered troubled debt restructurings and classified 
as impaired. These analyses involve a high degree of judgment in estimating the amount of loss associated 
with	specific	loans,	including	estimating	the	amount	and	timing	of	future	cash	flows	and	collateral	values.	
Impaired	loans	are	evaluated	for	impairment	using	the	discounted	cash	flow	methodology	or	based	on	the	
net	realizable	value	of	the	underlying	collateral.	Impaired	loans	are	individually	reviewed	on	a	quarterly	
basis to determine the level of impairment.

Factors considered by management in determining impaired loans include payment status, collateral val-
ue,  and  the  probability  of  collecting  scheduled  principal  and  interest  payments  when  due.  Loans  that 
experience insignificant payment delays and payment shortfalls generally are not classified as impaired. 
Management  determines  the  significance  of  payment  delays  and  payment  shortfalls  on  a  case-by-case 
basis, taking into consideration all of the circumstances surrounding the loan and the borrower, including 
the length of the delay, the reasons for the delay, the borrower’s prior payment record, and the amount of 
the shortfall in relation to the principal and interest owed.

If a loan has impairment, a portion of the allowance is allocated so that the loan is reported, net, at the 
present	value	of	estimated	future	cash	flows	using	the	loan’s	existing	rate	or	at	the	fair	value	of	collateral	
if repayment is expected solely from the collateral. For collateral-dependent loans, the measurement of 
impairment was based on the net investment of the loan compared to the fair value of the collateral less 
estimated selling costs. In most cases, the fair value of the collateral was based on appraised value. When 
appropriate, the fair value was based on the probable sales price of the collateral when sale of the collat-
eral was imminent or contracted sales price if the collateral is subject to a binding sales contract as of the 
end of the quarter.

98

The general component covers non-impaired loans and is based on historical loss experience adjusted for 
current factors. The Company considers the actual loss history experience over the trailing twenty quarters 
to determine the historical loss experience used in the general component. This actual loss experience is 
supplemented with other economic factors based on the risks present for each portfolio segment. These 
economic  factors  include  consideration  of  the  following:  levels  of  and  trends  in  delinquencies  and  im-
paired loans; levels of and trends in charge-offs and recoveries for the most recent sixteen quarters; trends 
in volume and terms of loans; effects of any changes in risk selection and underwriting standards; other 
changes in lending policies, procedures, and practices; experience, ability, and depth of lending manage-
ment and other relevant staff; national and local economic trends and conditions; industry conditions; and 
effects of changes in credit concentrations.

While management uses the best information available to establish the allowance for loan losses, future 
adjustments to the allowance may be necessary if economic conditions differ substantially from the as-
sumptions used in making the valuations or, if required by regulators, based upon information available to 
them at the time of their examinations. Such adjustments to original estimates, as necessary, are made in 
the period in which these factors and other relevant considerations indicate that loss levels may vary from 
previous estimates.

Business Combinations and Method of Accounting for Loans Acquired

The Company accounts for its acquisitions under Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Ac-
counting Standards Codification (“ASC”) Topic 805, Business Combinations, which requires the use of the 
acquisition method of accounting. All identifiable assets acquired, including loans, are recorded at fair val-
ue. No allowance for loan losses related to the acquired loans is recorded on the acquisition date because 
the fair value of the loans acquired incorporates assumptions regarding credit risk. As provided for under 
GAAP,	management	has	up	to	twelve	months	following	the	date	of	the	acquisition	to	finalize	the	fair	val-
ues	of	acquired	assets	and	assumed	liabilities.	Once	management	has	finalized	the	fair	values	of	acquired	
assets and assumed liabilities within this twelve month period, management considers such values to be the 
day 1 fair values (“Day 1 Fair Values”).

There are two methods to account for acquired loans as part of a business combination. Acquired loans 
that contain evidence of credit deterioration on the date of purchase are carried at the net present value 
of expected future proceeds in accordance with ASC 310-30. All other acquired loans are recorded at their 
initial	fair	value,	adjusted	for	subsequent	advances,	pay	downs,	amortization	or	accretion	of	any	premium	
or discount on purchase, charge-offs and any other adjustment to carrying value in accordance with ASC 
310-20.

In determining the Day 1 Fair Values of acquired loans without evidence of credit deterioration at the date 
of acquisition, management includes (i) no carry over of any previously recorded allowance for loan losses 
and	(ii)	an	adjustment	of	the	unpaid	principal	balance	to	reflect	an	appropriate	market	rate	of	interest,	
given the risk profile and grade assigned to each loan. This adjustment will be accreted into earnings as a 
yield adjustment, using the effective yield method, over the remaining life of each loan.

To the extent that current information indicates it is probable that the Company will collect all amounts ac-
cording to the contractual terms thereof, such loan is not considered impaired and is not considered in the 
determination of the required allowance for loan losses. To the extent that current information indicates 
it is probable that the Company will not be able to collect all amounts according to the contractual terms 
thereon, such loan is considered impaired and is considered in the determination of the required level of 
allowance for loan and lease losses.

99

2015 Form 10-KCore Deposit Intangible

In connection with business combinations, the Company records core deposit intangibles, representing the 
value	of	the	acquired	core	deposit	base.	Core	deposit	intangibles	are	amortized	over	their	estimated	useful	
lives ranging up to 10 years.

Mortgage Servicing Rights, Fees and Costs

The Company initially measures servicing assets and liabilities retained related to the sale of residential 
loans held for sale (“mortgage servicing rights”) at fair value, if practicable. For subsequent measurement 
purposes, the Company measures servicing assets and liabilities based on the lower of cost or market using 
the	amortization	method.

Mortgage	servicing	rights	are	amortized	in	proportion	to,	and	over	the	period	of,	estimated	net	servicing	
income.	The	amortization	of	the	mortgage	servicing	rights	is	analyzed	periodically	and	is	adjusted	to	re-
flect	changes	in	prepayment	rates	and	other	estimates.

The Company evaluates potential impairment of mortgage servicing rights based on the difference be-
tween the carrying amount and current estimated fair value of the servicing rights. In determining impair-
ment, the Company aggregates all servicing rights and stratifies them into tranches based on predominant 
risk	characteristics.	If	impairment	exists,	a	valuation	allowance	is	established	for	any	excess	of	amortized	
cost over the current estimated fair value by a charge to income. If the Company later determines that all 
or a portion of the impairment no longer exists for a particular tranche, a reduction of the allowance may 
be recorded as an increase to income.

Service fee income is recorded for fees earned for servicing mortgage loans under servicing agreements 
with the Federal National Mortgage Association (“FNMA”), the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corpora-
tion (“FHLMC”), Government National Mortgage Association (“GNMA”) and certain private investors. 
The fees are based on a contractual percentage of the outstanding principal balance of the loans serviced 
and	 are	 recorded	 as	 income	 when	 received	 in	 noninterest	 income.	 Amortization	 of	 mortgage	 servicing	
rights and mortgage servicing costs are charged to expense when incurred.

Guarantees

Standby letters of credit obligate the Company to meet certain financial obligations of its customers, under 
the contractual terms of the agreement, if the customers are unable to do so. Payment is only guaranteed 
under  these  letters  of  credit  upon  the  borrower’s  failure  to  perform  its  obligations  to  the  beneficiary. 
The Company can seek recovery of the amounts paid from the borrower; however, these standby letters 
of	credit	are	generally	not	collateralized.	Commitments	under	standby	letters	of	credit	are	usually	one	
year or less. At December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company had recorded no liability for the current car-
rying amount of the obligation to perform as a guarantor; as such amounts are not considered material.  
The maximum potential amount of undiscounted future payments related to standby letters of credit at 
December 31, 2015 was $1.4 million.

Premises and Equipment, Net

Premises and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation. Depreciation is computed using 
the straight-line method over the asset’s estimated useful life. Estimated lives range up to forty years for 

100

buildings and improvements and up to ten years for furniture, fixtures and equipment. Maintenance and 
repairs are charged to expense as incurred. Improvements that extend the lives of the respective assets are 
capitalized.	When	property	or	equipment	is	sold	or	otherwise	disposed	of,	the	cost	and	related	accumu-
lated	depreciation	are	removed	from	the	respective	accounts	and	the	resulting	gain	or	loss	is	reflected	in	
income.

Advertising

The	Company	expenses	advertising	costs	as	incurred.	These	expenses	are	reflected	as	marketing	and	pub-
lic relations in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations.

Income Taxes

The provision for income taxes is based upon income or loss before taxes for financial statement purposes, 
adjusted for nontaxable income and nondeductible expenses. Deferred income taxes have been provided 
when different accounting methods have been used in determining income for income tax purposes and 
for	 financial	 reporting	 purposes.	 Deferred	 tax	 assets	 and	 liabilities	 are	 recognized	 based	 on	 future	 tax	
consequences  attributable  to  differences  arising  from  the  financial  statement  carrying  values  of  assets 
and liabilities and their tax bases. In the event of changes in the tax laws, deferred tax assets and liabilities 
are adjusted in the period of the enactment of those changes, with the cumulative effects included in the 
current year’s income tax provision.

Positions taken by the Company’s tax returns may be subject to challenge by the taxing authorities upon 
examination.	The	benefits	of	uncertain	tax	positions	are	initially	recognized	in	the	financial	statements	
only when it is more likely than not the position will be sustained upon examination by the tax authorities. 
Such tax positions are both initially and subsequently measured as the largest amount of tax benefit that 
is	greater	than	50%	likely	of	being	realized	upon	settlement	with	the	tax	authority,	assuming	full	knowl-
edge of the position and all relevant facts. The Company believes that its income tax filing positions taken 
or expected to be taken in its tax returns will more likely than not be sustained upon audit by the taxing 
authorities and does not anticipate any adjustments that will result in a material adverse impact on the 
Company’s	financial	condition,	results	of	operations,	or	cash	flow.	Therefore,	no	reserves	for	uncertain	
tax positions have been recorded. The Company’s federal income tax returns were examined for the years 
2008 through 2010. No changes were proposed.

Interest and penalties on income tax uncertainties are classified within income tax expense in the state-
ment  of  operations.  There  were  no  significant  interest  and  penalties  paid  on  income  tax  uncertainties 
during 2015 or 2014.

It	is	management’s	belief	that	the	realization	of	the	remaining	net	deferred	tax	assets	is	more	likely	than	
not. Accordingly, no additional reserve was considered necessary. See Note 13 for additional information.

Drafts Outstanding

The Company invests excess funds on deposit at other banks (including amounts on deposit for payment of 
outstanding disbursement checks) on a daily basis in an overnight interest-bearing account. Accordingly, 
outstanding checks are reported as a liability.

101

2015 Form 10-KReserve for Mortgage Loan Repurchase Losses

The Company sells mortgage loans to various third parties, including government-sponsored entities, un-
der contractual provisions that include various representations and warranties that typically cover own-
ership of the loan, compliance with loan criteria set forth in the applicable agreement, validity of the lien 
securing the loan, absence of delinquent taxes or liens against the property securing the loan, and similar 
matters. The Company may be required to repurchase the mortgage loans with identified defects, indem-
nify the investor or insurer, or reimburse the investor for credit loss incurred on the loan (collectively “re-
purchase”) in the event of a material breach of such contractual representations or warranties. Risk associ-
ated with potential repurchases or other forms of settlement is managed through underwriting and quality 
assurance practices and by servicing mortgage loans to meet investor and secondary market standards.

The Company establishes mortgage repurchase reserves related to various representations and warran-
ties	that	reflect	management’s	estimate	of	losses	based	on	a	combination	of	factors.	Such	factors	incor-
porate estimated levels of defects on internal quality assurance, default expectations, historical investor 
repurchase  demand  and  appeals  success  rates,  reimbursement  by  correspondent  and  other  third  party 
originators, changes in the regulatory repurchase framework and projected loss severity. The Company 
establishes a reserve at the time loans are sold and quarterly updates the reserve estimate during the esti-
mated loan life.

The following table presents activity in the reserve for mortgage loan repurchase losses:

Beginning Balance
  Losses paid
  Recoveries
  Provision for mortgage repurchase losses
Ending balance

Transfers of Financial Assets

December 31,

2015

2014

(In thousands)
4,999 
(165)
42 
(1,000)
3,876 

6,109 
(389)
29 
(750)
4,999 

$

$

Transfers of financial assets are accounted for as sales, when control over the assets has been surrendered. 
Control over transferred assets is deemed to be surrendered when (1) the assets have been isolated from 
the Company, (2) the transferee obtains the right (free of conditions that constrain it from taking advan-
tage of that right) to pledge or exchange the transferred assets, and (3) the Company does not maintain ef-
fective control over the transferred assets through an agreement to repurchase them before their maturity.

Off-Balance-Sheet Financial Instruments

In the ordinary course of business, the Company entered into off-balance-sheet financial instruments con-
sisting of commitments to extend credit, commitments under revolving credit agreements, and standby 
letters of credit. Such financial instruments are recorded in the financial statements when they are funded.

102

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
   
Stock Compensation Plans

The Company can issue stock options, restricted stock, and restricted stock units under various plans to 
directors, officers and other key employees. The Company accounts for its stock compensation plans in 
accordance with ASC Topics 718 and 505. Under those provisions, the Company has adopted a fair value 
based method of accounting for employee stock compensation plans, whereby compensation cost is mea-
sured	at	the	grant	date	based	on	the	value	of	the	award	and	is	recognized	on	a	straight-line	basis	over	the	
service period, which is usually the vesting period, taking into account retirement eligibility. As a result, 
compensation	expense	relating	to	stock	options	and	restricted	stock	is	reflected	in	net	income	as	part	of	
“salaries and employee benefits” on the consolidated statements of operations.

Earnings Per Common Share

Basic earnings per common share (“EPS”) represents income available to common stockholders’ divided 
by  the  weighted-average  number  of  common  shares  outstanding  during  the  year.  Diluted  earnings  per 
common	 share	 reflects	 additional	 shares	 that	 would	 have	 been	 outstanding	 if	 dilutive	 potential	 shares	
had been issued. Potential shares that may be issued by the Company relate solely to outstanding stock 
options, restricted stock (non-vested shares), and warrants, and are determined using the treasury stock 
method. Under the treasury stock method, the number of incremental shares is determined by assuming 
the issuance of stock for the outstanding stock options and warrants, reduced by the number of shares 
assumed to be repurchased from the issuance proceeds, using the average market price for the year of the 
Company’s stock. Weighted-average shares for the basic and diluted EPS calculations have been reduced 
by the average number of unvested restricted shares.

On January 15, 2014, the Board of Directors of the Company declared a two-for-one stock split to stock-
holders of record dated February 10, 2014, issued on February 28, 2014.

On October 15, 2014, the Board of Directors of the Company declared an additional two-for-one stock 
split to stockholders of record as of October 31, 2014, issued on November 14, 2014.

On June 22, 2015, the Board of Directors of the Company declared a six-for-five stock split representing a 
20% stock dividend to stockholders of record as of July 15, 2015, payable on July 31, 2015.

As	such,	all	share,	earnings	per	share,	and	per	share	data	have	been	retroactively	adjusted	to	reflect	the	
stock splits for all periods presented in accordance with GAAP.

Reclassification

Certain reclassifications of accounts reported for previous periods have been made in these consolidated 
financial statements. Such reclassifications had no effect on stockholders’ equity or the net income as pre-
viously reported.

Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements

In  January  2014,  the  Financial  Accounting  Standards  Board  (“FASB”)  amended  the  Receivables  topic 
of the Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”). The amendments are intended to resolve diversity in 
practice	with	respect	to	when	a	creditor	should	reclassify	a	collateralized	consumer	mortgage	loan	to	other	

103

2015 Form 10-Kreal	estate	owned	(“OREO”).	In	addition,	the	amendments	require	a	creditor	reclassify	a	collateralized	
consumer mortgage loan to OREO upon obtaining legal title to the real estate collateral, or the borrower 
voluntarily conveying all interest in the real estate property to the lender to satisfy the loan through a deed 
in lieu of foreclosure or similar legal agreement. The amendments were effective for the Company for 
annual periods, and interim periods within those annual periods beginning after December 15, 2014 with 
early implementation of the guidance permitted. In implementing this guidance, assets that are reclassi-
fied from real estate to loans are measured at the carrying value of the real estate at the date of adoption. 
Assets reclassified from loans to real estate are measured at the lower of the net amount of the loan re-
ceivable or the fair value of the real estate less costs to sell at the date of adoption. These amendments did 
not have a material effect on its financial statements.

In May 2014 and August 2015, the FASB issued guidance to change the recognition of revenue from con-
tracts	with	customers.	The	core	principle	of	the	new	guidance	is	that	an	entity	should	recognize	revenue	
to	 reflect	 the	 transfer	 of	 goods	 and	 services	 to	 customers	 in	 an	 amount	 equal	 to	 the	 consideration	 the	
entity receives or expects to receive. The guidance will be effective for the Company for reporting periods 
beginning after December 15, 2017. The Company will apply the guidance using a modified retrospective 
approach.  The  Company  does  not  expect  these  amendments  to  have  a  material  effect  on  its  financial 
statements.

In  June  2014,  the  FASB  issued  guidance  which  makes  limited  amendments  to  the  guidance  on  acco- 
unting  for  certain  repurchase  agreements.  The  new  guidance  (1)  requires  entities  to  account  for 
 repurchase-to-maturity  transactions  as  secured  borrowings  (rather  than  as  sales  with  forward  repur-
chase agreements), (2) eliminates accounting guidance on linked repurchase financing transactions, and  
(3) expands disclosure requirements related to certain transfers of financial assets that are accounted for 
as sales and certain transfers (specifically, repos, securities lending transactions, and repurchase-to-matu-
rity transactions) accounted for as secured borrowings. The amendments were effective for the Company 
for annual period beginning after December 15, 2014. These amendments did not have a material effect 
on its financial statements.

In June 2014, the FASB issued guidance which clarifies that performance targets associated with stock 
compensation	should	be	treated	as	a	performance	condition	and	should	not	be	reflected	in	the	grant	date	
fair value of the stock award. The amendments will be effective for the Company for fiscal years that begin 
after December 15, 2015. The Company will apply the guidance to stock awards with performance targets 
that are outstanding at the start of the first fiscal year in the financial statements and to all stock awards 
that are granted or modified after the effective date. The Company does not expect these amendments to 
have a material effect on its financial statements.

In January 2015, the FASB issued guidance that eliminated the concept of extraordinary items from GAAP. 
Existing GAAP required that an entity separately classify, present, and disclose extraordinary events and 
transactions. The amendments will eliminate the requirements for reporting entities to consider whether 
an underlying event or transaction is extraordinary, however, the presentation and disclosure guidance 
for items that are unusual in nature or occur infrequently will be retained and will be expanded to include 
items that are both unusual in nature and infrequently occurring. The amendments are effective for fis-
cal years, and interim periods within those fiscal years, beginning after December 15, 2015. The amend-
ments may be applied either prospectively or retrospectively to all prior periods presented in the financial 
statements. Early adoption is permitted provided that the guidance is applied from the beginning of the 
fiscal year of adoption. The Company does not expect these amendments to have a material effect on its 
 financial statements.

104

In February 2015, the FASB issued guidance which amends the consolidation requirements and signifi-
cantly changes the consolidation analysis required under GAAP. Although the amendments are expected 
to  result  in  the  deconsolidation  of  many  entities,  the  Company  will  need  to  reevaluate  all  its  previous 
consolidation conclusions. The amendments will be effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within 
those fiscal years, beginning after December 15, 2015 with early adoption permitted (including during an 
interim period), provided that the guidance is applied as of the beginning of the annual period containing 
the adoption date. The Company does not expect these amendments to have a material effect on its finan-
cial statements.

In August 2015, the FASB issued amendments to the Interest topic of the Accounting Standards Codifica-
tion to clarify the SEC staff’s position on presenting and measuring debt issuance costs incurred in connec-
tion with line-of-credit arrangements. The amendments were effective upon issuance. The amendments 
did not have a material effect on the financial statements

In January 2016, the FASB amended the Financial Instruments topic of the Accounting Standards Cod-
ification  to  address  certain  aspects  of  recognition,  measurement,  presentation,  and  disclosure  of  finan-
cial instruments. The amendments will be effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2017, 
including interim periods within those fiscal years. The Company will apply the guidance by means of a 
cumulative-effect adjustment to the balance sheet as of the beginning of the fiscal year of adoption. The 
amendments related to equity securities without readily determinable fair values will be applied prospec-
tively to equity investments that exist as of the date of adoption of the amendments. The Company does 
not expect these amendments to have a material effect on its financial statements.

In February 2016, the FASB issued new guidance to change accounting for leases and that will generally 
require	most	leases	to	be	recognized	on	the	balance	sheet.	The	new	lease	standard	only	contains	targeted	
changes	to	accounting	by	lessors,	however,	lessees	will	be	required	to	recognize	most	leases	in	their	bal-
ance sheets as lease liabilities for lease payments and right-of-use assets representing the lessee’s rights 
to use the underlying assets for the lease terms for lease arrangements longer than 12 months. Under this 
approach, a lessee will account for most existing capital/finance leases as Type A leases and most exist-
ing operating leases as Type B leases. Type A and Type B leases have unique accounting and disclosure 
requirements. Existing sale-leaseback guidance, including guidance for real estate, will be replaced with 
a  new  model  applicable  to  both  lessees  and  lessors.  The  new  guidance  will  be  effective  for  fiscal  years 
beginning	 after	 December	 15,	 2018.	 Early	 adoption	 is	 permitted	 for	 all	 companies	 and	 organizations.	
Management	is	currently	analyzing	the	impact	of	the	adoption	of	this	guidance	on	the	Company’s	consoli-
dated financial statements, including assessing changes that might be necessary to information technology 
systems, processes and internal controls to capture new data and address changes in financial reporting.

Other accounting standards that have been issued or proposed by the FASB or other standards-setting 
bodies are not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s financial position, results of opera-
tions	or	cash	flows.

Risks and Uncertainties

In the normal course of its business, the Company encounters two significant types of risks: economic and 
regulatory. There are three main components of economic risk: interest rate risk, credit risk, and market 
risk. The Company is subject to interest rate risk to the degree that its interest-bearing liabilities mature 
or re-price at different speeds, or on a different basis, than its interest-earning assets. Credit risk is the risk 
of default on the loan portfolio or certain securities that results from borrowers’ inability or unwillingness 

105

2015 Form 10-Kto	make	contractually	required	payments.	Market	risk	reflects	changes	in	the	value	of	collateral	underlying	
loans receivable and the valuation of real estate held by the Company. The Company is subject to the reg-
ulations of various governmental agencies. These regulations can and do change significantly from period 
to period. Periodic examinations by the regulatory agencies may subject the Company to further changes 
with respect to asset valuations, amounts of required loss allowances and operating restrictions from the 
regulators’ judgments based on information available to them at the time of their examination.

NOTE 2 - BUSINESS COMBINATION

On December 12, 2014, CresCom Bank purchased 13 branches from First Community Bank. In accor-
dance with the Purchase and Assumption Agreement, dated as of August 6, 2014, by and between First 
Community Bank and CresCom Bank (the “P&A Agreement”), CresCom Bank acquired approximately 
$215.1 million of deposits, approximately $70.9 million of performing loans and the bank facilities and 
certain other assets of the acquired branches. In consideration of the purchased assets and transferred lia-
bilities, CresCom Bank paid (a) the recorded investment of the loans acquired, (b) the net book value, or 
approximately $6.6 million, for the bank facilities and certain assets located at the acquired branches, (c) 
a deposit premium of 3.25% on substantially all of the deposits assumed, which equated to approximately 
$6.5 million. The acquisition settled by First Community Bank paying cash of $131.1 million to CresCom 
Bank for the difference between these amounts and the total deposits assumed.

The purchase was accounted for under the acquisition method in accordance  with  ASC  805,  “Business 
Combinations,” and accordingly the assets and liabilities were recorded at their fair values on the date of 
acquisition. Determining the fair value of assets and liabilities, especially the loan portfolio, is a complicat-
ed process involving significant judgment regarding methods and assumptions used to calculate estimated 
fair values. Fair values are preliminary and subject to refinement for up to one year after the closing date 
of the acquisition as information relative to closing date fair values become available. We made no adjust-
ments to our Day 1 fair values during 2015.

The	following	table	summarizes	the	estimated	fair	values	of	assets	acquired	and	liabilities	assumed	at	the	
date of acquisition.

December 12, 2014

  Acquired Book Value    Fair Value Adjustments 

(In thousands)

(In thousands)

 Amount Recorded 
(In thousands)  

Assets
  Cash and cash equivalents  
  Loans receivable
  Premises and equipment
  Accrued interest receivable 
  Core deposit intangible
  Other assets

  Total assets acquired

Liabilities
  Deposits
  Accrued interest payable
  Other liabilities

$

$

$

  Total liabilities assumed  

$

131,135 
70,906 
6,608 
158 
— 
53 
208,860 

  $

  $

215,121 
42 
34 
215,197 

  $

  $

106

— 

  $
(940) (1)   
4,102 (2)    

— 

3,175 (3)    

— 
6,337 

— 
— 
— 
— 

  $

  $

  $

131,135 
69,966 
10,710 
158 
3,175 
53 
215,197 

215,121 
42 
34 
215,197 

 
 
   
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
Explanation of Fair Value Adjustments

(1)   The fair value adjustment on loans relates to the interest rate and credit adjustments ap-
plied	to	the	loan	portfolio.	The	interest	rate	adjustment	is	calculated	by	analyzing	the	gain	
or loss based on movements in interest rates since origination of loans within the portfolio. 
The	credit	adjustment	utilizes	assumptions	regarding	the	underlying	probability	of	default	
and loss given default of the loan portfolio by risk characteristics such as risk grade and 
segment type. The combination of these adjustments will be accreted into earnings as a 
yield adjustment, using the effective yield method, over the remaining life of each loan. 
The Company hired an independent consulting firm to assist in the determination of the 
fair value of the loan portfolio.

(2)   The fair value adjustment represents the difference between the fair value of the acquired 
branches	and	the	book	value	of	the	assets	acquired.	The	Company	utilized	third	party	ap-
praisals to assist in the determination of the fair value.

(3)   The fair value adjustment represents the value of the core deposit base assumed in the 
acquisition based on a study performed by an independent consulting firm. This amount 
was	recorded	by	the	Company	as	an	identifiable	intangible	asset	and	will	be	amortized	as	
an expense on a straight-line basis over the average life of the core deposit base, which is 
estimated to be 10 years.

The	following	table	presents	loans	acquired	at	the	acquisition	date	summarized	by	category:

Loans secured by real estate:
  One-to-four family
  Home equity
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and development
Consumer loans
Commercial business loans
  Total loans receivable, at fair value

At December 12, 2014

    % of Total  

Amount

Loans
(Dollars in thousands)

  $

  $

20,675   
3,833   
18,179   
20,926   
3,220   
3,133   
69,966   

29.55%
5.48%
25.98%
29.91%
4.60%
4.48%
100.00%

As stated in Note 1 under “Business Combination and Method of Accounting for Loans Acquired”, all 
identifiable assets acquired, including loans, are recorded at fair value. No allowance for loan losses relat-
ed to the acquired loans is recorded on the acquisition date because the fair value of the loans acquired 
incorporates assumptions regarding credit risk.

107

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The following table presents deposits acquired at the acquisition date by type of account:

Noninterest-bearing demand accounts
Interest-bearing demand accounts
Savings accounts
Money market accounts
Certificates of deposit:
  Less than $100,000
  $100,000 or more
Total certificates of deposit

  Total deposits

 At December 12, 2014 
(In thousands)

 $

 $

43,910 
43,743 
13,715 
51,415 

33,394 
28,944 
62,338 
215,121 

Included in non-interest expense for the period ended December 31, 2014 was approximately $1.4 million 
in acquisition related expenses of which $880,000 was included in Other, $90,000 was included Marketing 
and Public Relations, $242,000 was included in Occupancy and Equipment and $149,000 was included in 
Salaries and Employee Benefits.

As the transaction occurred on December 12, 2014, the amount of revenue and earnings included in the 
consolidated income statement were deemed immaterial. Furthermore, it was concluded that it would be 
impracticable to provide revenue and earnings of the combined entity as if the acquisition date for the 
business combination had been as of the beginning of the annual reporting period for several reasons. 
The branches acquired were only a portion of the seller’s branch network; therefore, historical and pro 
forma	statements	of	revenue	and	earnings	for	the	branches	acquired	would	not	accurately	reflect	all	of	the	
overhead and other administrative expenses associated with operating them as a stand-alone branch net-
work. Also, the loans acquired only represent a sub-set of the loans as the remaining loans not purchased 
were still subject to loss-share protection (cannot be sold). Finally, the seller would not be able to provide 
accurate, historical information regarding the revenue and earnings of the acquired branches to facilitate 
appropriate presentation. As such, no historical or pro forma financial statements are provided.

On February 21, 2014, the Bank completed the acquisition of one branch in St. George from First Federal 
of South Carolina in a transaction that had been announced on August 28, 2013. The Bank added approx-
imately $24.5 million in deposits and $11.2 million in loans receivable as a result of this branch acquisition. 
Business combination accounting resulted in an immaterial effect on the balance sheet and income state-
ment of the Company.

There are two methods to account for acquired loans as part of a business combination. Acquired loans 
that contain evidence of credit deterioration on the date of purchase are carried at the net present val-
ue  of  expected  future  proceeds  in  accordance  with  Financial  Accounting  Standards  Board  Accounting 
Standards Codification (“ASC”) 310-30. All other acquired loans are recorded at their initial fair value, 
adjusted	for	subsequent	advances,	pay	downs,	amortization	or	accretion	of	any	premium	or	discount	on	
purchase, charge-offs and any other adjustment to carrying value in accordance with ASC 310-20. All loans 
acquired as part of the branch acquisitions were accounted for under ASC 310-20, as the loans acquired 
did not have signs of deteriorated credit and the Company expects to receive all of the contractually spec-
ified principal and interest payments.

108

 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
 
 
  
   
NOTE 3 - CORE DEPOSIT INTANGIBLES

In connection with business combinations, the Company records core deposit intangibles, representing the 
value of the acquired core deposit base. As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, core deposit intangible was 
$3.0	million	and	$3.3	million,	respectively.	Core	deposit	intangibles	are	amortized	straight	line	ranging	up	
to ten years.

Amortization	expense	(in	thousands)	for	core	deposit	intangible	is	expected	to	be	as	follows.

Year 1
Year 2
Year 3
Year 4
Year 5
Thereafter
Total

 $

343 
343 
343 
343 
343 
   1,246 
 $ 2,961 

Amortization	expense	of	$343,000	and	$47,000	related	to	the	core	deposit	intangible	was	recognized	in	
2015 and 2014, respectively.

NOTE 4 - SECURITIES

The	amortized	cost,	gross	unrealized	gains,	gross	unrealized	losses	and	fair	value	of	investments	securities	
available-for-sale and held-to-maturity at December 31, 2015 and 2014 follows:

2015

    Gross

    Gross

2014

    Gross

    Gross

At December 31,

  Amortized     Unrealized     Unrealized     Fair

    Amortized     Unrealized    Unrealized    Fair

Cost

    Gains

    Losses

    Value    

Cost

    Gains

    Losses

    Value  

(In thousands)

Securities available-for- 

sale:

  $
Municipal securities
US government agencies   
Collateralized	loan	 

obligations

Mortgage-backed  

securities:

  Agency
  Non-agency
  Total mortgage-

backed 
securities
Trust preferred 
securities

  Total
Securities held-to- 

maturity:

Municipal securities
Trust preferred 
securities

  Total

60,603     
7,015     

1,885     
81     

(13)    62,475     
7,096     
—     

43,119     
4,770     

1,621     
—     

(23)     44,717 
4,748 
(22)    

38,957     

8     

(207)    38,758     

25,883     

11     

(22)     25,872 

112,608     
75,415     

1,370     
580     

(123)    113,855     
(459)    75,536     

122,727     
49,936     

2,856     
1,065     

(41)     125,542 
(163)     50,838 

188,023     

1,950     

(582)    189,391     

172,663     

3,921     

(204)     176,380 

11,374     
305,972     

  $

1,145     
5,069     

(3,765)   
8,754     
(4,567)    306,474     

—     
246,435     

—     
5,553     

—     

— 
(271)     251,717 

  $

17,053     

912     

—      17,965     

16,787     

882     

(17)     17,652 

—     
17,053     

  $

—     
912     

—     
—     
—      17,965     

8,757     
25,544     

3,125     
4,007     

(2,149)    
9,733 
(2,166)     27,385 

109

2015 Form 10-K  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
   
   
   
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
   
   
   
   
   
   
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
   
   
As of December 31, 2014, the Company had all trust preferred securities classified as held-to-maturity. As 
a result of the implementation of the regulatory changes in risk weightings and capital deductions dictated 
by Basel III, the Company transferred all trust preferred securities to available-for-sale during 2015. The 
transfer  was  in  accordance  with  ASC  320-10-25-6;  therefore,  management  has  determined  the  transfer 
out of held-to-maturity is consistent with the original designation and does not taint the remaining portfo-
lio.	The	amortized	cost	of	the	securities	reclassified	to	available-for-sale	from	held-to-maturity	was	$11.4	
million.	The	net	unrealized	gains	recorded	in	other	comprehensive	income	during	2015	as	result	of	this	
reclassification were approximately $1.0 million.

The	following	table	presents	unrealized	losses	related	to	the	trust	preferred	securities	that	were	recog-
nized	within	other	comprehensive	income	at	the	time	of	transfer	to	held-to-maturity	as	well	as	the	unreal-
ized	gains	and	losses	that	are	not	presented	in	other	comprehensive	income	for	December	31,	2014.

At December 31, 2014

    Recognized in    
OCI
    Gross Unrealized   

    Not Recognized    
in OCI
    Gross Unrealized   

  Purchased    Cumula-   

    Estimated    Collateral-

Face
  Value

tive

    Carrying   

    OTTI     Value     Gains     Losses    

    Amortized   
Cost

Fair
    Gains     Losses     Value

ization

    Percentage

(In thousands)

Held-to-Maturity:   
Trust Preferred 
Securities
  Total A-Class
  Total B-Class
  Total C-Class

  $

  $

2,381     
11,718     
2,727     
16,826     

—     
(2,635)    
(1,340)    

2,381      —     
9,083      —     
1,387      —     

(558)    
(2,458)    
(1,078)    

1,823     
336   
6,625      1,788   
309      1,001   

(75)    
  (2,074)    
—     

2,084      17 5% - 3 7 8% 
9 6% - 111% 
6,339     
9 2% - 9 2% 
1,310     

(3,975)     12,851      —     

(4,094)    

8,757      3,125   

  (2,149)    

9,733     

The underlying issuers in the pools were primarily financial institutions and to a lesser extent, insurance 
companies	 and	 real	 estate	 investment	 trusts.	 The	 Company	 owns	 both	 senior	 and	 mezzanine	 tranches	
in pooled trust preferred securities; however, the Company does not own any income notes. The senior 
and	mezzanine	tranches	of	trust	preferred	collateralized	debt	obligations	generally	have	some	protection	
from	defaults	in	the	form	of	over-collateralization	and	excess	spread	revenues,	along	with	waterfall	struc-
tures	that	redirect	cash	flows	in	the	event	certain	coverage	test	requirements	are	failed.	Generally,	senior	
tranches	have	the	greatest	protection,	with	mezzanine	tranches	subordinated	to	the	senior	tranches,	and	
income	notes	subordinated	to	the	mezzanine	tranches.	Unrealized	losses	recognized	in	other	comprehen-
sive	income	relate	to	unrealized	losses	at	the	time	of	transfer	from	available-for-sale	to	held-to-maturity	
and are accreted in accordance with GAAP.

As  of  December  31,  2015,  $0.8  million  of  the  pooled  trust  preferred  securities  were  investment  grade 
and $8.0 million were below investment grade. As of December 31, 2014, $0.9 million of the pooled trust 
preferred securities were investment grade, $1.0 million were split-rated, and the remaining $6.9 million 
were below investment grade. In terms of risk-based capital calculation, the Company allocates additional 
risk-based capital to the below investment grade securities.

110

 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
   
 
   
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
   
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
       
       
       
       
       
     
 
       
       
   
   
       
       
       
       
       
       
     
 
       
       
   
 
   
   
 
 
   
 
   
       
       
       
       
       
       
     
 
       
       
   
As of December 31, 2015, senior tranches represent $764,000 of the Company’s pooled securities, while 
mezzanine	tranches	represented	$8.0	million.	All	of	the	$8.0	million	in	mezzanine	tranches	are	still	sub-
ordinate	to	senior	tranches	as	the	senior	notes	have	not	been	paid	to	a	zero	balance.	As	of	December	31,	
2014,	senior	tranches	represent	$1.8	million	of	the	Company’s	pooled	securities,	while	mezzanine	tranch-
es	represented	$7.0	million.	All	of	the	$7.0	million	in	mezzanine	tranches	are	still	subordinate	to	senior	
tranches	as	the	senior	notes	have	not	been	paid	to	a	zero	balance.

The	amortized	cost	and	fair	value	of	debt	securities	by	contractual	maturity	at	December	31,	2015	follows:

Securities available-for-sale:
One to five years
Six to ten years
After ten years
Total
Securities held-to-maturity:
One to five years
Six to ten years
After ten years
Total

2015

Amortized    

Cost

Fair
Value

(In thousands)

$

$

$

$

264   
30,453   
275,255   
305,972   

430   
4,397   
12,226   
17,053   

269 
30,736 
275,469 
306,474 

441 
4,482 
13,042 
17,965 

The contractual maturity dates of the securities were used for this table. No estimates were made to antic-
ipate principal repayments.

Sales of investment securities available-for-sale for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014 are as 
follows.

Proceeds
Realized	gains
Realized	losses
  Total investment securities gains, net

For the Years
Ended December 31,
2015
2014

(In thousands)

$

$

105,840   
1,639   
(146) 
1,493   

74,901 
1,251 
(167)
1,084 

At December 31, 2015, the Company has pledged $76.4 million of securities for FHLB advances. See Note 
11 – Short-Term Borrowed Funds for further discussion.

At December 31, 2015, the Company has pledged $13.4 million of securities to secure public agency funds.

111

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The	gross	unrealized	losses	and	fair	value	of	the	Company’s	investments	available-for-sale	with	unrealized	
losses that are not deemed to be other-than-temporarily impaired, aggregated by investment category and 
length	of	time	that	individual	securities	have	been	in	a	continuous	unrealized	loss	position,	at	December	
31, 2015 are as follows:

Less than 12 Months

Total
  Amortized    Fair     Unrealized    Amortized    Fair     Unrealized    Amortized    Fair
  Cost

    Value     Losses

    Cost

    Cost

    Unrealized 

    Value     Losses

At December 31, 2015
12 Months or Greater

    Value     Losses
(In thousands)

Available-for-sale:
Municipal securities
Collateralized	loan	

obligations

  $

2,579      2,566     

(13)   

—      —     

—     

2,579     

2,566     

(13)

24,289      24,130     

(159)   

9,706      9,658     

(48)   

33,995      33,788     

(207)

Mortgage-backed securities:    
  Agency
  Non-agency
  Total mortgage-backed 

22,528      22,416     
27,724      27,432     

(112)   
(292)   

804     

793     
12,242      12,075     

(11)   
(167)   

23,332      23,209     
39,966      39,507     

securities

Trust preferred securities

  Total

50,252      49,848     
—      —     
77,120      76,544     

  $

(404)   
—     
(576)   

13,046      12,868     
8,803      5,038     
31,555      27,564     

(178)   
(3,765)   
(3,991)   

63,298      62,716     
5,038     
8,803     
108,675      104,108     

(123)
(459)

(582)
(3,765)
(4,567)

The	gross	unrealized	losses	and	fair	value	of	the	Company’s	investments	available-for-sale	and	held-to- 
maturity	with	unrealized	losses	that	are	not	deemed	to	be	other-than-temporarily	impaired,	aggregated	by	
investment	category	and	length	of	time	that	individual	securities	have	been	in	a	continuous	unrealized	loss	
position, at December 31, 2014 are as follows:

At December 31, 2014
12 Months or Greater
  Amortized    Fair     Unrealized    Amortized    Fair     Unrealized    Amortized    Fair     Unrealized 

Less than 12 Months

Total

Available-for-sale:
Municipal securities
US government agencies
Collateralized	loan	obligations   
Mortgage-backed securities:

  $

  Agency
  Non-agency

  Total mortgage-backed  

  securities

  Total

Held-to-maturity -
Municipal securities
Trust preferred securities
  Total

  $

  $

  $

Cost

    Value     Losses

Cost

    Value    Losses

Cost

    Value     Losses

2,479      2,475     
4,770      4,748     
14,708      14,686     

17,541      17,500     
14,284      14,138     

31,825      31,638     
53,782      53,547     

(4) 
(22) 
(22) 

(41) 
(146) 

(187) 
(235) 

(In thousands)

1,504      1,485     
—      —     
—      —     

—      —     
3,114      3,097     

3,114      3,097     
4,618      4,582     

(19)  
—   
—   

—   
(17)  

(17)  
(36)  

3,983      3,960     
4,770      4,748     
14,708      14,686     

17,541      17,500     
17,398      17,235     

34,939      34,735     
58,400      58,129     

(23)
(22)
(22)

(41)
(163)

(204)
(271)

—      —     
—      —     
—      —     

—   
—   
—   

2,363      2,346     
7,326      5,177     
9,689      7,523     

(17)  
(2,149)  
(2,166)  

2,363      2,346     
7,326      5,177     
9,689      7,523     

(17)
(2,149)
(2,166)

The  Company  reviews  its  investment  securities  portfolio  at  least  quarterly  and  more  frequently  when 
economic conditions warrant, assessing whether there is any indication of other-than-temporary impair-
ment	(“OTTI”).	Factors	considered	in	the	review	include	estimated	future	cash	flows,	length	of	time	and	

112

 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
   
   
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
       
     
 
       
       
     
 
       
       
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
       
       
     
 
       
       
     
 
       
       
   
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
       
       
     
 
       
       
     
 
       
       
   
   
       
       
     
 
       
       
     
 
       
       
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
extent to which market value has been less than cost, the financial condition and near term prospect of 
the issuer, and our intent and ability to retain the security to allow for an anticipated recovery in market 
value.	If	the	review	determines	that	there	 is	OTTI,	then	 an	impairment	loss	is	recognized	in	earnings	
equal to the difference between the investment’s cost and its fair value at the balance sheet date of the 
reporting	period	for	which	the	assessment	is	made,	or	a	portion	may	be	recognized	in	other	comprehen-
sive	income.	The	fair	value	of	investments	on	which	OTTI	is	recognized	then	becomes	the	new	cost	basis	
of the investment.

At December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company had 45 and 26, respectively, individual investments avail-
able-for-sale	 that	 were	 in	 an	 unrealized	 loss	 position.	 The	 unrealized	 losses	 on	 the	 Company’s	 invest-
ments in US government-sponsored agencies, municipal securities, mortgage-backed securities (agency 
and	non-agency),	and	trust	preferred	securities	summarized	above	were	attributable	primarily	to	changes	
in	interest	rates.	Management	has	performed	various	analyses,	including	cash	flows	as	needed,	and	deter-
mined that no OTTI expense was necessary during 2015 or 2014.

The Company had 1 municipal security and 4 trust preferred securities within the held-to-maturity portfo-
lio	that	were	in	an	unrealized	loss	position	at	December	31,	2014.	There	were	no	securities	held-to-matu-
rity	in	an	unrealized	loss	position	at	December	31,	2015.

To	determine	the	fair	value	for	trust	preferred	securities,	cash	flow	models	are	provided	by	a	third-party	
pricing	service.	Impairment	testing	is	performed	on	a	quarterly	basis	using	a	detailed	cash	flow	analysis	
for each security. The major assumptions used during the impairment test are described in the subsequent 
paragraph.

In 2009, the Company adopted a four year “burst” scenario for its modeled default rates (2010 - 2015) 
that replicated the default rates for the banking industry from the four peak years of the Savings and Loan 
crisis,  which  then  reduced  to  0.25%  annually.  The  last  year  of  the  elevated  default  rate  was  2014.  The 
constant default rate used by the Company is now 0.25% annually. All issuers that were currently in de-
ferral were presumed to be in default. Additionally, all defaults are assumed to have a 15% recovery after 
two years and 1% of the pool is presumed to prepay annually. If this analysis results in a present value of 
expected	cash	flows	that	is	less	than	the	book	value	of	a	security	(that	is,	a	credit	loss	exists),	an	OTTI	is	
considered to have occurred. If there is no credit loss, any impairment is considered temporary. The cash 
flow	analysis	we	performed	used	discount	rates	equal	to	the	credit	spread	at	the	time	of	purchase	for	each	
security and then added the current 3-month LIBOR forward interest rate curve.

Management believes that there are no additional securities other-than-temporarily impaired at Decem-
ber 31, 2015. The Company does not intend to sell these securities and it is more likely than not that the 
Company	will	not	be	required	to	sell	these	securities	before	recovery	of	their	amortized	cost.	Management	
continues to monitor these securities with a high degree of scrutiny. There can be no assurance that the 
Company will not conclude in future periods that conditions existing at that time indicate some or all of 
the securities may be sold or are other-than-temporarily impaired, which would require a charge to earn-
ings in such periods.

113

2015 Form 10-KThe following table presents detail of non-marketable investments at December 31, 2015 and 2014.

Community Reinvestment Act fund
SBIC Investments
Investment in Statutory Business Trusts
  Total other investments
Federal Home Loan Bank stock
  Non-marketable investments

At December 31,

2015

2014

(In thousands)
1,295 
1,513 
465 
3,273 
9,919 
13,192 

1,277 
567 
465 
2,309 
5,405 
7,714 

$

$

The Company, as a member of the FHLB, is required to own capital stock in the FHLB based generally 
upon a membership-based requirement and an activity-based requirement. FHLB capital stock is pledged 
to secure FHLB advances. No secondary market exists for this stock, and it has no quoted market price. 
However, redemption through the FHLB of this stock has historically been at par value.

For additional information regarding the investments in statutory business trust, see Note 12-Long Term 
Debt.

NOTE 5 - DERIVATIVES

In the ordinary course of business, the Company enters into various types of derivative transactions. The 
Company’s primary uses of derivative instruments are related to the mortgage banking activities. As such, 
the Company holds derivative instruments, which consist of rate lock agreements related to expected fund-
ing of fixed-rate mortgage loans to customers (interest rate lock commitments) and forward commitments 
to sell mortgage-backed securities and individual fixed-rate mortgage loans. The Company’s objective in 
obtaining the forward commitments is to mitigate the interest rate risk associated with the interest rate 
lock commitments and the mortgage loans that are held for sale. Derivative instruments not related to 
mortgage banking activities primarily relate to interest rate swap agreements.

114

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
   
The derivative positions of the Company at December 31, 2015 and 2014 are as follows:

At December 31,

2015

2014

Fair  
Value  

  Notional 
Value  

Fair
  Value  

  Notional 
  Value  

(In thousands)

$ 180 

    30,000 

— 

— 

  1,246 
340 

    143,318 
    31,513 

    1,122 
567 

    106,440 
    27,292 

179 
$ 1,945 

    105,014 
    309,845 

— 
    1,689 

— 
    133,732 

$ 306 

    10,000 

530 

    20,000 

  — 
$ 306 

— 
    10,000 

506 
    1,036 

    93,000 
    113,000 

Derivative assets:
	 Cash	flow	hedges:

  Interest rate swaps
  Non-hedging derivatives:

  Mortgage loan interest rate lock commitments
  Mortgage loan forward sales commitments
  Mortgage-backed securities forward sales  

  commitments
Total derivative assets

Derivative liabilities:
  Non-hedging derivatives:
  Interest rate swaps
  Mortgage-backed securities forward sales  

  commitments
Total derivative liabilities

Non-Designated Hedges

Derivative Loan Commitments and Forward Sales Commitments

The Company enters into mortgage loan commitments that are also referred to as derivative loan commit-
ments, if the loan that will result from exercise of the commitment will be held for sale upon funding. The 
Company enters into commitments to fund residential mortgage loans at specified rates and times in the 
future, with the intention that these loans will subsequently be sold in the secondary market.

Outstanding  derivative  loan  commitments  expose  the  Company  to  the  risk  that  the  price  of  the  loans 
arising from exercise of the loan commitment might decline from inception of the rate lock to funding of 
the loan due to increases in mortgage interest rates. If interest rates increase, the value of these loan com-
mitments typically decreases. Conversely, if interest rates decrease, the value of these loan commitments 
typically increases.

To	 protect	 against	 the	 price	 risk	 inherent	 in	 derivative	 loan	 commitments,	 the	 Company	 utilizes	 both	
“mandatory delivery” and “best efforts” forward loan sale commitments to mitigate the risk of potential 
decreases in the values of loans that would result from the exercise of the derivative loan commitments.

With  a  “mandatory  delivery”  contract,  the  Company  commits  to  deliver  a  certain  principal  amount  of 
mortgage loans to an investor at a specified price on or before a specified date. If the Company fails to 
deliver the amount of mortgages necessary to fulfill the commitment by the specified date, it is obligated 

115

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
to pay a “pair-off” fee, based on then-current market prices, to the investor to compensate the investor 
for the shortfall.

With a “best efforts” contract, the Company commits to deliver an individual mortgage loan of a specified 
principal amount and quality to an investor if the loan to the underlying borrower closes. Generally, the 
price the investor will pay the seller for an individual loan is specified prior to the loan being funded (e.g., 
on the same day the lender commits to lend funds to a potential borrower). The Company expects that 
these forward loan sale commitments will experience changes in fair value opposite to the change in fair 
value of derivative loan commitments.

Derivatives related to these commitments are recorded as either a derivative asset or a derivative liability 
on the balance sheet and are measured at fair value. Both the interest rate lock commitments and the 
forward commitments are reported at fair value, with adjustments recorded in current period earnings 
in mortgage banking income within the noninterest income in the consolidated statements of operations.

Interest Rate Swaps

The Company enters into interest rate swaps that do not meet the hedge accounting requirements and 
are recorded at fair value as a derivative asset or liability. Interest rate swaps that are not designated as 
hedges are primarily used to more closely match the interest rate characteristics of assets and liabilities 
and to mitigate the risks arising from timing mismatches between assets and liabilities including duration 
mismatches.	Fair	value	changes	are	recognized	in	noninterest	income	as	“fair	value	adjustment	on	interest	
rate swaps”. As of December 31, 2015, the Company had two outstanding stand-alone interest rate deriv-
atives with a notional value of $10.0 million and a weighted average remaining term of 7.18 years.

Cash Flow Hedges of Interest Rate Risk

The Company’s objectives in using certain interest rate derivatives are to add stability to interest expense and 
to manage its exposure to interest rate movements. To accomplish this objective, the Company uses interest 
rate	swaps	as	part	of	its	interest	rate	risk	management	strategy.	Interest	rate	swaps	designated	as	cash	flow	
hedges involve the receipt of variable amounts from a counterparty in exchange for the Company making 
fixed-rate payments over the life of the agreements without exchange of the underlying notional amount.

The Company has entered into forward starting interest rate swaps to reduce the exposure to variability 
in	interest-related	cash	outflows	attributable	to	changes	in	forecasted	LIBOR	based	FHLB	borrowings.	
These	derivative	instruments	are	designated	as	cash	flow	hedges.	The	hedged	item	is	the	LIBOR	portion	
of the series of future short-term fixed rate borrowings over the term of the interest rate swap. Accord-
ingly,	changes	to	the	amount	of	interest	payment	cash	flows	for	the	hedged	transactions	attributable	to	
a change in credit risk are excluded from our assessment of hedge effectiveness. The Company tests for 
hedging effectiveness on a quarterly basis. The effective portion of changes in the fair value of derivatives 
designated	and	that	qualify	as	cash	flow	hedges	is	recorded	in	accumulated	other	comprehensive	income	
and is subsequently reclassified into earnings in the period that the hedged forecasted transaction affects 
earnings.	The	ineffective	portion	of	the	change	in	fair	value	of	the	derivatives	is	recognized	directly	in	
earnings. The Company has not recorded any hedge ineffectiveness since inception.

As of December 31, 2015, the Company had two outstanding interest rate derivatives with a notional val-
ue	of	$30.0	million	that	were	designated	as	cash	flow	hedges	of	interest	rate	risk	with	a	weighted	average	
remaining term of 9.84 years.

116

Risk Management Objective of Using Derivatives

When	using	derivatives	to	hedge	fair	value	and	cash	flow	risks,	the	Company	exposes	itself	to	potential	
credit risk from the counterparty to the hedging instrument. This credit risk is normally a small percentage 
of	the	notional	amount	and	fluctuates	as	interest	rates	change.	The	Company	analyzes	and	approves	credit	
risk for all potential derivative counterparties prior to execution of any derivative transaction. The Com-
pany	seeks	to	minimize	credit	risk	by	dealing	with	highly	rated	counterparties	and	by	obtaining	collater-
alization	for	exposures	above	certain	predetermined	limits.	If	significant	counterparty	risk	is	determined,	
the Company would adjust the fair value of the derivative recorded asset balance to consider such risk.

NOTE 6 - LOANS RECEIVABLE, NET

Loans	receivable,	net	at	December	31,	2015	and	2014	are	summarized	by	category	as	follows:

Loans secured by real estate:
  One-to-four family
  Home equity
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and development
Consumer loans
Commercial business loans
  Total gross loans receivable
Less:
  Allowance for loan losses
  Deferred fees, net
  Total loans receivable, net

At December 31,

2015
    % of Total  

2014
    % of Total 

Amount

Loans
(Dollars in thousands)

  Amount    

Loans

  $

  $

343,686 
23,303 
342,395 
91,713 
5,181 
116,737 
923,015 

10,141 
292 
912,582 

37.23%    
2.52%    
37.10%    
9.94%    
0.56%    
12.65%    
100.00%    

252,819 
27,547 
317,912 
92,008 
5,675 
82,305 
778,266 

9,035 
1,109 
768,122 

32.48%
3.54%
40.85%
11.82%
0.73%
10.58%
100.00%

Included in the loan totals at December 31, 2015 and 2014 were $64.1 million and $80.2 million, respec-
tively, in acquired loans. No allowance for loan losses related to the acquired loans is recorded on the ac-
quisition date because the fair value of the loans acquired incorporates assumptions regarding credit risk. 
Subsequent	to	the	purchase	date	and	after	any	credit	discounts	have	been	fully	used,	the	methods	utilized	
to estimate the required allowance for loan losses are the same as originated loans.

See Note 2 “Business Combinations” for additional information regarding acquired loans.

117

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
The composition of gross loans outstanding by rate type is as follows:

Variable rate loans
Fixed rate loans
Total loans outstanding

At December 31,

2015

2014

$ 399,108 
523,907 
$ 923,015 

(Dollars in thousands)

43.24%    
56.76%    
100.00%    

337,802 
440,464 
778,266 

43.40%
56.60%
100.00%

The following table presents activity in the allowance for loan losses. Allocation of a portion of the allow-
ance to one category of loans does not preclude its availability to absorb losses in other categories.

Allowance for loan losses:

At December 31, 2015

Loans Secured by Real Estate

  Commercial  Construction  

  One-to-  
  Home 
four
family   equity 

real
estate

and

  Commercial 

  Development   Consumer 

business   Unallocated  Total  

3,283   
(231)  
—   
350   
3,402   

(In thousands)
1,069 
(320)  
(90)  
479 
1,138 

30 
(21)  
(20)  
38 
27 

1,430   
(3)  
(70)  
743   
2,100   

114    9,035 
306    — 
—    (1,230)
—    2,336 
420   10,141 

Balance at January 1, 2015
Provision for loan losses
Charge-offs
Recoveries

Balance at December 31, 2015

  $ 2,888   

221   
489    (220)  
  (1,050)   —   
150   
151   

576   
  $ 2,903   

Loans Secured by Real Estate

At December 31, 2014

  One-to-  
four
  Home 
family   equity 

real
estate

  Commercial  Construction  

and

  Development   Consumer 

  Unallocated  Total  

  Commercial 
business

Balance at January 1, 2014
Provision for loan losses
Charge-offs
Recoveries

Balance at December 31, 2014

231   
  $ 2,472   
338   
(10)  
(80)   —   
158    —   
221   

  $ 2,888   

2,855   
356   
(28)  
100   
3,283   

(In thousands)
1,418 
(634)  
(172)  
457 
1,069 

42 
(59)  
(24)  
71 
30 

339   
629   
(59)  
521   
1,430   

734    8,091 
(620)   — 
(363)
—   
—    1,307 

114    9,035 

118

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
   
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
     
   
 
   
 
     
     
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The following table disaggregates our allowance for loan losses and recorded investment in loans by im-
pairment methodology.

Loans Secured by Real Estate

  One-to-   
four
   Home   
family    equity   

  Commercial  Construction   

real
estate

and

    Commercial   

   Development    Consumer    business     Unallocated    Total

(In thousands)

At December 31, 2015:
Allowance for loan losses 

ending balances:

Individually evaluated for 

impairment

  $

15   

—   

343   

120     

Collectively evaluated for 

impairment

Loans receivable ending 

balances:

Individually evaluated for 

2,888   
2,903   

151   
151   

3,059   
3,402   

1,018     
1,138     

  $

—     

27     
27     

9     

—     

487 

2,091     
2,100     

420     
420     

9,654 
10,141 

impairment

  $

3,968   

—   

12,499   

500     

65     

482     

—     

17,514 

  339,718    23,303   
  $ 343,686    23,303   

329,896   
342,395   

91,213     
91,713     

5,116     
5,181     

116,255     

116,737     

—      905,501 
—      923,015 

Collectively evaluated for 

impairment

Total loans receivable

At December 31, 2014:
Allowance for loan losses 

ending balances:

Individually evaluated for 

impairment

  $

364   

—   

30   

90     

Collectively evaluated for 

impairment

Loans receivable ending 

balances:

Individually evaluated for 

2,524   
2,888   

221   
221   

3,253   
3,283   

  $

979     
1,069     

1     

29     
30     

—     

—     

485 

1,430     

1,430     

114     

114     

8,550 

9,035 

impairment

  $

3,249   

63   

11,606   

267     

30     

1,730     

—     

16,945 

Collectively evaluated for 

impairment

Total loans receivable

  249,570    27,484   
  $ 252,819    27,547   

306,306   
317,912   

91,741     
92,008     

5,645     
5,675     

80,575     
82,305     

—      761,321 

—      778,266 

119

2015 Form 10-K 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
  
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
     
     
     
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
     
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
     
     
     
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
 
 
     
     
     
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
     
     
     
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
     
     
     
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
     
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
     
     
     
       
       
       
       
   
 
The  following  table  presents  impaired  loans  individually  evaluated  for  impairment  in  the  segmented 
 portfolio categories as of December 31, 2015 and 2014. The recorded investment is defined as the original 
amount of the loan, net of any deferred costs and fees, less any principal reductions and direct charge-offs. 
Unpaid principal balance includes amounts previously included in charge-offs.

At and for the Year Ended December 31, 2015

    Unpaid    

Interest
    Average    
Income  
  Recorded     Principal    Related     Recorded    
  Investment      Balance       Allowance     Investment     Recognized 
(In thousands)

—     
—     
—     
—     
—     
—     
—     

15     
—     
343     
120     
—     
9     
487     

15     
—     
343     
120     
—     
9     
487     

3,106     
59     
11,003     
225     
181     
1,304     
15,878     

522     
—     
838     
245     
—     
66     
1,671     

3,628     
59     
11,841     
470     
181     
1,370     
17,549     

225 
32 
698 
1 
40 
208 
1,204 

25 
— 
24 
12 
— 
3 
64 

250 
32 
722 
13 
40 
211 
1,268 

With no related allowance recorded:
  Loans secured by real estate:

  One-to-four family
  Home equity
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and development

  Consumer loans
  Commercial business loans

  $

With an allowance recorded:
  Loans secured by real estate:

  One-to-four family
  Home equity
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and development

  Consumer loans
  Commercial business loans

Total:
  Loans secured by real estate:

  One-to-four family
  Home equity
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and development

  Consumer loans
  Commercial business loans

3,175     
—     
10,681     
25     
65     
473     
14,419     

5,572     
28     
11,226     
1,863     
362     
1,668     
20,719     

793     
—     
1,818     
475     
—     
9     
3,095     

793     
—     
1,818     
475     
—     
9     
3,095     

3,968     
—     
12,499     
500     
65     
482     
17,514     

6,365     
28     
13,044     
2,338     
362     
1,677     
23,814     

  $

120

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At and for the Year Ended December 31, 2014

    Unpaid    

    Average    
  Recorded     Principal     Related     Recorded    
  Investment      Balance       Allowance     Investment      Recognized  
(In thousands)

Interest
Income

With no related allowance recorded:
  Loans secured by real estate:

  One-to-four family
  Home equity
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and development

  $

  Consumer loans
  Commercial business loans

With an allowance recorded:
  Loans secured by real estate:

  One-to-four family
  Home equity
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and development

  Consumer loans
  Commercial business loans

Total:
  Loans secured by real estate:

  One-to-four family
  Home equity
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and development

  Consumer loans
  Commercial business loans

2,008     
63     
11,346     
—     
29     
1,730     
15,176     

3,731     
410     
11,892     
1,733     
506     
2,927     
21,199     

1,241     
—     
260     
267     
1     
—     
1,769     

1,241     
—     
260     
267     
1     
—     
1,769     

3,249     
63     
11,606     
267     
30     
1,730     
16,945     

4,972     
410     
12,152     
2,000     
507     
2,927     
22,968     

  $

—     
—     
—     
—     
—     
—     
—     

364     
—     
30     
90     
1     
—     
485     

364     
—     
30     
90     
1     
—     
485     

5,144     
4     
16,939     
348     
23     
2,405     
24,863     

673     
—     
265     
184     
4     
—     
1,126     

5,817     
4     
17,204     
532     
27     
2,405     
25,989     

128 
1 
1,293 
(26)
11 
275 
1,682 

29 
— 
19 
1 
1 
— 
50 

157 
1 
1,312 
(25)
12 
275 
1,732 

The Company was not committed to advance additional funds in connection with impaired loans as of 
December 31, 2015 or 2014.

121

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
A loan is considered past due if the required principal and interest payment has not been received as of 
the due date. The following schedule is an aging of past due loans receivable by portfolio segment as of 
December 31, 2015 and 2014.

At December 31, 2015

Real estate loans

  Commercial   Construction  

  One-to-  
four
family

  Home  
equity  

real
estate

and

  Development   Consumer  

  Commercial  
business

Total

30-59 days past due   $
60-89 days past due    
90 days or more past 
  due
  Total past due
Current
  Total loans  
  receivable

—   
275   

— 
— 

(In thousands)
— 
— 

— 
182 

1,960   
2,235   

— 
— 
341,451    23,303 

235 
417 
341,978 

499 
499 
91,214 

1 
— 

25 
26 
5,155 

50 
— 

51 
457 

— 
50 
116,687 

2,719 
3,227 
  919,788 

  $ 343,686    23,303 

342,395 

91,713 

5,181 

116,737 

  923,015 

At December 31, 2014

Real estate loans

  Commercial   Construction  

  One-to-  
four
family

  Home  
equity  

real
estate

and

  Development   Consumer  

  Commercial  
business

Total

336   
188   

18 
— 

(In thousands)
60 
— 

260 
— 

1,589   
2,113   

— 
18 
250,706    27,529 

333 
593 
317,319 

267 
327 
91,681 

21 
6 

6 
33 
5,642 

27 
— 

722 
194 

— 
27 
82,278 

2,195 
3,111 
  775,155 

  $ 252,819    27,547 

317,912 

92,008 

5,675 

82,305 

  778,266 

30-59 days past due   $
60-89 days past due    
90 days or more past 
  due
  Total past due
Current
  Total loans  
  receivable

Loans are generally placed in nonaccrual status when the collection of principal and interest is 90 days or 
more past due, unless the obligation is both well-secured and in the process of collection. When interest 
accrual is discontinued, all unpaid accrued interest is reversed. Interest payments received while the loan is 
on	nonaccrual	are	applied	to	the	principal	balance.	No	interest	income	was	recognized	on	impaired	loans	
subsequent to the nonaccrual status designation. A loan is returned to accrual status when the borrower 
makes consistent payments according to contractual terms and future payments are reasonably assured.

122

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The following is a schedule of loans receivable, by portfolio segment, on nonaccrual at December 31, 2015 
and 2014.

Loans secured by real estate:
  One-to-four family
  Home equity
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and development
Consumer loans
Commercial business loans

At December 31,
2015

2014

(In thousands)

  $

  $

2,032   
—   
1,686   
499   
50   
35   
4,302   

1,720 
63 
333 
267 
12 
39 
2,434 

There were no loans past due 90 days or more and still accruing at December 31, 2015 or 2014.

The Company uses several metrics as credit quality indicators of current or potential risks as part of the 
ongoing monitoring of credit quality of its loan portfolio. The credit quality indicators are periodically 
reviewed and updated on a case-by-case basis. The Company uses the following definitions for the internal 
risk rating grades, listed from the least risk to the highest risk.

Pass: These loans range from minimal credit risk to average, however, still acceptable credit risk.

Special mention: A special mention loan has potential weaknesses that deserve management’s close atten-
tion. If left uncorrected, these potential weaknesses may result in deterioration of the repayment prospects 
for the loan or the institution’s credit position at some future date.

Substandard: A substandard loan is inadequately protected by the current sound worth and paying capaci-
ty of the obligor or of the collateral pledged, if any. Loans so classified must have a well-defined weakness, 
or	weaknesses,	that	may	jeopardize	the	liquidation	of	the	debt.	A	substandard	loan	is	characterized	by	the	
distinct possibility that the Bank will sustain some loss if the deficiencies are not corrected.

Doubtful: A doubtful loan has all of the weaknesses inherent in one classified as substandard with the 
added characteristic that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in full, on the basis of the currently 
existing facts, conditions and values, highly questionable and improbable.

The Company uses the following definitions:

Nonperforming:  Loans on nonaccrual status plus loans greater than ninety days  past due still  accruing 
interest.

Performing: All current loans plus loans less than ninety days past due.

123

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
 
The following is a schedule of the credit quality of loans receivable, by portfolio segment, as of December 
31, 2015 and 2014.

At December 31, 2015

Real estate loans

  Commercial   Construction  

  One-to-  
four
family

  Home  
  equity  

real
estate

and

  Development   Consumer  

  Commercial  
business

Total

Internal Risk Rating  
  Grades:
  Pass
  Special Mention
  Substandard

  Total loans  
  receivable

  Performing
  Nonperforming:

  90 days or more  

  and still 
  accruing
  Nonaccrual
  Total  

(In thousands)

  $ 340,905 
535 
2,246 

  23,303   
—   
—   

332,320 
8,242 
1,833 

91,051 
172 
490 

5,133 
— 
48 

115,664    908,376 
9,868 
4,771 

919   
154   

  $ 343,686 

  23,303   

342,395 

91,713 

5,181 

116,737    923,015 

  $ 341,654 

  23,303   

340,709 

91,214 

5,131 

116,702    918,713 

— 
2,032 

—   
—   

— 
1,686 

— 
499 

— 
50 

—   
35   

— 
4,302 

  nonperforming  

2,032 
  $ 343,686 

  Total loans receivable

Internal Risk Rating  
  Grades:
  Pass
  Special Mention
  Substandard

  Total loans  
  receivable

  Performing
  Nonperforming:

  90 days or more  

  and still 
  accruing
  Nonaccrual
  Total  

—   
  23,303   

1,686 
342,395 

499 
91,713 

50 
5,181 

35   

4,302 
116,737    923,015 

At December 31, 2014

Real estate loans

  Commercial   Construction  

  One-to-  
four
family

  Home  
  equity  

real
estate

and

  Development   Consumer  

  Commercial  
business

Total

(In thousands)

  $ 249,781 
1,318 
1,720 

  27,484   
—   
63   

307,283 
10,037 
592 

91,441 
300 
267 

5,662 
1 
12 

81,499    763,150 
11,873 
3,243 

217   
589   

  $ 252,819 

  27,547   

317,912 

92,008 

5,675 

82,305    778,266 

  $ 251,099 

  27,484   

317,579 

91,741 

5,663 

82,266    775,832 

— 
1,720 

—   
63   

— 
333 

— 
267 

— 
12 

—   
39   

— 
2,434 

  nonperforming  

  Total loans receivable

1,720 
  $ 252,819 

63   
  27,547   

333 
317,912 

267 
92,008 

12 
5,675 

39   

2,434 
82,305    778,266 

124

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
     
   
 
   
 
   
 
     
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
     
   
 
   
 
   
 
     
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
     
   
 
   
 
   
 
     
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
     
   
 
   
 
   
 
     
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Activity in loans to officers, directors and other related parties for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 
2014	is	summarized	as	follows:

Balance at beginning of year
  New loans
  Repayments
Balance at end of year

At December 31,

2015

2014

(In thousands)
12,233   
5,986   
(6,352) 
11,867   

12,932 
3,735 
(4,434)
12,233 

$

$

In management’s opinion, related party loans are made on substantially the same terms, including interest 
rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with an unrelated person 
and generally do not involve more than the normal risk of collectability.

Loans serviced for the benefit of others under loan participation arrangements amounted to $1.5 million 
and $1.7 million at December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

Troubled Debt Restructurings

There  was  one  relationship  totaling  fourteen  loans  designated  as  a  troubled  debt  restructuring  during 
the year ended December 31, 2015. All loans within this relationship were designated as a troubled debt 
restructuring due to a change in payment structure. Eleven loans were within the one-to-four family loan 
segment with a pre-modification and post-modification recorded investment of $749,000. Two loans were 
within the commercial real estate loan segment with a pre-modification and post-modification recorded 
investment of $147,000. One loan was within the commercial and industrial loan segment with a pre-mod-
ification and post-modification recorded investment of $14,000.

During the year ended December 31, 2014, one commercial business loan was designated as a troubled 
debt restructuring due to a modification to extend terms on the note. The pre-modification and post-mod-
ification balance was $589,000.

No loans restructured in the twelve months prior to December 31, 2015 or 2014 went into default during 
the period ended December 31, 2015 or 2014.

At December 31, 2015, there were $13.3 million in loans designated as troubled debt restructurings of 
which $13.2 million were accruing. At December 31, 2014, there were $14.3 million in loans designated as 
troubled debt restructurings of which $14.3 million were accruing.

125

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTE 7 - PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT, NET

Premises and equipment, net at December 31, 2015 and 2014 consists of the following:

Land
Buildings
Furniture, fixtures and equipment
Construction in process
  Total premises and equipment
Less: accumulated depreciation
  Premises and equipment, net

At December 31,
2015
2014
(In thousands)

8,735   
20,772  
13,300   
110
42,917
(10,355)
32,562

7,859 
19,311
12,437
678
40,285
(9,210)
31,075

  $

$

Depreciation expense included in operating expenses for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014 
amounted to $1.8 million and $1.2 million, respectively. Remaining estimated costs for completion of the 
construction	in	process	are	expected	to	be	approximately	$50,000.	There	was	no	interest	capitalized	during	
fiscal 2015 and 2014.

NOTE 8 - REAL ESTATE ACQUIRED THROUGH FORECLOSURE

Transactions	in	other	real	estate	owned	for	the	years	ended	December	31,	2015	and	2014	are	summarized	
below:

Balance at beginning of year
  Additions
  Sales
  Write downs
Balance at end of year

At December 31,
2015
2014
(In thousands)

  $

$

3,239   
1,307  
(2,172)  
—
2,374

6,273 
1,461
(3,969)
(526)
3,239

A summary of the composition of real estate acquired through foreclosure follows:

Real estate loans:
  One-to-four family
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and development

At December 31,
2015
2014
(In thousands)

$

$

773   
484  
1,117   
2,374

245 
954
2,040
3,239

126

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTE 9 - MORTGAGE SERVICING RIGHTS

Mortgage loans serviced for others are not included in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. The 
value of mortgage servicing rights is included on the Company’s consolidated balance sheets. The unpaid 
principal balances of loans serviced for others were $2.0 billion and $1.9 billion, respectively, at December 
31, 2015 and 2014.

The  economic  estimated  fair  values  of  mortgage  servicing  rights  were  $17.6  million  and  $15.7  million, 
respectively, at December 31, 2015 and 2014.

The estimated fair value of servicing rights at December 31, 2015 were determined using a net servicing 
fee of 0.26%, discount rates ranging from 11.86% to 12.86%, constant prepayment rate (“CPR”) from 
7.93% to 8.82%, depending upon the stratification of the specific servicing right, and a weighted average 
delinquency  rate  of  1.36%  as  determined  by  a  third  party.  The  estimated  fair  value  of  servicing  rights 
at December 31, 2014 were determined using a net servicing fee of 0.26%, discount rates ranging from 
11.73% to 12.73%, constant prepayment rate (“CPR”) ranging from 10.00% to 11.10%, depending upon 
the stratification of the specific servicing right, and a weighted average delinquency rate of 1.35% as de-
termined by a third party.

During 2014, servicing rights related to approximately $147.7 million of unpaid loan principal serviced for 
others were sold resulting in a net gain on sale of $775,000. No servicing rights previously held were sold 
in 2015.

The	following	summarizes	the	activity	in	mortgage	servicing	rights,	along	with	the	aggregate	activity	in	the	
related valuation allowances, for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014:

December 31,

MSR beginning balance
	 Amount	capitalized
  Amount sold
	 Amount	amortized
MSR ending balance

  $

2015
2014
(In thousands)
10,181   
3,238  
—   

10,908 
1,868
(800)
(1,795)
10,181

(1,986)
11,433

$

There was no allowance for loss in fair value in mortgage servicing rights for the years ended December 
31, 2015 and 2014.

Estimated	 amortization	 expense	 is	 presented	 below	 for	 the	 following	 subsequent	 years	 ended	 (in	 
thousands):

Year 1
Year 2
Year 3
Year 4
Year 5
After Year 5
Total

  $

$

2,115
2,115
1,829
1,591
1,514
2,269
11,433

127

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The	estimated	amortization	expense	is	based	on	current	information	regarding	future	loan	payments	and	
prepayments.	Amortization	expense	could	change	in	future	periods	based	on	changes	in	the	volume	of	
prepayments and economic factors.

At  December  31,  2015  and  2014,  servicing  related  impound  funds  of  approximately  $22.8  million,  and 
$26.1 million, respectively, representing both principal and interest due investors and escrows received 
from borrowers, are on deposit in custodial accounts and are included in noninterest-bearing deposits in 
the accompanying financial statements.

At December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company had blanket bond and errors and omissions coverages of 
$5.0 million each.

NOTE 10 - DEPOSITS

Deposits	outstanding	by	type	of	account	at	December	31,	2015	and	2014	are	summarized	as	follows:

Noninterest-bearing demand accounts
Interest-bearing demand accounts
Savings accounts
Money market accounts
Certificates of deposit:
  Less than $250,000
  $250,000 or more
Total certificates of deposit

  Total deposits

  $

At December 31,
2015
2014
(In thousands)
163,054    142,900
158,581    183,550
39,147   
36,630
223,906    246,116

428,067    335,740
18,773
19,254
446,840
354,994
$ 1,031,528    964,190

The aggregate amount of brokered certificates of deposit was $97.1 million and $77.3 million at December 
31,  2015  and  2014,  respectively.  Brokered  certificates  of  deposit  are  included  in  the  table  above  under 
certificates of deposit less than $250,000. The aggregate amount of institutional certificates of deposit was 
$51.5 million and $44.8 million at December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

The amounts and scheduled maturities of certificates of deposit at December 31, 2015 and 2014 are as 
follows:

Maturing within one year
Maturing one through three years
Maturing after three years

At December 31,
2015
2014
(In thousands)
  $ 231,315    157,849 
96,029
101,116
354,994

131,625  
83,900
$ 446,840

Included in the schedules above were deposits assumed as part of branch acquisitions during 2014. See 
Note 2 “Business Combinations” for further details regarding the types and balances of deposits assumed.

128

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The Company has pledged $13.4 million of securities as of December 31, 2015 to secure public agency 
funds.

NOTE 11 - SHORT-TERM BORROWED FUNDS

Short-term	borrowed	funds	at	December	31,	2015	and	2014	are	summarized	as	follows:

At December 31,

2015

2014

Short-term FHLB advances
Subordinated debenture, due 2015
  Total short-term borrowed funds

Balance

$ 120,000
—
$ 120,000

Interest  
Rate

Balance
(Dollars in thousands)
0.28%-0.64%
57,500
300
57,800

—

Interest 
Rate

0.19%-0.56%
2.68%

Lines of credit with the FHLB are based upon FHLB-approved percentages of Bank assets, but must be 
supported by appropriate collateral to be available. The Company has pledged first lien residential mort-
gage, second lien residential mortgage, residential home equity line of credit, commercial mortgage and 
multifamily mortgage portfolios under blanket lien agreements resulting in approximately $273.6 million 
of collateral for these advances. In addition, at December 31, 2015, the Company has pledged securities 
with a fair value of $76.4 million for these advances. At December 31, 2015, the Company had FHLB ad-
vances of $208 million outstanding with excess collateral pledged to the FHLB during those periods that 
would support additional borrowings of approximately $77.4 million.

Lines of credit with the Federal Reserve Bank (“FRB”) are based on collateral pledged. The Company has 
pledged approximately $168.5 million of certain non-mortgage commercial, acquisition and development, 
and lot loan portfolios under blanket lien agreements to the FRB. At December 31, 2015 the Company 
had lines available with the FRB for $84.3 million. At December 31, 2015 the Company had no FRB ad-
vances outstanding.

129

2015 Form 10-KNOTE 12 - LONG-TERM DEBT

Long-term	debt	at	December	31,	2015	and	2014	are	summarized	as	follows:

December 31, 2015

Interest
Rate

Balance
(Dollars in thousands)

Long-term FHLB advances, due 2017 through 2021
Subordinated debentures issued to Carolina Financial Capital Trust I, due 2032
Subordinated debentures issued to Carolina Financial Capital Trust II, due 2034  
  Total long-term debt

  $ 

88,000 
5,155    
10,310    
  $  103,465    

  0.35%-4.00%
3.75 %
3.38 %

December 31, 2014
Interest
Rate

Balance
(Dollars in thousands)

Long-term FHLB advances, due 2016 through 2021
Subordinated debentures, due 2016 through 2020
Subordinated debentures issued to Carolina Financial Capital Trust I, due 2032
Subordinated debentures issued to Carolina Financial Capital Trust II, due 2034  
  Total long-term debt

  $ 

  $ 

45,000 
1,275    
5,155    
10,310    
61,740    

  1.20%-4.00%
2.68%
3.75%
3.28%

The following table presents the scheduled repayments of long-term debt as of December 31, 2015.

2016
2017
2018
2019
2020
Thereafter
Total

  $

$

—
45,000
18,000
5,000
—
35,465
103,465

As of December 31, 2015, there were no principal amounts callable by the FHLB on advances.

At December 31, 2015 and 2014, statutory business trusts (“Trusts”) created by the Company had out-
standing trust preferred securities with an aggregate par value of $15.0 million. The trust preferred securi-
ties	have	floating	interest	rates	ranging	from	3.38%	to	3.75%	at	December	31,	2015	and	maturities	ranging	
from December 31, 2032 to January 7, 2034. The principal assets of the Trusts are $15.5 million of the 
Company’s subordinated debentures with identical rates of interest and maturities as the trust preferred 
securities. The Trusts have issued $465,000 of common securities to the Company.

The trust preferred securities, the assets of the Trusts and the common securities issued by the Trusts are 
redeemable in whole or in part beginning on or after December 31, 2008, or at any time in whole but not 
in part from the date of issuance on the occurrence of certain events. The obligations of the Company 
with respect to the issuance of the trust preferred securities constitutes a full and unconditional guarantee 
by the Company of the Trusts’ obligations with respect to the trust preferred securities. Subject to certain 

130

   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
exceptions and limitations, the Company may elect from time to time to defer subordinated debenture 
interest payments, which would result in a deferral of distribution payments on the related trust preferred 
securities.

As currently defined by the FRB, the Company had $15.0 million of long-term debt that qualified as Tier 
1 capital at December 31, 2015 and 2014. The Company had $675,000 of long-term debt that qualified 
as Tier 2 capital at December 31, 2014. There was no long-term debt that qualified as Tier 2 capital at  
December 31, 2015.

NOTE 13 - INCOME TAXES

Income tax expense for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014 consists of the following:

Current income tax expense
  Federal
  State

Deferred income tax expense (benefit)
  Federal
  State

Total income tax expense

For the Years 
Ended December 31,

2015
2014
(In thousands)

$

$

6,722
645
7,367

(307)
—
(307)
7,060  

2,331
229
2,560

752
136
888
3,448

A  reconciliation  from  expected  Federal  tax  expense  to  actual  income  tax  expense  for  the  years  ended  
December 31, 2015 and 2014 using the base federal tax rates of 35% follows:

Computed federal income taxes
State income tax, net of federal benefit
Tax exempt interest
Change in valuation allowance
Cash surrender value of life insurance
Other, net
  Total income tax expense

For the Years 
Ended December 31,

2015
2014
(In thousands)

$

$

7,518
391
(731)
44
(254)
92
7,060  

4,116
190
(497)
73
(256)
(178)
3,448

131

2015 Form 10-K 
 
The following is a summary of the tax effects of temporary differences that give rise to significant portions 
of the deferred tax assets and liabilities at December 31, 2015 and 2014:

At December 31,

2015

2014

(In thousands)

Deferred tax assets:
  Loan loss reserve
  Tax vs. book gain on loans held for sale
  Debt issuance costs
  Net operating loss carryforwards
  Reserve for mortgage repurchase losses
  OREO write-downs
  Stock based compensation
  Loan fees
  Reserve for miscellaneous losses
  Other

  Valuation allowance

  Total gross deferred tax assets

Deferred tax liabilities:
  Depreciation
	 Unrealized	gain	on	securities	available	for	sale 

  Total gross deferred tax liabilities
  Deferred tax assets, net

$

$

3,722   
13   
85   
289   
1,448   
264   
295   
(56)  
209   
947   
7,216   
(289)  
6,927   

(1,454)  
(200)  
(1,654)  
5,273   

3,204 
46 
86 
246 
1,827 
368 
144 
171 
223 
392 
6,707 
(245)
6,462 

(1,296)
(451)
(1,747)
4,715 

Deferred	tax	assets	are	recognized	for	future	deductible	amounts	resulting	from	differences	in	the	finan-
cial statement and tax bases of assets and liabilities and operating loss carry forwards. A valuation allow-
ance is then established to reduce that deferred tax asset to the level that it is “more likely than not” that 
the	tax	benefit	will	be	realized.	The	realization	of	a	deferred	tax	benefit	by	the	Company	depends	upon	
having sufficient taxable income of an appropriate character in the future periods.

A	portion	of	the	annual	change	in	the	net	deferred	income	tax	asset	relates	to	unrealized	gains	and	losses	
on	debt	and	equity	securities.	The	deferred	income	tax	(benefit)	related	to	the	unrealized	gains	and	losses	
on debt and equity securities of ($251,000) and $1.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 
2014,  respectively,  was  recorded  directly  to  stockholders’  equity  as  a  component  of  accumulated  other 
comprehensive income. The balance of the change in the net deferred tax asset of $307,000 of deferred tax 
and	$888,000	of	deferred	tax	for	the	years	ended	December	31,	2015	and	2014,	respectively,	is	reflected	
as a deferred income tax expense in the consolidated statement of operations. The valuation allowances 
relate	to	state	net	operating	loss	carry-forwards.	It	is	management’s	belief	that	the	realization	of	the	re-
maining net deferred tax assets is more likely than not. The Company’s federal income tax returns were ex-
amined for the years 2008 through 2010. No changes were proposed. Tax returns for 2012 and subsequent 
years	are	subject	to	examination	by	taxing	authorities.	The	Company	has	analyzed	the	tax	positions	taken	
or expected to be taken on its tax returns and concluded it has no liability related to uncertain tax positions 
in accordance with ASC Topic 740.

132

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTE 14 - COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

The Company has entered into agreements to lease certain office facilities under non-cancellable operat-
ing lease agreements expiring on various dates through the year 2021. Some of these leases provide for the 
payment of property taxes and insurance and contain various renewal options. The exercise of the renewal 
options	 are	 dependent	 on	 future	 events.	 Accordingly,	 the	 following	 summary	 does	 not	 reflect	 possible	
additional payments due if renewal options are exercised.

Future minimum lease payments (in thousands), by year and in the aggregate, under non-cancellable op-
erating leases with initial or remaining terms in excess of on year are as follows:

Year 1
Year 2
Year 3
Year 4
Year 5
After Year 5
Total

$

$

1,013 
870 
831 
568 
458 
69 
3,809 

The Company’s rental expense for its office facilities for the years ended December 31, 2015, and 2014 
totaled $1.0 million, and $729,000, respectively

In the course of ordinary business, the Company is, from time to time, named a party to legal actions and 
proceedings, primarily related to the collection of loans and foreclosed assets. In accordance with general-
ly accepted accounting principles, the Company establishes reserves for litigation and regulatory matters 
when those matters present loss contingencies that are both probable and estimable. When loss contingen-
cies are not both probable and estimable, the Company does not establish reserves.

NOTE 15 - STOCK-BASED COMPENSATION

Compensation	cost	is	recognized	for	stock	options	and	restricted	stock	awards	issued	to	employees.	Com-
pensation cost is measured as the fair value of these awards on their date of grant. A Black-Scholes model 
is	utilized	to	estimate	the	fair	value	of	stock	options,	while	the	market	price	of	the	Company’s	common	
stock at the date of grant is used as the fair value of restricted stock awards. Compensation cost is recog-
nized	over	the	required	service	period,	generally	defined	as	the	vesting	period	for	stock	option	awards	and	
as the restriction period for restricted stock awards. For awards with graded vesting, compensation cost is 
recognized	on	a	straight-line	basis	over	the	requisite	service	period	for	the	entire	award.

On January 15, 2015, the Board of Directors of the Company declared a two-for-one stock split to stock-
holders of record dated February 10, 2015, payable on February 28, 2015.

On October 15, 2015, the Board of Directors of the Company declared an additional two-for-one stock 
split to stockholders of record as of October 31, 2015, payable on November 14, 2015.

On June 22, 2015, the Board of Directors of the Company declared a six-for-five stock split representing a 
20% stock dividend to stockholders of record as of July 15, 2015, payable on July 31, 2015.

All	share,	earnings	per	share,	and	per	share	data	have	been	retroactively	adjusted	to	reflect	this	stock	split	
for all periods presented in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. In addition, all stock 
options and restricted stock awards have been retroactively adjusted for the stock splits.

133

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The Company has adopted the 2002 Stock Option Plan for issuance by the Company upon the grant of 
stock options or limited rights, of which 3,360 are outstanding. The plan provided for the grant of options 
to key employees and Directors as determined by the Board of Directors. No additional options can be 
awarded under this plan and all options have vested. The options vest ratably over a five-year period and 
have a ten-year term, both of which begin at the date of grant.

The Company adopted the 2006 Recognition and Retention Plan under which an aggregate of 288,000 
shares of common stock have been reserved for issuance by the Company. The plan provides for the grant 
of stock to key employees and Directors of the Company and its subsidiaries. The non-vested common 
stock  vests  ratably  over  a  five-year  period.  No  restricted  common  stock  of  the  Company  was  granted 
during fiscal 2014 and 2015 from this plan. As of December 31, 2015, a total of 271,200 shares have been 
awarded under the plan, of which all have vested.

The Company has adopted a 2013 Equity Incentive Plan under which an aggregate of 1,200,000 shares of 
common stock have been reserved for issuance by the Company. The plan provides for the grant of stock 
options and restricted stock awards to our officers, employees, directors, advisors, and consultants. The 
options are granted at an exercise price at least equal to the fair value of the common stock at the date of 
grant and expire ten years from the date of the grant. The vesting period for both option grants, restricted 
stock grants, and restricted stock units will vary based on the timing of the grant. As of December 31, 2015 
a total of 453,022 shares were remaining in the plan to be issued.

The expense recognition of employee stock option, restricted stock awards, and restricted stock units re-
sulted in net expense of approximately $874,000, and $617,000 during the twelve months ended December 
31, 2015, and 2014, respectively.

Information regarding the 2015 grants as well as other relevant disclosure related to the share-based com-
pensation plans of the Company is presented below.

Stock Options

Activity	in	the	Company’s	stock	option	plans	is	summarized	in	the	following	table.	All	information	has	
been retroactively adjusted for stock splits.

At and For the Years Ended December 31,

2015

  Weighted  
Average
Exercise
Price

Shares

2014
  Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price

Shares

Outstanding at beginning of year  
  Granted
  Exercised
  Forfeited or expired
Outstanding at end of year

148,881  $
56,705   
(14,016)  
—   
191,570  $

4.53   
11.68   
3.46   
—   
6.61   

153,633   $
6,576   
(11,328)  
—  
148,881   $

Options exercisable at end of year 

131,578  $

4.37   

79,841   $

4.33 
8.54 
4.72 
—
4.53 

4.48 

The aggregate intrinsic value of 191,570 and 148,881 stock options outstanding at December 31, 2015 and 
2014 was $2.1 million and $1.1 million, respectively. The aggregate intrinsic value of 131,578 and 79,841 

134

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
     
   
 
stock  options  exercisable  at  December  31,  2015  and  2014  was  $1.8  million  and  $574,000,  respectively. 
Intrinsic value represents the amount by which the fair market value of the underlying stock exceeds the 
exercise price of the stock option.

Information pertaining to options outstanding at December 31, 2015 and 2014, is as follows:

At December 31, 2015

Options Outstanding
  Weighted Avg.
  Remaining Years  

  Weighted
Average

Options Exercisable

Number

Weighted
Average

Number

Exercise Prices   Outstanding   Contractual Life   Exercise Price   Outstanding   Exercise Price  
4.17 
7.3  $
  $4.17
8.03 
0.8   
  $8.03
8.54 
8.3   
  $8.54
— 
9.1   
  $11.58
— 
9.6 
  $16.19
4.37
7.8 $

124,930  $
3,360   
3,288   
—   
— 

124,930   
3,360   
6,576   
55,504   
1,200   

4.17   
8.03   
8.54   
11.58   
16.19   
6.61

131,578 $

191,570

At December 31, 2014

Options Outstanding
  Weighted Avg.
  Remaining Years  

  Weighted
Average

Options Exercisable

  Number

Weighted
Average

  Number

Exercise Prices   Outstanding   Contractual Life   Exercise Price   Outstanding   Exercise Price  
4.17 
8.3  $
  $4.17
5.00 
0.4   
  $5.00
8.03 
1.8   
  $8.03
8.54 
9.3   
  $8.54
4.48 
7.5  $

124,930   
14,015   
3,360   
6,576   
148,881   

62,465  $
14,016   
3,360   
—   
79,841  $

4.17   
5.00   
8.03   
8.54   
4.53   

The fair value of options is estimated at the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option pricing model 
and expensed over the options’ vesting period. The following weighted-average assumptions were used in 
valuing options issued during 2015 and 2014:

Dividend yield
Expected life
Expected volatility
Risk-free interest rate

2015

2014

1%  

6 years 

32%  
1.51%  

1%

8 years 

32%
2.42%

As	of	December	31,	2015,	there	was	$148,000	of	total	unrecognized	compensation	cost	related	to	non-vest-
ed	stock	option	grants	under	the	plans.	The	cost	is	expected	to	be	recognized	over	a	weighted-average	
period of 1.84 years as of December 31, 2015.

Restricted Stock Grants

The Company from time-to-time also grants shares of restricted stock to key employees and non-employee 
directors. These awards help align the interests of these employees and directors with the interests of the 

135

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
stockholders of the Company by providing economic value directly related to increases in the value of the 
Company’s stock. These awards typically hold service requirements over various vesting periods. The value of 
the stock awarded is established as the fair market value of the stock at the time of the grant. The Company 
recognizes	expense,	equal	to	the	total	value	of	such	awards,	ratably	over	the	vesting	period	of	the	stock	grants.

All restricted stock agreements are conditioned upon continued employment. Termination of employment 
prior to a vesting date, as described below, would terminate any interest in non-vested shares. Prior to vest-
ing of the shares, as long as employed by the Company, the key employees and non-employee directors will 
have the right to vote such shares and to receive dividends paid with respect to such shares. All restricted 
shares will fully vest in the event of change in control of the Company.

Nonvested	restricted	stock	for	the	year	ended	December	31,	2015	and	2014	is	summarized	in	the	following	
table. All information has been retroactively adjusted for stock splits.

At and For the Years Ended December 31,

Restricted stock grants
Nonvested at January 1
Granted
Vested
Forfeited
Nonvested at December 31

2015
    Weighted    
Average
    Grant- Date   
Fair Value    
4.86   
$
12.05   
5.54   
4.94   
5.87   

$

Shares    
352,680   
48,890   
(104,365) 
(11,400) 
285,805   

2014
    Weighted  
Average  
    Grant- Date 
Fair Value  
4.41 
8.62 
5.83 
4.17 
4.86 

$

$

Shares

411,840   
73,274   
(130,034) 
(2,400) 
352,680   

The vesting schedule of these shares as of December 31, 2015 is as follows:

2016
2017
2018
2019
2020
Thereafter

  Shares  
  101,535 
  151,435 
   25,835 
7,000 
— 
— 
  285,805 

As	of	December	31,	2015,	there	was	$966,000	of	total	unrecognized	compensation	cost	related	to	nonvest-
ed	restricted	stock	granted	under	the	plans.	The	cost	is	expected	to	be	recognized	over	a	weighted-average	
period of 1.7 years as of December 31, 2015.

Restricted Stock Units

The Company from time-to-time also grants performance restricted stock units (“RSUs”) to key employ-
ees. These awards help align the interests of these employees with the interests of the shareholders of the 

136

 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
   
Company by providing economic value directly related to the performance of the Company. Performance 
RSU grants contain a two year performance period. The Company communicates the specific threshold, 
target, and maximum performance RSU awards and performance targets to the applicable key employees 
at the beginning of a performance period. Dividends are not paid in respect to the awards and the holder 
does not have the right to vote the shares during the performance period. The value of the RSUs awarded 
is	established	as	the	fair	market	value	of	the	stock	at	the	time	of	the	grant.	The	Company	recognizes	ex-
penses on a straight-line basis typically over the period the performance target is to be achieved.

Nonvested	RSUs	for	the	year	ended	December	31,	2015	is	summarized	in	the	following	table.

  At and For the Years Ended  
December 31, 2015

    Weighted  

Average

Restricted stock units
Nonvested at January 1
Granted
Vested
Forfeited
Nonvested at December 31

Shares

    Grant- Date 
Fair Value  
— 
$
11.58 
— 
11.58 
11.58 

$

—   
25,392   
—   
(480) 
24,912   

As	of	December	31,	2015,	there	was	$151,000	of	total	unrecognized	compensation	cost	related	to	nonvest-
ed	RSUs	granted	under	the	plan.	This	cost	is	expected	to	be	recognized	over	a	weighted-average	period	of	
1.0 years as of December 31, 2015. There were no RSUs granted prior to 2015.

NOTE 16 – ESTIMATED FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

Current accounting literature requires disclosures about the fair value of all financial instruments whether 
or	not	recognized	in	the	balance	sheet,	for	which	it	is	practicable	to	estimate	the	value.	In	cases	where	
quoted market prices are not available, fair values are based on estimates using present value or other 
techniques. Those techniques are significantly affected by the assumptions used, including the discount 
rate	and	estimates	of	future	cash	flows.	In	that	regard,	the	derived	fair	value	estimates	cannot	be	substan-
tiated	by	comparison	to	independent	markets	and,	in	many	cases,	could	not	be	realized	through	immediate	
settlement  of  the  instrument.  Certain  items  are  specifically  excluded  from  disclosure  requirements,  in-
cluding the Company’s stock, premises and equipment, accrued interest receivable and payable and other 
assets and liabilities.

The fair value of a financial instrument is an amount at which the asset or obligation could be exchanged 
in a current transaction between willing parties, other than in a forced sale. Fair values are estimated at 
a specific point in time based on relevant market information and information about the financial instru-
ments.  Because  no  market  value  exists  for  a  significant  portion  of  the  financial  instruments,  fair  value 
estimates are based on judgments regarding future expected loss experience, current economic conditions, 
risk characteristics of various financial instruments, and other factors.

The Company has used management’s best estimate of fair value based on the above assumptions. Thus 
the	fair	values	presented	may	not	be	the	amounts	that	could	be	realized	in	an	immediate	sale	or	settlement	

137

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
of the instrument. In addition, any income taxes or other expenses that would be incurred in an actual sale 
or settlement are not taken into consideration in the fair values presented.

The Company determines the fair value of its financial instruments based on the fair value hierarchy estab-
lished	under	ASC	820-10,	which	requires	an	entity	to	maximize	the	use	of	observable	inputs	and	minimize	
the	use	of	unobservable	inputs	when	measuring	fair	value.	A	financial	instrument’s	categorization	within	
the valuation hierarchy is based upon the lowest level of input that is significant to the financial instru-
ment’s fair value measurement in its entirety. There are three levels of inputs that may be used to measure 
fair value. The three levels of inputs of the valuation hierarchy are defined below:

Level 1 

Level 2 

Level 3 

 Quoted  prices  (unadjusted)  in  active  markets  for  identical  assets  and  liabilities  for  the  in-
strument or security to be valued. Level 1 assets include marketable equity securities as well 
as U.S. Treasury securities that are highly liquid and are actively traded in over-the-counter 
markets.

 Observable inputs other than Level 1 quoted prices, such as quoted prices for similar assets 
and liabilities in active markets, quoted prices in markets that are not active, or model-based 
valuation techniques for which all significant assumptions are derived principally from or cor-
roborated by observable market data. Level 2 assets and liabilities include debt securities with 
quoted prices that are traded less frequently than exchange-traded instruments and derivative 
contracts whose value is determined by using a pricing model with inputs that are observable 
in the market or can be derived principally from or corroborated by observable market data. 
U.S.  Government  sponsored  agency  securities,  mortgage-backed  securities  issued  by  U.S. 
Government  sponsored  enterprises  and  agencies,  obligations  of  states  and  municipalities, 
collateralized	 mortgage	 obligations	 issued	 by	 U.S.	 Government	 sponsored	 enterprises,	 and	
mortgage  loans  held-for-sale  are  generally  included  in  this  category.  Certain  private  equity 
investments that invest in publicly traded companies are also considered Level 2 assets.

 Unobservable inputs that are supported by little, if any, market activity for the asset or liabili-
ty. Level 3 assets and liabilities include financial instruments whose value is determined using 
pricing	models,	discounted	cash	flow	models	and	similar	techniques,	and	may	also	include	the	
use of market prices of assets or liabilities that are not directly comparable to the subject asset 
or liability. These methods of valuation may result in a significant portion of the fair value 
being	derived	from	unobservable	assumptions	that	reflect	The	Company’s	own	estimates	for	
assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. This category 
primarily  includes  collateral-dependent  impaired  loans,  other  real  estate,  certain  equity  in-
vestments, and certain private equity investments.

Cash and due from banks - The carrying amounts of these financial instruments approximate fair value. 
All mature within 90 days and present no anticipated credit concerns.

Interest-bearing cash - The carrying amount of these financial instruments approximates fair value.

Securities available-for-sale and securities held to maturity – Fair values for investment securities avail-
able-for-sale and securities held to maturity are based upon quoted prices, if available. If quoted prices are 
not available, fair values are measured using independent pricing models or other model-based valuation 
techniques	such	as	the	present	value	of	future	cash	flows,	adjusted	for	the	security’s	credit	rating,	prepay-
ment assumptions and other factors such as credit loss assumptions.

138

FHLB stock and other non-marketable equity securities - The carrying amount of these financial instru-
ments approximates fair value.

Mortgage loans held for sale – Mortgage loans held for sale are recorded at either fair value, if elected, or 
the lower of cost or fair value on an individual loan basis. Origination fees and costs for loans held for sale 
recorded	at	lower	of	cost	or	market	are	capitalized	in	the	basis	of	the	loan	and	are	included	in	the	calcula-
tion	of	realized	gains	and	losses	upon	sale.	Origination	fees	and	costs	are	recognized	in	earnings	at	the	time	
of origination for loans held for sale that are recorded at fair value. Fair value is derived from observable 
current market prices, when available, and includes loan servicing value. When observable market prices 
are not available, the Company uses judgment and estimates fair value using internal models, in which 
the Company uses its best estimates of assumptions it believes would be used by market participants in 
estimating fair value. Mortgage loans held for sale are classified within Level 2 of the valuation hierarchy.

Loans	receivable	-	The	fair	value	of	other	types	of	loans	is	estimated	by	discounting	the	future	cash	flows	
using the current rates at which similar loans would be made to borrowers with similar credit ratings and 
for	the	same	remaining	maturities.	Further	adjustments	are	made	to	reflect	current	market	conditions.	
There	is	no	discount	for	liquidity	included	in	the	expected	cash	flow	assumptions.	Loans	receivable	are	
classified within Level 3 of the valuation hierarchy.

Accrued interest receivable - The fair value approximates the carrying value.

Mortgage servicing rights - The Company initially measures servicing assets and liabilities retained related 
to the sale of residential loans held for sale (“mortgage servicing rights”) at fair value, if practicable. For 
subsequent measurement purposes, the Company measures servicing assets and liabilities based on the 
lower of cost or market.

Deposits - The estimated fair value of demand deposits, savings accounts, and money market accounts is 
the amount payable on demand at the reporting date. The estimated fair value of fixed maturity certifi-
cates	of	deposits	is	estimated	by	discounting	the	future	cash	flows	using	rates	currently	offered	for	deposits	
of similar remaining maturities.

Bank-owned life insurance - The cash surrender value of bank owned life insurance policies held by the 
Bank approximates fair values of the policies.

Short-term borrowed funds - The carrying amounts of federal funds purchased, borrowings under repur-
chase agreements, and other short-term borrowings maturing within 90 days approximate their fair values. 
Estimated	fair	values	of	other	short-term	borrowings	are	estimated	using	discounted	cash	flow	analyses	
based on the Company’s current incremental borrowing rates for similar types of borrowing arrangements.

Long-term debt - The estimated fair values of the Company’s long-term debt are estimated using discount-
ed	cash	flow	analyses	based	on	the	Company’s	current	incremental	borrowing	rates	for	similar	types	of	
borrowing arrangements.

Derivative asset and liabilities – The primary use of derivative instruments are related to the mortgage 
banking activities of the Company. The Company’s wholesale mortgage banking subsidiary enters into 
interest rate lock commitments related to expected funding of residential mortgage loans at specified 
times in the future. Interest rate lock commitments that relate to the origination of mortgage loans that 
will be held-for-sale are considered derivative instruments under applicable accounting guidance. As 

139

2015 Form 10-Ksuch, The Company records its interest rate lock commitments and forward loan sales commitments at 
fair value, determined as the amount that would be required to settle each of these derivative financial 
instruments at the balance sheet date. In the normal course of business, the mortgage subsidiary enters 
into contractual interest rate lock commitments to extend credit, if approved, at a fixed interest rate 
and  with  fixed  expiration  dates.  The  commitments  become  effective  when  the  borrowers  “lock-in”  a 
specified interest rate within the time frames established by the mortgage banking subsidiary. Market 
risk arises if interest rates move adversely between the time of the interest rate lock by the borrower 
and the sale date of the loan to an investor. To mitigate the effect of the interest rate risk inherent in 
providing  interest  rate  lock  commitments  to  borrowers,  the  mortgage  banking  subsidiary  enters  into 
best efforts forward sales contracts with third party investors. The forward sales contracts lock in a price 
for the sale of loans similar to the specific interest rate lock commitments. Both the interest rate lock 
commitments to the borrowers and the forward sales contracts to the investors that extend through to 
the date the loan may close are derivatives, and accordingly, are marked to fair value through earnings. 
In estimating the fair value of an interest rate lock commitment, the Company assigns a probability to 
the interest rate lock commitment based on an expectation that it will be exercised and the loan will 
be funded. The fair value of the interest rate lock commitment is derived from the fair value of related 
mortgage loans, which is based on observable market data and includes the expected net future cash 
flows	related	to	servicing	of	the	loans.	The	fair	value	of	the	interest	rate	lock	commitment	is	also	derived	
from inputs that include guarantee fees negotiated with the agencies and private investors, buy-up and 
buy-down values provided by the agencies and private investors, and interest rate spreads for the differ-
ence between retail and wholesale mortgage rates. Management also applies fall-out ratio assumptions 
for those interest rate lock commitments for which we do not close a mortgage loan. The fall-out ratio 
assumptions are based on the mortgage subsidiary’s historical experience, conversion ratios for similar 
loan commitments, and market conditions. While fall-out tendencies are not exact predictions of which 
loans will or will not close, historical performance review of loan-level data provides the basis for deter-
mining the appropriate hedge ratios. In addition, on a periodic basis, the mortgage banking subsidiary 
performs analysis of actual rate lock fall-out  experience  to determine the sensitivity  of  the  mortgage 
pipeline to interest rate changes from the date of the commitment through loan origination, and then 
period end, using applicable published mortgage-backed investment security prices. The expected fall-
out ratios (or conversely the “pull-through” percentages) are applied to the determined fair value of 
the  unclosed  mortgage  pipeline  in  accordance  with  GAAP.  Changes  to  the  fair  value  of  interest  rate 
lock	 commitments	 are	 recognized	 based	 on	 interest	 rate	 changes,	 changes	 in	 the	 probability	 that	 the	
commitment will be exercised, and the passage of time. The fair value of the forward sales contracts to 
investors considers the market price movement of the same type of security between the trade date and 
the balance sheet date. These instruments are defined as Level 2 within the valuation hierarchy.

Derivative instruments not related to mortgage banking activities interest rate swap agreements. Fair val-
ues for these instruments are based on quoted market prices, when available. As such, the fair value ad-
justments for derivatives with fair values based on quoted market prices are recurring Level 1.

Commitments to extend credit – The carrying amounts of these commitments are considered to be a rea-
sonable estimate of fair value because the commitments underlying interest rates are based upon current 
market rates.

Accrued interest payable - The fair value approximates the carrying value.

Off-balance sheet financial instruments – Contract values and fair values for off-balance sheet, credit-re-
lated financial instruments are based on estimated fees currently charged to enter into similar agreements, 
taking into account the remaining terms of the agreements and counterparties’ credit standing.

140

The carrying amount and estimated fair value of the Company’s financial instruments at December 31, 
2015 and 2014 are as follows:

Financial assets:
  Cash and due from banks
  Interest-bearing cash
  Securities available for sale
  Securities held to maturity
  Federal Home Loan Bank stock
  Other investments
  Derivative assets
  Loans held for sale
  Loans receivable, net
  Cash value life insurance
  Accrued interest receivable
  Mortgage servicing rights

Financial liabilities:
  Deposits
  Short-term borrowed funds
  Long-term debt
  Derivative liabilities
  Accrued interest payable

Financial assets:
  Cash and due from banks
  Interest-bearing cash
  Securities available-for-sale
  Securities held-to-maturity
  Federal Home Loan Bank stock
  Other investments
  Derivative assets
  Loans held for sale
  Loans receivable, net
  Cash value life insurance
  Accrued interest receivable
  Mortgage servicing rights

Financial liabilities:
  Deposits
  Short-term borrowed funds
  Long-term debt
  Derivative liabilities
  Accrued interest payable

— 
— 
— 
— 
9,919 
3,273 
— 
— 
917,043 
— 
— 
— 

— 
— 
— 
— 
— 

Carrying    
Amount

$

10,206   
16,421   
306,474   
17,053   
9,919   
3,273   
1,945   
41,774   
912,582   
28,082   
4,333   
11,433   

At December 31, 2015

Fair Value

Total

Level 1    
(In thousands)

Level 2    

Level 3  

10,206   
16,421   
306,474   
17,965   
9,919   
3,273   
1,945   
41,774   
917,043   
28,082   
4,333   
17,564   

  10,206   
  16,421   
—   
—   
—   
—   
180   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   

—   
—   
306,474   
17,965   
—   
—   
1,765   
41,774   
—   
28,082   
4,333   
17,564   

  1,031,528   
120,000   
103,465   
306   
333   

  1,029,406   
119,880   
105,551   
306   
333   

—   
—   
—   
306   
—   

  1,029,406   
119,880   
105,551   
—   
333   

Carrying    
Amount

At December 31, 2014

Fair Value

Total

Level 1    
(In thousands)

Level 2    

Level 3  

$

10,453   
10,694   
251,717   
25,544   
5,405   
2,309   
1,689   
40,912   
768,122   
21,532   
3,628   
10,181   

964,190   
57,800   
61,740   
1,036   
312   

10,453   
10,694   
251,717   
27,385   
5,405   
2,309   
1,689   
39,729   
785,109   
21,532   
3,628   
15,730   

962,763   
57,745   
65,516   
1,036   
312   

  10,453   
  10,694   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   

—   
—   
—   
530   
—   

—   
—   
251,717   
17,652   
—   
—   
1,689   
39,729   
—   
21,532   
3,628   
15,730   

962,763   
57,745   
65,516   
506   
312   

— 
— 
— 
9,733 
5,405 
2,309 
— 
— 
785,109 
— 
— 
— 

— 
— 
— 
— 
— 

141

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Off-Balance Sheet Financial Instruments:

Commitments to extend credit
Standby letters of credit

At December 31,

2015

2014

  Notional    Estimated    Notional    Estimated 
  Amount     Fair Value    Amount     Fair Value 

(In thousands)

$ 70,365   
1,357   

—   
—   

  68,181   
1,982   

— 
— 

In determining appropriate levels, the Company performs a detailed analysis of the assets and liabilities 
that are subject to fair value disclosures. At each reporting period, all assets and liabilities for which the 
fair value measurement is based on significant unobservable inputs are classified as Level 3.

Following is a description of valuation methodologies used for assets recorded at fair value on a recurring 
and non-recurring basis.

Investment Securities Available-for-sale

Measurement is on a recurring basis upon quoted market prices, if available. If quoted market prices are 
not available, fair values are measured using independent pricing models or other model-based valuation 
techniques	such	as	the	present	value	of	future	cash	flows,	adjusted	for	prepayment	assumptions,	projected	
credit losses, and liquidity. At December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company’s investment securities avail-
able-for-sale are recurring Level 2.

Mortgage loans held for sale

Mortgage loans held for sale are recorded at either fair value, if elected, or the lower of cost or fair value 
on an individual loan basis. Origination fees and costs for loans held for sale recorded at lower of cost or 
market	are	capitalized	in	the	basis	of	the	loan	and	are	included	in	the	calculation	of	realized	gains	and	
losses	upon	sale.	Origination	fees	and	costs	are	recognized	in	earnings	at	the	time	of	origination	for	loans	
held for sale that are recorded at fair value. Fair value is derived from observable current market prices, 
when available, and includes loan servicing value. When observable market prices are not available, the 
Company uses judgment and estimates fair value using internal models, in which the Company uses its 
best estimates of assumptions it believes would be used by market participants in estimating fair value. 
Mortgage loans held for sale are classified within Level 2 of the valuation hierarchy.

Impaired Loans

Loans that are considered impaired are recorded at fair value on a non-recurring basis. Once a loan is 
considered impaired, the fair value is measured using one of several methods, including collateral liquida-
tion	value,	market	value	of	similar	debt	and	discounted	cash	flows.	Those	impaired	loans	not	requiring	a	
specific charge against the allowance represent loans for which the fair value of the expected repayments 
or collateral meet or exceed the recorded investment in the loan. At December 31, 2015, substantially all 
of the total impaired loans were evaluated based on the fair value of the underlying collateral. Loans which 
are deemed to be impaired are primarily valued on a nonrecurring basis at the fair value of the underlying 
real  estate  collateral.  Such  fair  values  are  obtained  using  independent  appraisals,  which  the  Company 
considers to be Level 3 inputs.

142

 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
Derivative Assets and Liabilities

The primary use of derivative instruments is related to the mortgage banking activities of the Compa-
ny. The Company’s wholesale mortgage banking subsidiary enters into interest rate lock commitments 
related to expected funding of residential mortgage loans at specified times in the future. Interest rate 
lock commitments that relate to the origination of mortgage loans that will be held-for-sale are consid-
ered derivative instruments under applicable accounting guidance. As such, The Company records its 
interest rate lock commitments and forward loan sales commitments at fair value, determined as the 
amount that would be required to settle each of these derivative financial instruments at the balance 
sheet date. In the normal course of business, the mortgage subsidiary enters into contractual interest 
rate lock commitments to extend credit, if approved, at a fixed interest rate and with fixed expiration 
dates. The commitments become effective when the borrowers “lock-in” a specified interest rate within 
the time frames established by the mortgage banking subsidiary. Market risk arises if interest rates move 
adversely between the time of the interest rate lock by the borrower and the sale date of the loan to an 
investor. To mitigate the effect of the interest rate risk inherent in providing interest rate lock commit-
ments  to  borrowers,  the  mortgage  banking  subsidiary  enters  into  best  efforts  forward  sales  contracts 
with third party investors. The forward sales contracts lock in a price for the sale of loans similar to the 
specific interest rate lock commitments. Both the interest rate lock commitments to the borrowers and 
the forward sales contracts to the investors that extend through to the date the loan may close are de-
rivatives, and accordingly, are marked to fair value through earnings. In estimating the fair value of an 
interest rate lock commitment, the Company assigns a probability to the interest rate lock commitment 
based on an expectation that it will be exercised and the loan will be funded. The fair value of the in-
terest rate lock commitment is derived from the fair value of related mortgage loans, which is based on 
observable	market	data	and	includes	the	expected	net	future	cash	flows	related	to	servicing	of	the	loans.	
The fair value of the interest rate lock commitment is also derived from inputs that include guarantee 
fees negotiated with the agencies and private investors, buy-up and buy-down values provided by the 
agencies and private investors, and interest rate spreads for the difference between retail and wholesale 
mortgage rates. Management also applies fall-out ratio assumptions for those interest rate lock com-
mitments for which we do not close a mortgage loan. The fall-out ratio assumptions are based on the 
mortgage subsidiary’s historical experience, conversion ratios for similar loan commitments, and market 
conditions. While fall-out tendencies are not exact predictions of which loans will or will not close, his-
torical performance review of loan-level data provides the basis for determining the appropriate hedge 
ratios. In addition, on a periodic basis, the mortgage banking subsidiary performs analysis of actual rate 
lock  fall-out  experience  to  determine  the  sensitivity  of  the  mortgage  pipeline  to  interest  rate  chang-
es from the date of the commitment through loan origination, and then period end, using applicable 
published mortgage-backed investment security prices. The expected fall-out ratios (or conversely the 
“pull-through” percentages) are applied to the determined fair value of the unclosed mortgage pipeline 
in	accordance	with	GAAP.	Changes	to	the	fair	value	of	interest	rate	lock	commitments	are	recognized	
based on interest rate changes, changes in the probability that the commitment will be exercised, and 
the passage of time. The fair value of the forward sales contracts to investors considers the market price 
movement of the same type of security between the trade date and the balance sheet date. These instru-
ments are defined as Level 2 within the valuation hierarchy.

Derivative instruments not related to mortgage banking activities include interest rate swap agreements. 
Fair  values  for  these  instruments  are  based  on  quoted  market  prices,  when  available.  As  such,  the  fair 
value adjustments for derivatives with fair values based on quoted market prices in an active market are 
recurring Level 1.

143

2015 Form 10-KOther Real Estate Owned (OREO)

OREO is carried at the lower of carrying value or fair value on a non-recurring basis. Fair value is based 
upon independent appraisals or management’s estimation of the collateral and is considered a Level 3 
measurement. When the OREO value is based upon a current appraisal or when a current appraisal is not 
available or there is estimated further impairment, the measurement is considered a Level 3 measurement.

Mortgage Servicing Rights

A mortgage servicing right asset represents the amount by which the present value of the estimated future 
net	cash	flows	to	be	received	from	servicing	loans	are	expected	to	more	than	adequately	compensate	the	
Company  for  performing  the  servicing.  The  Company  initially  measures  servicing  assets  and  liabilities 
retained related to the sale of residential loans held for sale (“mortgage servicing rights”) at fair value, if 
practicable. For subsequent measurement purposes, the Company measures servicing assets and liabilities 
based on the lower of cost or market on a quarterly basis. The quarterly determination of fair value of 
servicing	rights	is	provided	by	a	third	party	and	is	estimated	using	a	present	value	cash	flow	model.	The	
most important assumptions used in the valuation model are the anticipated rate of the loan prepayments 
and discount rates. Although some assumptions in determining fair value are based on standards used by 
market participants, some are based on unobservable inputs and therefore are classified in Level 3 of the 
valuation hierarchy. See Note 9 for a description of inputs for fair value of servicing rights as of December 
31, 2015 and 2014.

144

Assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis are as follows as of December 31, 2015 
and 2014:

Quoted market price 
in active markets 
(Level 1)

Significant other 
observable inputs 
(Level 2)
(In thousands)

Significant other 
unobservable inputs 
(Level 3)

— 
— 
— 

— 
— 
— 

180 

— 
— 
— 

306 
486 

— 
— 
— 

— 
— 
— 

— 
— 
— 

— 
530 
530 

62,475 
7,096 
38,758 
8,754 

113,855 
75,536 
41,774 

— 

1,246 
340 
179 

— 
350,013 

44,717 
4,748 
25,872 

125,542 
50,838 
39,729 

1,122 
567 
— 

506 
— 
293,641 

— 
— 
— 

— 
— 
— 

— 

— 
— 
— 

— 
— 

— 
— 

— 
— 
— 

— 
— 
— 

— 
— 
— 

December 31, 2015
Available-for-sale investment securities:
  Municipal securities
  US government agencies
  Collateralized	loan	obligations
  Trust preferred securities
  Mortgage-backed securities:

  Agency
  Non-agency
Loans held for sale
Derivative assets:
  Cash	flow	hedges:

  Interest rate swaps
  Non-hedging derivatives:

  Mortgage loan interest rate lock commitments
  Mortgage loan forward sales commitments
  Mortgage-backed securities forward sales commitments  

Derivative liabilities:
  Non-hedging derivatives:
  Interest rate swaps

  Total

December 31, 2014
Available-for-sale investment securities:
  Municipal securities
  US government agencies
  Collateralized	loan	obligations
  Mortgage-backed securities:

  Agency
  Non-agency
Loans held for sale
Derivative assets:
  Non-hedging derivatives:

  Mortgage loan interest rate lock commitments
  Mortgage loan forward sales commitments

Derivative liabilities:
  Non-hedging derivatives:

  Mortgage-backed securities forward sales commitments  
  Interest rate swaps

  Total

$

$

$

$

145

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Assets measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis are as follows as of December 31, 2015 and 2014:

  Quoted market price   Significant other     Significant other  
in active markets   observable inputs   unobservable inputs 

(Level 1)

(Level 2)
(In thousands)

(Level 3)

December 31, 2015
  Impaired loans:

  Loans secured by real estate:

  One-to-four family
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and development  

$

  Consumer loans
  Commercial business loans

  Real estate owned:

  One-to-four family
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and development

  Mortgage servicing rights
  Total

December 31, 2014
  Impaired loans:

  Loans secured by real estate:

  One-to-four family
  Home equity
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and development  

  Consumer loans
  Commercial business loans

  Real estate owned:

  One-to-four family
  Commercial real estate
  Construction and development

  Mortgage servicing rights
  Total

$

$

$

—   
—   
—   
—   
—   

—   
—   
—   
—   
—   

—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   

—   
—   
—   
—   
—   

—    
—    
—    
—    
—    

—    
—    
—    
—    
—    

—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    

—    
—    
—    
—    
—    

3,953 
12,156 
380 
65 
473 

773 
484 
1,117 
17,564 
36,965 

2,885 
63 
11,576 
177 
29 
1,730 

245 
954 
2,040 
15,730 
35,429 

The Company predominantly lends with real estate serving as collateral on a substantial majority of loans. 
Loans that are deemed to be impaired are primarily valued at fair values of the underlying real estate 
collateral.

For Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring or non-recurring basis as of Decem-
ber 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, the significant unobservable inputs used in the fair value measure-
ments were as follows:

146

 
 
 
 
 
  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
      
   
 
 
     
      
   
 
 
 
     
      
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
      
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
      
   
 
 
     
      
   
 
 
     
      
   
 
 
 
     
      
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
      
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Impaired Loans

  Valuation Technique  
Appraisal Value

Real estate owned

Appraisal Value/ 
Comparison Sales/ 
Other estimates

December 31, 2015 and 2014

Significant
Observable Inputs
Appraisals and or sales of 
comparable properties  

Significant Unobservable
Inputs
Appraisals discounted 10% to 20% for 
sales commissions and other holding costs

Appraisals and or sales of 
comparable properties

Appraisals discounted 10% to 20% for 
sales commissions and other holding costs

Mortgage Servicing  
  Rights

Discounted cash 
flows

Comparable sales

Discount rates 12% - 13% - 2015 and 2014 
Prepayment rate 8% - 9% - 2015 
Prepayment rate 10% - 11% - 2014

NOTE  17  -  OFF-BALANCE  SHEET  FINANCIAL  INSTRUMENTS  AND  CONCENTRATIONS  OF 
CREDIT RISK

The Company is party to financial instruments with off-balance-sheet risk in the normal course of business 
to meet the financing needs of its customers. These financial instruments include commitments to extend 
credit. These instruments involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit risk in excess of the amount rec-
ognized	in	the	consolidated	balance	sheets.

The Company’s exposure to credit loss in the event of nonperformance by the other party to the financial 
instrument for commitments to extend credit is represented by the contractual amount of these instru-
ments. The Company uses the same credit policies in making commitments as for on-balance sheet instru-
ments. At December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company had commitments to extend credit in the amount of 
$70.4 million and $68.2 million, respectively. At December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company had standby 
letters of credit in the amount of $1.4 million and $2.0 million, respectively.

Standby letters of credit obligate the Company to meet certain financial obligations of its customers, if, 
under the contractual terms of the agreement, the customers are unable to do so. Payment is only guaran-
teed under these letters of credit upon the borrower’s failure to perform its obligations to the beneficiary. 
The  Company  can  seek  recovery  of  the  amounts  paid  from  the  borrower  and  the  letters  of  credit  are 
generally	not	collateralized.	Commitments	under	standby	letters	of	credit	are	usually	one	year	or	less.	At	
December 31, 2015, the Company has recorded no liability for the current carrying amount of the obliga-
tion to perform as a guarantor; as such amounts are not considered material. The maximum potential of 
undiscounted future payments related to standby letters of credit at December 31, 2015 was approximately 
$1.4 million.

Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of 
any  condition  established  in  the  contract.  Commitments  generally  have  fixed  expiration  dates  or  other 
termination clauses and may require a payment of a fee. Since commitments may expire without being 
drawn upon, the total commitments do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. The Company 
evaluates each customer’s creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis. The amount of collateral obtained, if 
deemed necessary by the Company upon extension of credit, is based on management’s credit evaluation 
of the party. Collateral held varies, but may include inventory, property and equipment, residential real 
estate and income producing commercial properties.

The  Company’s  primary  uses  of  derivative  instruments  are  related  to  the  mortgage  banking  activities. 
As such, the Company holds derivative instruments, which consist of rate lock agreements related to ex-
pected funding of fixed-rate mortgage loans to customers (interest rate lock commitments) and forward 

147

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 commitments to sell mortgage-backed securities and individual fixed-rate mortgage loans. The Company’s 
objective in obtaining the forward commitments is to mitigate the interest rate risk associated with the 
interest rate lock commitments and the mortgage loans that are held for sale. Derivative instruments not 
related to mortgage banking activities primarily relate to interest rate swap agreements.

The Company’s derivative positions are presented with discussion in Note 5 - Derivatives.

NOTE 18 - EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

The Company maintains a 401(k) plan that covers substantially all employees of CresCom Bank, Carolina 
Services (“CFC Participants”) and Crescent Mortgage (“CMC Participants”). Participants may contribute 
up to the maximum allowed by the regulation. During fiscal 2015 and 2014, the Company matched 75% 
of an employee’s contribution up to 6.00% of the participant’s compensation of the CFC Participants and 
the CMC Participants. For the years ended December 31, 2015, and 2014, the Company made matching 
contributions of $474,000 and $415,000, respectively.

The  Company  had  an  arrangement  with  two  executives  whereby  the  Company  made  payments  to  an 
insurance company on behalf of the executives. The advance is treated as a loan to the executive and 
the  cash  surrender  value  of  the  payment  to  the  insurance  company  is  included  in  other  assets  in  the 
accompanying consolidated statements of financial condition. The cash surrender value of the advance 
at December 31, 2015 and 2014 is $253,000 and $427,000, respectively. The executive is entitled to the 
increase in cash value above the Company’s original cash value insurance contributions. The executive 
pays the Company imputed interest on the loan balance and the increase in the cash value is recorded as 
compensation to the executives. The insurance policy premiums are paid in full by the executives. The 
executive is entitled to receive a $1.0 million death benefit and the Company will receive a $1.8 million 
death benefit. Since the executive pays the insurance premiums, the insurance proceeds would be taxable 
to the Company. During 2015, one of the executives ended their participation in the plan and received 
their portion of the cash value.

The Company incurred an aggregate payment of $40,000 and $180,000 paid on behalf of the executives for 
the period ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

NOTE 19 - EARNINGS PER COMMON SHARE

Basic earnings per common share are calculated by dividing net income by the weighted average number 
of common shares outstanding during the period. Basic earnings per common share exclude the effect of 
nonvested restricted stock. Diluted earnings per common share is calculated by dividing net income by the 
weighted average number of common shares outstanding plus the weighted average number of additional 
common shares that would have been outstanding if the dilutive potential common shares had been is-
sued. Diluted earnings per common share include the effects of outstanding stock options and restricted 
stock issued by the Company, if dilutive. The number of additional shares is calculated by assuming that 
outstanding stock options were exercised and that the proceeds from such exercises and vesting were used 
to acquire shares of common stock at the average market price during the reporting period.

On January 15, 2015, the Board of Directors of the Company declared a two-for-one stock split to stock-
holders of record dated February 10, 2015, payable on February 28, 2015.

On October 15, 2015, the Board of Directors of the Company declared an additional two-for-one stock 
split to stockholders of record as of October 31, 2015, payable on November 14, 2015.

148

On June 22, 2015, the Board of Directors of the Company declared a six-for-five stock split representing a 
20% stock dividend to stockholders of record as of July 15, 2015, payable on July 31, 2015.

All	share,	earnings	per	share,	and	per	share	data	have	been	retroactively	adjusted	to	reflect	this	stock	split	
for all periods presented in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

The following is a summary of the reconciliation of average shares outstanding for the years ended De-
cember 31, 2015 and 2014:

December 31,

2015

2014

Basic

Diluted    

Basic

Diluted  

Weighted average shares outstanding
Effect of dilutive securities
Average shares outstanding

9,537,358   
—   
9,537,358   

  9,537,358   
180,998   
  9,718,356   

  9,314,048   
—   
  9,314,048   

  9,314,048 
193,377 
  9,507,425 

The average market price used in calculating the dilutive securities under the treasury stock method for 
the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014 $13.60 and $9.50, respectively.

For the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, 56,705 and 6,576 option shares, respectively, were ex-
cluded from the calculation of diluted earnings per share during the period because the exercise prices 
were greater than the average market price of the common shares, and therefore were deemed not to be 
dilutive.

The following is a summary of the reconciliation of shares issued and outstanding and unvested restricted 
stock awards as of December 31, 2015 and 2014 used for computing book value and tangible book value:

Issued and outstanding shares
Less nonvested restricted stock awards
Period end dilutive shares

As of December 31,
2015

2014

  12,023,557   
(285,805)  
  11,737,752   

  9,717,043 
(365,160)
  9,351,883 

On December 14, 2015, the Company closed a public offering of 2,262,296 shares of its common stock 
with net proceeds of approximately $32.1 million after deducting underwriting discounts, commissions and 
offering expenses incurred by the Company.

NOTE 20 - CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS AND OTHER RESTRICTIONS

The Company and the Bank are subject to various federal and state regulatory requirements, including 
regulatory capital requirements. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate certain man-
datory and possible additional discretionary actions that if undertaken could have a direct material effect 
on the Company’s and the Bank’s financial statements.

149

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
In 2013, federal bank regulatory agencies issued a final rule that revises their risk-based capital require-
ments and the method for calculating risk-weighted assets to make them consistent with agreements that 
were reached by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (“Basel III”) and certain provisions of the 
Dodd-Frank Act.

The rule imposes higher risk-based capital and leverage requirements than those in place at the time the 
rule was issued. Specifically, the rule imposes the following minimum capital requirements:

•	 A	new	Common	Equity	Tier	1	risk-based	capital	ratio	of	4.5%

•	 A	Tier	1	risk-based	capital	ratio	of	6%	(increased	from	the	previous	4%	requirement),

•	 A	total	risk-based	capital	ratio	of	8%	(unchanged	from	previous	requirement),

•	 A	leverage	ratio	of	4%	and

•	

	A	new	supplementary	leverage	ratio	of	3%	applicable	to	advanced	approaches	banking	orga-
nizations	resulting	in	a	leverage	ratio	requirement	of	7%	for	such	institutions

The rule also includes changes in what constitutes regulatory capital, some of which are subject to a transi-
tion period. These changes include the phasing-out of certain instruments as qualifying capital. In  addition, 
Tier 2 capital is no longer limited to the amount of Tier 1 capital included in total capital. Mortgage ser-
vicing rights, certain deferred tax assets and investments in unconsolidated subsidiaries over designated 
percentages of common stock are required to be deducted from capital, subject to a transition period. Fi-
nally, Common Equity Tier 1 capital includes accumulated other comprehensive income (which includes 
all	unrealized	gains	and	losses	on	available	for	sale	debt	and	equity	securities),	subject	to	a	transition	pe-
riod and a one-time opt-out election. The Bank elected to opt-out of this provision. As such, accumulated 
comprehensive income is not included in the Bank’s Tier 1 capital.

The	rule	also	includes	changes	in	the	risk-weights	of	assets	to	better	reflect	credit	risk	and	other	risk	expo-
sures. These include a 150% risk weight (up from 100%) for certain high volatility commercial real estate 
acquisition, development and construction loans and non-residential mortgage loans that are 90 days past 
due or otherwise on nonaccrual status, a 20% (up from 0%) credit conversion factor for the unused por-
tion of a commitment with an original maturity of one year or less that is not unconditionally cancellable, 
a 250% risk weight (up from 100%) for mortgage servicing rights and deferred tax assets that are not de-
ducted from capital and increased risk-weights (from 0% to up to 600%) for equity exposures.

Finally, the rule limits capital distributions and certain discretionary bonus payments if the banking or-
ganization	 does	 not	 hold	 a	 “capital	 conservation	 buffer”	 consisting	 of	 2.5%	 of	 Common	 Equity	 Tier	 1	
capital to risk-weighted assets in addition to the amount necessary to meet its minimum risk-based capital 
requirements.

The final rule became effective on January 1, 2015, and the requirements in the rule will be fully phased-
in by January 1, 2019. While the ultimate impact of the fully phased-in capital standards on the Company 
and the Bank is being reviewed, we currently do not believe Basel III will have a material impact once fully 
implemented.

150

The actual capital amounts and ratios as well as minimum amounts for each regulatory defined category 
for the Company and the Bank at December 31, 2015 and 2014 are as follows:

Actual
  Amount   Ratio  

  Minimum Required 
For Capital
  Adequacy Purposes 
  Amount     Ratio  
(Dollars in thousands)

To Be Well
  Capitalized Under  
  Prompt Corrective  
  Action Regulations  
  Amount     Ratio  

December 31, 2015
  Carolina Financial Corporation  

  CET1 capital (to risk  
  weighted assets)
  Tier 1 capital (to risk  
  weighted assets)

  Total capital (to risk weighted 

 assets)

  Tier 1 capital (to total  

  average assets)

  $ 138,213    13.97%     44,527     

4.50%    

N/A      N/A 

  153,213    15.48%     59,370     

6.00%    

N/A      N/A 

  163,353    16.51%     79,160     

8.00%    

N/A      N/A 

  153,213    11.23%     54,557     

4.00%    

N/A      N/A 

  CresCom Bank

  CET1 capital (to risk  
  weighted assets)
  Tier 1 capital (to risk  
  weighted assets)

  Total capital (to risk weighted 

  assets)

  Tier 1 capital (to total  

  average assets)

December 31, 2014
  Carolina Financial Corporation  

  139,025    14.08%     44,442     

4.50%     64,194     

6.50%

  139,025    14.08%     59,256     

6.00%     79,008     

8.00%

  149,165    15.10%     79,008     

8.00%     98,760      10.00%

  139,025    10.21%     54,466     

4.00%     68,082     

5.00%

  Tier 1 capital (to risk  
  weighted assets)

  Total risk based capital (to  

  risk weighted assets)
  Tier 1 capital (to total  

  average assets)

  CresCom Bank

  Tier 1 capital (to risk  
  weighted assets)

  Total risk based capital (to  

  risk weighted assets)
  Tier 1 capital (to total  

  average assets)

  $ 104,613    12.03%    34,787     

4.00%   

N/A      N/A 

  114,323    13.15%    69,574     

8.00%   

N/A      N/A 

  104,613   

9.49%    44,079     

4.00%   

N/A      N/A 

  103,319    11.90%    34,716     

4.00%    52,074     

6.00%

  113,029    13.02%    69,433     

8.00%    86,791      10.00%

  103,319   

9.40%    43,985     

4.00%    54,981     

5.00%

151

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
     
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
 
     
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
 
 
     
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
 
 
     
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
 
     
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
 
 
     
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
   
   
       
   
   
       
   
A South Carolina state bank may not pay dividends from capital. All dividends must be paid out of undi-
vided profits then on hand, after deducting expenses, including reserves for losses and bad debts. Unless 
otherwise instructed by the South Carolina Board of Financial Institutions, the Bank is generally permit-
ted under South Carolina state banking regulations to pay cash dividends of up to 100% of net income 
in any calendar year without obtaining the prior approval of the South Carolina Board of Financial Insti-
tutions. In addition, under the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act, the Bank may 
not	pay	a	dividend	if,	after	paying	the	dividend,	the	Bank	would	be	undercapitalized.	The	FRB	may	also	
prevent the payment of a dividend by the Bank if it determines that the payment would be an unsafe and 
unsound banking practice.

During the year ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company paid dividend payments of $780,000 
and $606,000 to stockholders.

NOTE 21 - SUPPLEMENTAL SEGMENT INFORMATION

The Company has three reportable segments: community banking, wholesale mortgage banking (“mort-
gage banking”) and other. The community banking segment provides traditional banking services offered 
through CresCom Bank. The mortgage banking segment provides mortgage loan origination and servicing 
offered through Crescent Mortgage. The other segment provides managerial and operational support to 
the other business segments through Carolina Services and Carolina Financial.

The accounting policies of the segments are the same as those described in the summary of significant 
accounting policies. The Company evaluates performance based on net income.

The Company accounts for intersegment revenues and expenses as if the revenue/expense transactions 
were generated to third parties, that is, at current market prices.

The Company’s reportable segments are strategic business units that offer different products and services. 
They are managed separately because each segment has different types and levels of credit and interest 
rate risk.

152

The following tables present selected financial information for the Company’s reportable business seg-
ments for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014:

For the Year Ended December 31, 2015  

Community 
Banking  

Mortgage 
Banking   Other   Eliminations 

Total

  $

Interest income
Interest expense
Net interest income (expense)
(Recovery of) provision for loan losses  
Noninterest income from external 
customers
Intersegment noninterest income
Noninterest expense
Intersegment noninterest expense
Income (loss) before income taxes
Income tax expense (benefit)
Net income (loss)

  $

47,701   
6,017   
41,684   
(67)  

6,598   
4   
25,497   
6,112   
16,744   
5,342   
11,402   

(In thousands)
16   
587   
(571)  
—   

1,819   
100   
1,719   
67   

21,080   
81   
15,789   
964   
6,060   
2,228   
3,832   

1   
7,072   
7,913   
—   
(1,411)  
(544)  
(867)  

68   
(100)  
168   
—   

—   
(7,157)  
—   
(7,076)  
87   
34   
53   

49,604 
6,604 
43,000 
— 

27,679 
— 
49,199 
— 
21,480 
7,060 
14,420 

Assets
Loans receivable, net
Loans held for sale
Deposits
Borrowed funds

  $ 1,404,681   
908,227   
3,466   
  1,047,671   
208,000   

75,926    156,774   
—   
17,783   
—   
38,308   
—   
—   
15,465   
12,748   

(227,712)   1,409,669 
912,582 
(13,428)  
41,774 
—   
(16,143)   1,031,528 
223,465 
(12,748)  

For the Year Ended December 31, 2014 

Community 
Banking  

Mortgage 
Banking   Other   Eliminations  

Total

  $

Interest income
Interest expense
Net interest income (expense)
(Recovery of) provision for loan losses  
Noninterest income from external 
customers
Intersegment noninterest income
Noninterest expense
Intersegment noninterest expense
Income (loss) before income taxes
Income tax expense (benefit)
Net income (loss)

  $

36,075   
5,061   
31,014   
(61)  

4,084   
—   
19,548   
5,186 
10,425   
3,157 
7,268   

(In thousands)
16   
541   
(525)  
—   

1,455   
28   
1,427   
61   

17,017   
136   
14,946   
960 
2,613   
762 
1,851   

47   
6,146   
6,949   
— 
(1,281)  
(472)
(809)  

110   
(28)  
138   
—   

—   
(6,282)  
—   

(6,146)

2   
1 
1   

37,656 
5,602 
32,054 
— 

21,148 
— 
41,443 
— 
11,759 
3,448 
8,311 

Assets
Loans receivable, net
Loans held for sale
Deposits
Borrowed funds

  $ 1,192,419   
764,881   
1,547   
966,309   
104,076   

67,952    111,096   
—   
10,808   
—   
39,365   
—   
—   
15,465   
6,800   

(172,450)   1,199,017 
768,122 
40,912 
964,190 
119,540 

(7,567)  
—   
(2,119)  
(6,801)  

153

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
     
     
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
     
     
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
     
     
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTE 22 - PARENT COMPANY FINANCIAL INFORMATION

The condensed financial statements for the parent company are presented below:

Carolina Financial Corporation
Condensed Statements of Financial Condition

Assets:

  Cash and cash equivalents
  Investment in bank subsidiary
  Investment in non-bank subsidiaries
  Investment in unconsolidated statutory business trusts
  Securities available for sale
  Other assets

  Total assets

Liabilities and stockholders’ equity:
  Accrued expenses and other liabilities
  Long-term debt
  Stockholders’ equity

  Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

Carolina Financial Corporation
Condensed Statements of Operations

Dividend income from banking subsidiary
Interest income
Total income
Interest expense
General and administrative expenses

Total expenses

Income (loss) before income taxes and equity in undistributed earnings 
of subsidiaries
Income tax benefit
Income before equity in undistributed earnings of subsidiaries
Equity in undistributed earnings of CresCom Bank
Equity in undistributed (losses) of Carolina Services

Total equity in undistributed earnings of subsidiaries

Net income

At December 31,

2015

2014

(In thousands)

$

$

$

13,240   
140,672   
1,036   
465   
1   
519   
155,933   

609   
15,465   
139,859   
155,933   

519 
107,407 
850 
465 
1 
295 
109,537 

372 
15,465 
93,700 
109,537 

For the Years 
Ended December 31,
2015
2014

(In thousands)
1,700   
16   
1,716   
587   
733   
1,320   

396   
(501)  
897   
13,587   
(64)  
13,523   
14,420   

800 
16 
816 
541 
578 
1,119 

(303)
(415)
112 
8,320 
(121)
8,199 
8,311 

$

$

154

 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Carolina Financial Corporation
Condensed Statements of Cash Flows

Cash	flows	from	operating	activities:
  Net income
  Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by 

  operating activities:
  Equity in undistributed earnings in subsidiaries
  Stock-based compensation
  Stock awards
  Vested stock awards surrendered in cashless exercise
  Increase in other assets
  Increase in other liabilities
  Excess tax benefit in connection with equity awards
  Net cash provided by operating activities

Cash	flows	from	investing	activities:
  Equity contribution in bank subsidiaries
  Equity contribution in non-bank subsidiaries

  Net cash used in financing activities

Cash	flows	from	financing	activities:
  Proceeds from issuance of common stock
  Proceeds from exercise of stock options
  Cash dividends paid on common stock
  Net cash used in financing activities
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents

  Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year
  Cash and cash equivalents, end of year

For the Years 
Ended December 31,

2015

2014  

(In thousands)

$

14,420   

  8,311 

(13,523)  
874   
—   
(86)  
(224)  
237   
189   
1,887   

(20,000)  
(250)  
(20,250)  

32,156   
70   
(1,142)  
31,084   
12,721   
519   
13,240   

  (8,199)
617 
65 
— 
(130)
200 
126 
990 

— 
— 
— 

— 
50 
(855)
(805)
185 
334 
519 

$

155

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ITEM 9. 

 CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND 
FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

None.

ITEM 9A.  CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

Evaluation of disclosure controls and procedures. As of the end of the period covered by this Annual Report 
on Form 10-K, the Company carried out an evaluation, under the supervision and with the participation 
of its management, including its Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, of the effectiveness 
of  the  design  and  operation  of  its  disclosure  controls  and  procedures.  In  designing  and  evaluating  the 
disclosure	controls	and	procedures,	management	recognizes	that	any	controls	and	procedures,	no	matter	
how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable assurance of achieving the desired control 
objectives, and management was required to apply judgment in evaluating its controls and procedures. 
Based on this evaluation, the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded 
that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) un-
der the Exchange Act, were effective as of the end of the period covered by this report.

Changes in internal control over financial reporting. There were no changes in the Company’s internal con-
trol over financial reporting (as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act) that 
occurred during the quarter ended December 31, 2015, that have materially affected, or are reasonably 
likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

As of December 31, 2015, management assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over 
financial reporting based on the criteria for effective internal control over financial reporting established 
in	 “Internal	 Control-Integrated	 Framework,”	 issued	 by	 the	 Committee	 of	 Sponsoring	 Organizations	
(“COSO”) of the Treadway Commission in 2013. This assessment included controls over the preparation 
of the schedules equivalent to the basic financial statements in accordance with the instructions for the 
Consolidated Financial Statements for Bank Holding Companies (Form FR Y-9C) to meet the reporting 
requirements of Section 112 of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act. Based on 
the  assessment  management  determined  that  the  Company  maintained  effective  internal  control  over 
financial reporting as of December 31, 2015.

Elliott Davis Decosimo, LLC, the independent registered public accounting firm, audited the consolidated 
financial statements of the Company included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. Their report is in-
cluded in Part III, Item 15. Exhibits and Financial Statements under the heading “Report of Independent 
Registered Public Accounting Firm.” This Annual Report on Form 10-K does not include an attestation 
report of the Company’s registered public accounting firm due to a transition period established by rules 
of the Securities and Exchange Commission for an Emerging Growth Company.

ITEM 9B.  OTHER INFORMATION 

None

156

PART III

ITEM 10.  DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE. 

In response to this Item, this information is contained in our Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of 
Shareholders to be held on May 3, 2016 and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 11.  EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION.

In response to this Item, this information is contained in our Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of 
Shareholders to be held on May 3, 2016 and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 12. 

 SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT 
AND RELATED SHAREHOLDER MATTERS. 

In response to this Item, the information required by Item 201(d) is contained in Item 5 of this report. The 
other information required by this item is contained in our Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of 
Shareholders to be held on May 3, 2016 and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 13.  CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS.

The information is contained in our Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held 
on May 3, 2016 is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 14.  PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES.

In response to this Item, this information is contained in our Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of 
Shareholders to be held on May 3, 2016 and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 15.  EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

(a)   (1) 

(2) 

Financial Statements
The following consolidated financial statements are located in Item 8 of this report.
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2015 and 2014
Consolidated Statements of Income for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the years ended December 31, 2015 
and 2014
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity for the years ended December 
31, 2015 and 2014
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
Financial Statement Schedules
 These schedules have been omitted because they are not required, are not applicable or have 
been included in our consolidated financial statements.

(3)  Exhibits

 See the “Exhibit Index” immediately following the signature page of this report.

157

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 12 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has 

duly	caused	this	report	to	be	signed	on	its	behalf	by	the	undersigned,	thereunto	duly	authorized.

SIGNATURES

Date: March 14, 2016

CAROLINA FINANCIAL CORPORATION

By: /s/ Jerold L. Rexroad 

Jerold L. Rexroad 
Chief Executive Officer

158

 
 
 
 
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed 
below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated:

Signature

Title

  Date

/s/ Jerold L. Rexroad 
Jerold L. Rexroad

  Chief Executive Officer and Director

  March 14, 2016

(Principal Executive Officer)

/s/ William A. Gehman, III 
William A. Gehman, III

Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer

  March 14, 2016

and Principal Accounting Officer)

/s/ G. Manly Eubank 
G. Manly Eubank

/s/ Howell V. Bellamy, Jr. 
Howell V. Bellamy, Jr.

/s/ W. Scott Brandon 
W. Scott Brandon

/s/ Robert G. Clawson, Jr. 
Robert G. Clawson, Jr.

/s/ Jeffery L. Deal 
Jeffery L. Deal, M.D.

/s/ Michael P. Leddy  
Michael P. Leddy

/s/ Robert M. Moïse 
Robert M. Moïse, CPA

/s/ David L. Morrow 
David L. Morrow

/s/ Thompson E. Penney 
Thompson E. Penney

/s/ Benedict P. Rosen 
Benedict P. Rosen

/s/ Claudius E. Watts IV 
Claudius E. Watts IV

/s/ Bonum S. Wilson, Jr. 
Bonum S. Wilson, Jr.

Chairman of the Board of Directors

  March 14, 2016

  March 14, 2016

  March 14, 2016

  March 14, 2016

  March 14, 2016

  March 14, 2016

  March 14, 2016

  March 14, 2016

  March 14, 2016

  March 14, 2016

  March 14, 2016

  March 14, 2016

  Director

  Director

  Director

  Director

  Director

  Director

  Director

  Director

  Director

  Director

  Director

159

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exhibit No. 

3.1 

3.3 

4.1 

EXHIBIT INDEX

Description

Restated Certificate of Incorporation filed on August 31, 2015 (1)

Restated Bylaws (2)

 See Exhibits 3.1 through 3.3 for provisions in Carolina Financial Corporation’s Certificate of 
Incorporation and Bylaws defining the rights of holders of common stock (1) (2)

4.2 

Form of certificate of common stock (3)

10.1 

10.2 

10.3 

10.4 

10.5 

10.6 

10.7 

10.8 

 Amended and Restated Employment Agreement by and between Crescent Bank and M.J. 
Huggins, III dated as of December 24, 2008 (3)(4)

 First Amendment to the Amended and Restated Employment Agreement between CresCom 
Bank and M.J. Huggins, III dated September 21, 2012 (3)(4)

 Amended and Restated Supplemental Executive Agreement by and between Carolina Finan-
cial Corporation and M.J. Huggins, III dated as of December 24, 2008 (3)(4)

 Amended and Restated Employment Agreement by and between Crescent Bank and David 
Morrow dated as of December 24, 2008 (3)(4)

 First Amendment to the Amended and Restated Employment Agreement between CresCom 
Bank and David Morrow dated as of September 19, 2012 (3)(4)

 Amended and Restated Supplemental Executive Agreement by and between Carolina Finan-
cial Corporation and David Morrow dated as of December 24, 2008 (1)(2)

 Employment Agreement by and between Carolina Financial Corporation and Jerold L. Rex-
road dated as of May 1, 2008 (3)(4)

 First Amendment to the Employment Agreement between Carolina Financial Corporation 
and Jerold L. Rexroad dated as of September 19, 2012 (3)(4)

10.9 

Carolina Financial Corporation 2002 Stock Option Plan (3)

10.10  Carolina Financial Corporation 2006 Recognition and Retention Plan (3)(4)

10.11  Carolina Financial Corporation 2014 Equity Incentive Plan (3)(4)

10.12 

Form of Carolina Financial Corporation Elite LifeComp Agreement (3)(4)

10.13 

 Subservicing  Agreement  by  and  between  Cenlar  FSB  and  Crescent  Mortgage  Company  
dated January 1, 2004(3)

160

10.14 

 First  Amendment  to  Subservicing  Agreement  by  and  between  Cenlar  FSB  and  Crescent 
Mortgage Company dated as of February 19, 2004 (3)

10.15 

 Second Amendment to Subservicing Agreement by and between Cenlar FSB and Crescent 
Mortgage Company dated as of February 1, 2006 (3)

10.16 

 Third  Amendment  to  Subservicing  Agreement  by  and  between  Cenlar  FSB  and  Crescent 
Mortgage Company dated as of January 1, 2011 (1)

21.1 

Subsidiaries of Carolina Financial Corporation (1)

23	

Consent	of	Independent	Registered	Public	Accounting	Firm—Elliott	Davis	Decosimo,	LLC

31.1 

Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of the Chief Executive Officer

31.2 

Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of the Chief Financial Officer

32 

Section 1350 Certifications

101 

 The following materials from the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year end-
ed December 31, 2015, formatted in eXtensible Business Reporting Language (XBRL): (i) 
the Consolidated Balance Sheets as December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014; (ii) Consol-
idated Statements of Operations for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014; (iii) Con-
solidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 
2014 ; (iv) Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity for the years ended 
December 31, 2015 and 2014; (v) Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended 
December 31, 2015 and 2014; and (vi) Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

(1) 
(2) 
(3) 
(4) 

Incorporated by reference from the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-3 filed on August 31, 2015
Incorporated by reference from the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-4 filed on February 9, 2016
Incorporated by reference from the Company’s Registration Statement on Form 10 filed on February 26, 2014.
Indicates management contracts or compensatory plans or arrangements.

161

2015 Form 10-KCONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

Exhibit 23

The Board of Directors
Carolina Financial Corporation

We consent to incorporation by reference in the Registration Statement No. 333-197152 on Form S-8 and the Reg-
istration Statement No. 333-206676 on Form S-3 of Carolina Financial Corporation of our report dated March 14, 
2016, relating to our audit of the consolidated financial statements, which appear in this Annual Report on Form 
10-K of Carolina Financial Corporation for the year ended December 31, 2015.

/s/ Elliott Davis Decosimo, LLC

Greenville, South Carolina
March 14, 2016

162

Exhibit 31.1

Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of the Chief Executive Officer

I, Jerold L. Rexroad, President and Chief Executive Officer, certify that:

1. 

2. 

3. 

4. 

I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K of Carolina Financial Corporation;

 Based on my knowledge, this annual report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact 
or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances 
under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this 
annual report;

 Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this 
annual report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and 
cash	flows	of	the	registrant	as	of,	and	for,	the	periods	presented	in	this	annual	report;

 The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclo-
sure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal 
control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the 
registrant and have:

(a) 

(b) 

(c) 

(d) 

 Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and 
procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating 
to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within 
those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

 Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over 
financial reporting to be designed under  our supervision, to  provide  reasonable assurance 
regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for 
external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

 Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and pre-
sented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and 
procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting 
that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal 
quarter in the case of this annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to 
materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and

163

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
5. 

 The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of 
internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the 
registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

(a) 

(b) 

 All  significant  deficiencies  and  material  weaknesses  in  the  design  or  operation  of  internal 
control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s 
ability	to	record,	process,	summarize	and	report	financial	information;	and

 Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have 
a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.

Date: March 14, 2016

/s/ Jerold l. rexroad
Jerold L. Rexroad, 
Chief Executive Officer 
(Principal Executive Officer)

164

 
 
Exhibit 31.2 

Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of the Chief Financial Officer

I, William A. Gehman III, Chief Financial Officer, certify that:

1. 

2. 

3. 

4. 

I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K of Carolina Financial Corporation;

 Based on my knowledge, this annual report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or 
omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under 
which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this annual re-
port;

 Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this annual 
report,	fairly	present	in	all	material	respects	the	financial	condition,	results	of	operations	and	cash	flows	
of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this annual report;

 The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure 
controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal con-
trol over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant 
and have:

(a) 

(b) 

(c) 

(d) 

 Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and 
procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating 
to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within 
those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

 Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over 
financial reporting to be designed under  our supervision, to  provide  reasonable assurance 
regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for 
external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

 Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and pre-
sented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and 
procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting 
that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal 
quarter in the case of this annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to 
materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and

165

2015 Form 10-K 
 
 
 
5. 

 The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of 
internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the reg-
istrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

(a) 

(b) 

 All  significant  deficiencies  and  material  weaknesses  in  the  design  or  operation  of  internal 
control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s 
ability	to	record,	process,	summarize	and	report	financial	information;	and

 Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have 
a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.

Date: March 14, 2016

/s/ William a. Gehman iii
William A. Gehman III 
Chief Financial Officer 
(Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)

166

 
 
Exhibit 32 

CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO 18 U.S.C. SECTION 1350,  
AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO 
SECTION 906 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002

The undersigned, the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer of Carolina Finan-

cial Corporation (the “Company”), each certify that, to his knowledge on the date of this certification:

1. 

2. 

 The annual report of the Company for the period ended December 31, 2015 as filed with the Securities 
and Exchange Commission on this date (the “Report”) fully complies with the requirements of Section 
13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and

 The  information  contained  in  the  Report  fairly  presents,  in  all  material  respects,  the  financial 
condition and results of operations of the Company.

/s/ Jerold L. Rexroad

Jerold L. Rexroad 
Chief Executive Officer 
March 14, 2016

/s/ William A. Gehman III

William A. Gehman III 
Chief Financial Officer 
March 14, 2016

167

2015 Form 10-K(This page intentionally left blank)

(This page intentionally left blank)

SHAREHOLDER INFORMATION

OFFICERS

Jerold L. Rexroad 
President and Chief Executive Officer

William A. Gehman, III 
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

David L. Morrow 
Executive Vice President
President and Chief Executive Officer of CresCom Bank

M. J. Huggins, III 
Executive Vice President and Secretary

CORPORATE HEADQUARTERS

Carolina Financial Corporation
288 Meeting Street • Charleston, SC 29401
1 (855) 273 -7266

TRANSFER AGENT

Shareholder correspondence
Computershare 
P.O. BOX 30170
College Station, TX 77842-3170

Overnight correspondence
Computershare 
211 Quality Circle, Suite 210
College Station, TX 77845 

Telephone: Direct Dial 1 (781) 575 -4223  
Toll Free: (800) 368 -5948

ANNUAL MEETING 

The Annual Meeting of Stockholders will be held on Wednesday, May 3, 2016 at 5:00 PM at:

The Country Club of Charleston
1 Country Club Drive
Charleston, South Carolina 29412

CarolinaFC-AR-Wrap-2016-FINAL.indd   Custom V

3/24/16   9:47 AM

288 Meeting Street, Charleston, SC 29401
288 Meeting Street, Charleston, SC 29401
288 Meeting Street, Charleston, SC 29401

DOWNTOWN CHARLESTON
DOWNTOWN CHARLESTON
DOWNTOWN CHARLESTON
288 Meeting Street
288 Meeting Street
288 Meeting Street
Charleston, SC 29401-1570
Charleston, SC 29401-1570
Charleston, SC 29401-1570

GARDEN CITY
GARDEN CITY
GARDEN CITY
2636 S Hwy 17
2636 S Hwy 17
2636 S Hwy 17
Murrells Inlet, SC 29576-7617
Murrells Inlet, SC 29576-7617
Murrells Inlet, SC 29576-7617

WEST ASHLEY
WEST ASHLEY
WEST ASHLEY
884 Orleans Road
884 Orleans Road
884 Orleans Road
Charleston, SC 29407-4937
Charleston, SC 29407-4937
Charleston, SC 29407-4937

LITCHFIELD/PAWLEYS ISLAND
LITCHFIELD/PAWLEYS ISLAND
LITCHFIELD/PAWLEYS ISLAND
13021 Ocean Highway
13021 Ocean Highway
13021 Ocean Highway
Pawleys Island, SC 29585-7080
Pawleys Island, SC 29585-7080
Pawleys Island, SC 29585-7080

JAMES ISLAND
JAMES ISLAND
JAMES ISLAND
430 Folly Road
430 Folly Road
430 Folly Road
Charleston, SC 29412-2641
Charleston, SC 29412-2641
Charleston, SC 29412-2641

MOUNT PLEASANT
MOUNT PLEASANT
MOUNT PLEASANT
1492 Stuart Engals Blvd.
1492 Stuart Engals Blvd.
1492 Stuart Engals Blvd.
Mount Pleasant, SC 29464-3378
Mount Pleasant, SC 29464-3378
Mount Pleasant, SC 29464-3378

SUMMERVILLE
SUMMERVILLE
SUMMERVILLE
200 N Cedar Street
200 N Cedar Street
200 N Cedar Street
Summerville, SC 29483-6404
Summerville, SC 29483-6404
Summerville, SC 29483-6404

LITTLE RIVER
LITTLE RIVER
LITTLE RIVER
1180 Highway 17
1180 Highway 17
1180 Highway 17
Little River, SC 29566-9208
Little River, SC 29566-9208
Little River, SC 29566-9208

GREENVILLE
GREENVILLE
GREENVILLE
3695 E. North Street
3695 E. North Street
3695 E. North Street
Greenville, SC 29615
Greenville, SC 29615
Greenville, SC 29615

HEATH SPRINGS
HEATH SPRINGS
HEATH SPRINGS
202 N Main Street
202 N Main Street
202 N Main Street
Heath Springs, SC 29058
Heath Springs, SC 29058
Heath Springs, SC 29058

NORTH CHARLESTON
NORTH CHARLESTON
NORTH CHARLESTON
8485 Dorchester Road
8485 Dorchester Road
8485 Dorchester Road
North Charleston, SC 29420-7307
North Charleston, SC 29420-7307
North Charleston, SC 29420-7307

SUNSET BEACH
SUNSET BEACH
SUNSET BEACH
7290 Beach Drive SW
7290 Beach Drive SW
7290 Beach Drive SW
Ocean Isle Beach, NC 28469-5436
Ocean Isle Beach, NC 28469-5436
Ocean Isle Beach, NC 28469-5436

CANE BAY
CANE BAY
CANE BAY
1724 State Road
1724 State Road
1724 State Road
Summerville, SC 29483-2842
Summerville, SC 29483-2842
Summerville, SC 29483-2842

SAINT GEORGE
SAINT GEORGE
SAINT GEORGE
5561 Memorial Blvd.
5561 Memorial Blvd.
5561 Memorial Blvd.
Saint George, SC 29477-2475
Saint George, SC 29477-2475
Saint George, SC 29477-2475

MYRTLE BEACH
MYRTLE BEACH
MYRTLE BEACH
991 38th Avenue N
991 38th Avenue N
991 38th Avenue N
Myrtle Beach, SC 29577-2832
Myrtle Beach, SC 29577-2832
Myrtle Beach, SC 29577-2832

NORTH MYRTLE BEACH
NORTH MYRTLE BEACH
NORTH MYRTLE BEACH
700 Main Street
700 Main Street
700 Main Street
North Myrtle Beach, SC 29582-3030
North Myrtle Beach, SC 29582-3030
North Myrtle Beach, SC 29582-3030

SOCASTEE
SOCASTEE
SOCASTEE
4506 Highway 707
4506 Highway 707
4506 Highway 707
Myrtle Beach, SC 29588
Myrtle Beach, SC 29588
Myrtle Beach, SC 29588

CONWAY
CONWAY
CONWAY
2069 E Hwy 501
2069 E Hwy 501
2069 E Hwy 501
Conway, SC 29526-9504
Conway, SC 29526-9504
Conway, SC 29526-9504

CONWAY
CONWAY
CONWAY
1230 16th Avenue
1230 16th Avenue
1230 16th Avenue
Conway, SC 29526-3479
Conway, SC 29526-3479
Conway, SC 29526-3479

HOLDEN BEACH
HOLDEN BEACH
HOLDEN BEACH
3178 Holden Beach Road SW
3178 Holden Beach Road SW
3178 Holden Beach Road SW
Holden Beach, NC 28462
Holden Beach, NC 28462
Holden Beach, NC 28462

SHALLOTTE
SHALLOTTE
SHALLOTTE
200 Smith Avenue
200 Smith Avenue
200 Smith Avenue
Shallotte, NC 28470-4458
Shallotte, NC 28470-4458
Shallotte, NC 28470-4458

SOUTHPORT
SOUTHPORT
SOUTHPORT
4945 Southport Supply Road SE
4945 Southport Supply Road SE
4945 Southport Supply Road SE
Southport, NC 28461-8742
Southport, NC 28461-8742
Southport, NC 28461-8742

WHITEVILLE
WHITEVILLE
WHITEVILLE
110 N J K Powell Blvd.
110 N J K Powell Blvd.
110 N J K Powell Blvd.
Whiteville, NC 28472-3124
Whiteville, NC 28472-3124
Whiteville, NC 28472-3124

CHADBOURN
CHADBOURN
CHADBOURN
111 Strawberry Blvd.
111 Strawberry Blvd.
111 Strawberry Blvd.
Chadbourn, NC 28431-1415
Chadbourn, NC 28431-1415
Chadbourn, NC 28431-1415

ELIZABETHTOWN
ELIZABETHTOWN
ELIZABETHTOWN
306 S Poplar Street
306 S Poplar Street
306 S Poplar Street
Elizabethtown, NC 28337
Elizabethtown, NC 28337
Elizabethtown, NC 28337

TABOR CITY
TABOR CITY
TABOR CITY
105 Hickman Road
105 Hickman Road
105 Hickman Road
Tabor City, NC 28463-1927
Tabor City, NC 28463-1927
Tabor City, NC 28463-1927

ALL LOCATIONS
ALL LOCATIONS
ALL LOCATIONS
1 (855) 273-7266  •  www.haveanicebank.com
1 (855) 273-7266  •  www.haveanicebank.com
1 (855) 273-7266  •  www.haveanicebank.com

2
2
2
0
0
0
1
1
1
5
5
5
A
A
A
n
n
n
n
n
n
u
u
u
a
a
a
l
l
l

R
R
R
e
e
e
p
p
p
o
o
o
r
r
r
t
t
t

2
2
2
0
0
0
1
1
1
6
6
6
P
P
P
r
r
r
o
o
o
x
x
x
y
y
y
S
S
S
t
t
t
a
a
a
t
t
t
e
e
e
m
m
m
e
e
e
n
n
n
t
t
t

2015 Annual Report
2015 Annual Report
2015 Annual Report
2016 Proxy Statement
2016 Proxy Statement
2016 Proxy Statement

HOME OFFICE
HOME OFFICE
HOME OFFICE
6600 Peachtree Dunwoody Rd. NE/600 Embassy Row, Suite 650
6600 Peachtree Dunwoody Rd. NE/600 Embassy Row, Suite 650
6600 Peachtree Dunwoody Rd. NE/600 Embassy Row, Suite 650
Atlanta, GA 30328 • (800) 851- 0263 • www.crescentmortgage.com
Atlanta, GA 30328 • (800) 851- 0263 • www.crescentmortgage.com
Atlanta, GA 30328 • (800) 851- 0263 • www.crescentmortgage.com

DISCLAIMER – This annual report has not been reviewed or confirmed for accuracy or relevance by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.
DISCLAIMER – This annual report has not been reviewed or confirmed for accuracy or relevance by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.
DISCLAIMER – This annual report has not been reviewed or confirmed for accuracy or relevance by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.

CarolinaFC-AR-Wrap-2016-FINAL.indd   Custom H

3/24/16   9:47 AM